Official Software
Get notified when we add a new SuzukiVitara Manual

We cover 60 Suzuki vehicles, were you looking for one of these?

2005 Suzuki Swift (RS Series) Service Manual PDF
Suzuki SX4 RW415 RW416 RW420 Workshop Service Repair Manual PDF
2007 Suzuki Jimny SN413 SN415D Service Repair Manual PDF
Suzuki - Carry - Workshop Manual - 2001 - 2002
Suzuki Suzuki Alto Suzuki Alto Workshop Manual Service Manual
Suzuki Ignis (RB413) Service and Repair Manual
2007 Suzuki XL7 (JC636) Service Manual (99500S78J00-33E)
Suzuki - Swift - Workshop Manual - 2004 - 2010
Suzuki - Motorcycle - suzuki_TS_185_Service_Manual
Suzuki Samurai Service Repair Manual PDF
Suzuki - Cultus - Parts Catalogue - 2018 - 2018
1989-1994 Suzuki Swift 1300 GTI Service Repair Manual PDF
Suzuki Ignis Electrical Wiring Diagram
Suzuki Suzuki Baleno Suzuki Baleno Owners Manual
Suzuki Suzuki Alto Suzuki Alto Workshop Manual Service
2002-06--Suzuki--Aerio--4 Cylinders 4 2.0L MFI DOHC--32908901
Suzuki Suzuki Celerio Suzuki Celerio 2014 Owners Manual
1986-1998--Suzuki--Sidekick 4WD--4 Cylinders 0 1.6L 16V MFI SOHC--32153402
Suzuki - Motorcycle - Suzuki_GSF_600_Bandit_1999-2000_Service_Manual
1999 Suzuki Wagon R Service Repair & Wiring Diagram Manual PDF
Suzuki Suzuki Alto Suzuki Alto Workshop Manual Suzuki India
Suzuki Suzuki Alto Suzuki Alto Workshop Manual F8B
Suzuki - Motorcycle - Suzuki_GS750
Suzuki - Auto - suzuki-carry-2014-74855
Suzuki - Baleno - Owners Manual - 1999 - 1999
Suzuki Suzuki Splash Suzuki Splash 2012 Owners Manual
1994-02--Suzuki--Swift--4 Cylinders 2 1.3L FI SOHC--32582701
Suzuki Suzuki Jimny Suzuki Jimny 2010 Owners Manual
2003-06--Suzuki--Forenza--4 Cylinders 2.0L MFI DOHC--33005001
Suzuki - Motorcycle - Suzuki_GSF600_95-99
Suzuki RB413 Service & Repair Manual (99500-83E00-01E)
SUZUKI CHEVROLET SWIFT 1.3 1.6 Manual Taller completo PDF
Suzuki - SX4 - Owners Manual - 2008 - 2008
Suzuki - Auto - suzuki-sx4-s-cross-2015-74812
Suzuki - Splash - Workshop Manual - 2009 - 2016
Suzuki - Splash - Workshop Manual - 2008 - 2008 (2)
Suzuki - Auto - suzuki-jimny-2004-89261
Suzuki - Auto - suzuki-jimny-sierra-2002-74838
Suzuki Suzuki Alto Suzuki Alto Owners Manual
Suzuki - Motorcycle - Suzuki_TL1000R_1998-2002_Service_Manual
Suzuki Suzuki Swift Suzuki Swift Misc Documents Gearbox Repair Guidance
2002-06--Suzuki--Aerio FWD--4 Cylinders 6 2.3L MFI DOHC--33068001
Suzuki Suzuki Liana Suzuki Liana 2007 Service Repair Manual
Suzuki - Motorcycle - suzuki_Bandit1200
Suzuki - Swift - Miscellaneous Documents - 2010 - 2010
Maruti - Celerio - Owners Manual - (2015)
Suzuki - Splash - Workshop Manual - 2008 - 2008 (German)
Suzuki - XL-7 - Workshop Manual - 2002 - 2003
Suzuki - Samurai - Parts Catalogue - 1986 - 1987
Suzuki Suzuki Jimny Suzuki Jimny 1985 Owner Manual Holden Drover
Suzuki - Kizashi - Miscellaneous Documents - 2011 - 2012
1986-1998--Suzuki--Sidekick 4WD--4 Cylinders 0 1.6L 8V TBI SOHC--32154001
Suzuki - Motorcycle - Suzuki_XF650_Freewind_Service_Manual
Suzuki - Swift - Workshop Manual - 2003 - 2003
Suzuki - Swift - Sales Brochure - 2015 - 2015
Suzuki - Swift - Owners Manual - 2001 - 2001
Suzuki - Motorcycle - Suzuki_TL1000S_Service_Manual_and_Fiche_r2
Suzuki Suzuki Liana Suzuki Liana 2005 Service Repair Manual
Suzuki - Motorcycle - Suzuki_RV_125_Service_Manual
Suzuki - Swift - Sales Brochure - 2017 - 2017 (3)
Summary of Content
ENGLISH 14.5 mm 2010 SERVICE STATION INFORMATION Fuel recommendation: See page 1-1 Brake and clutch fluid: DOT3 Engine oil recommendation: Engine oil with “Starburst” symbol Automatic transmission fluid: SUZUKI ATF 3317 or Mobil ATF 3309 For further details, see “Engine Oil and Filter” in the “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section. Tire cold pressure: See the “Tire Information Label” located on the driver’s door lock pillar.   Suzuki Red: Magenta 100%, Yellow 100% Suzuki Blue: Cyan 100%, Magenta 70% takumi Blue: Cyan 100%, Black 85% Black           ! "# $ % & Keep With Vehicle At All Times. Contains Important Information On Safety, Operation & Maintenance. This owner’s manual applies to the GRAND VITARA series: 79K035 NOTE: The illustrated model is one of the GRAND VITARA series. © 2009 All rights reserved. No part of this document may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic or mechanical, for any purpose, without the express written permission of Suzuki Motor Corporation. 79K21-03E FOREWORD Your SUZUKI multipurpose vehicle is designed and built to be capable of performing both on pavement and off road. You should therefore remember that your vehicle is distinctly different from ordinary passenger cars in handling as well as in structure. As with other vehicles of this type, failure to operate this vehicle correctly may result in loss of control or an accident. Be sure to read “Important Vehicle Design Features to Know” and the “onpavement” and “off-road” driving guidelines which follow. It is very important to familiarize yourself with the proper operation of this vehicle before you start driving. All information in this manual is based on the latest product information available at the time of publication. Due to improvements or other changes, there may be discrepancies between information in this manual and your vehicle. SUZUKI MOTOR CORPORATION reserves the right to make production changes at any time, without notice and without incurring any obligation to make the same or similar changes to vehicles previously built or sold. SUZUKI MOTOR CORPORATION believes in conservation and protection of Earth’s natural resources. To that end, we encourage every vehicle owner to recycle, trade in, or properly dispose of, as appropriate, used motor oil, coolant, and other fluids, batteries and tires. IF YOU HAVE ANY PROBLEMS WITH YOUR SUZUKI: Please review the New Vehicle Warranty Information booklet supplied with your SUZUKI. Should you have a question or problem regarding the warranty or service of your vehicle, please take the following action: Consult the Service Manager and the Owner of the Suzuki Automotive Dealership. Explain your problem and ask for their assistance in resolving your problem. The Owner of the dealership is in the very best position to assist you as he or she is vitally concerned with your continued satisfaction. If you are still in need of additional information, or if you are dissatisfied, request that your dealer arrange a meeting with your District Service Manager. If, after doing so, you still require further assistance, and you purchased your SUZUKI in the continental United States, please contact the American Suzuki Customer Relations Department by telephone at 1-800-934-0934 or in writing at: American Suzuki Motor Corporation Automotive Customer Relations 3251 East Imperial Highway Brea, CA 92821-6795 79K21-03E If you purchased your SUZUKI in Canada please contact the Suzuki Canada Customer Relations Department by telephone at 1-905-889-2677 extension 2254 or in writing at: Suzuki Canada Inc. Customer Relations 100 East Beaver Creek Road Richmond Hill, On L4B 1J6 In the event you require assistance related to your SUZUKI, while temporarily travelling in either the United States or Canada, you may wish to contact the Suzuki Customer Relations Department directly of the country in which you are temporarily operating your vehicle. Please be certain to provide us with the following information: the model, Vehicle Identification Number, mileage, accessories involved, event dates, your concern, and any other comments which you may have. When we receive your correspondence, we will be pleased to contact the Owner of your dealership and assist in resolving your concern. IMPORTANT WARNING/CAUTION/NOTE Please read this manual and follow its instructions carefully. To emphasize special information, the symbol and the words WARNING, CAUTION and NOTE have special meanings. Pay special attention to the messages highlighted by these signal words: WARNING Indicates a potential hazard that could result in death or injury. CAUTION Indicates a potential hazard that could result in vehicle damage. 75F135 The circle with a slash in this manual means “Don’t do this” or “Don’t let this happen”. NOTE: Indicates special information to make maintenance easier or instructions clearer. For owners outside the continental United States, please refer to the distributor’s address listed in your Warranty Information booklet. 79K21-03E MODIFICATION WARNING WARNING Do not modify this vehicle. Modification could adversely affect safety, handling, performance or durability and may violate governmental regulations. In addition, damage or performance problems resulting from modification may not be covered under warranty. LEAK DETECTION PUMP NOTE: Your vehicle has a pump to regularly check the vehicle’s evaporative emission control system for leaks. This check is performed approximately five hours after the engine is turned off. During this leak check, you may hear a sound coming from the vehicle for several minutes. This sound is normal and does not indicate a malfunction. CAUTION Improper installation of mobile communication equipment such as cellular telephones or CB (Citizen’s Band) radios may cause electronic interference with your vehicle’s ignition system, resulting in vehicle performance problems. Consult your SUZUKI dealer or qualified service technician for advice on installing such mobile communication equipment. 79K21-03E MEMO 79K21-03E INTRODUCTION Thank you for choosing SUZUKI and welcome to our growing family. Your choice was a wise one; SUZUKI products are a great value that will give you years of driving pleasure. This Owner’s Manual was prepared to help you have a safe, enjoyable, and trouble-free experience with your SUZUKI. In it you will learn about the vehicle’s operation, its safety features and maintenance requirements. Please read it carefully before operating your vehicle. Afterwards, keep this Manual in the glove box for future reference. Should you resell the vehicle, please leave this Manual with it for the next owner. In addition to the Owner’s Manual, the other booklets provided with your SUZUKI explain the vehicle’s warranties. We recommend you read them as well to familiarize yourself with this important information. When planning the regular scheduled maintenance of your SUZUKI, we recommend you visit your local SUZUKI dealership. Their factory-trained technicians will provide the best possible service and use only genuine SUZUKI parts and accessories. 79K21-03E SERVICE STATION GUIDE 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. Fuel (see section 1) Engine hood (see section 5) Tire changing tools (see section 8) Engine oil dipstick (see section 7) Automatic transmission fluid dipstick (see section 7) Engine coolant (see section 7) Windshield washer fluid (see section 7) Battery (see section 7) Tire pressure (see Tire Information Label on driver’s door lock pillar) Spare tire (see section 8) 1 8 6 10 5 (4A/T) 2 4 7 5 (5A/T) 2 3 9 79K135 79K21-03E TABLE OF CONTENTS California Proposition 65 Warning WARNING Engine exhaust, some of its constituents, and certain product components contain or emit chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm. FUEL RECOMMENDATION 1 BEFORE DRIVING 2 OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE 3 DRIVING TIPS 4 OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT 5 VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING 6 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE 7 EMERGENCY SERVICE 8 APPEARANCE CARE 9 GENERAL INFORMATION 10 FUSES AND PROTECTED CIRCUITS 11 SPECIFICATIONS 12 INDEX 13 79K21-03E ILLUSTRATED TABLE OF CONTENTS EXTERIOR 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. Rear Window Wiper (P.2-81) Engine Hood (P.5-63) Windshield Wiper (P.2-79) Roof Rails or Roof Rack Anchors (if equipped) (P.5-78) Radio Antenna (P.5-8) Spare Wheel (P.8-3) Tailgate (P.2-3) Fuel Filler Cap (P.5-62) Outside Rearview Mirror (P.2-17) Door Locks (P.2-1) EXAMPLE 1 6 2 7 8 3 4 9 5 10 79K001 79K21-03E ILLUSTRATED TABLE OF CONTENTS INTERIOR 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. Interior Light (P.5-64, P.7-40) Seat Belts (P.2-26) Coat hooks (if equipped) (P.5-70) Side Curtain Air Bags (P.2-46) Sun Visor (P.5-64) Overhead Console Box (if equipped) (P.5-71) Spot Light (P.5-66, P.7-41) Inside Rearview Mirror (P.2-17) Luggage Compartment Cover (P.5-74) Rear Seats (P.2-22) Side Air Bags (P.2-46) Parking Brake Lever (P.3-7) Front Seats (P.2-18) Gearshift Lever (P.3-11) EXAMPLE 1 9 2 3 10 1 4 11 5 6 12 13 7 8 14 79K132 79K21-03E ILLUSTRATED TABLE OF CONTENTS INSTRUMENT PANEL 1. Power Window Controls (if equipped) (P.2-15) 2. Power Mirror Control (if equipped) (P.2-18) 3. Remote Audio Controls (if equipped) (P.5-56) 4. Front Air Bags (P.2-45) 5. Cruise Control (P.3-26) 6. Hazard Warning Switch (P.2-79) 7. Heating and Air Conditioning System (P.5-1) 8. Fuel Lid Opener Lever (P.5-62) 9. Front Seat Heater (if equipped) (P.2-21) 10. Accessory Socket (if equipped) (P.5-66) EXAMPLE 12 3 8 4 5 3 10 9 6 7 11 9 4 1 12 10 79K003 79K21-03E ILLUSTRATED TABLE OF CONTENTS INSTRUMENT PANEL 1. Lighting Control Lever (P.2-75)/ Turn Signal Control Lever (P.2-78) 2. Instrument Cluster (P.2-54) 3. Windshield Wiper and Washer Lever (P.2-79)/Rear Window Wiper and Washer Switch (P.2-81) 4. Rear Window Defroster and Outside Rearview Mirrors Defroster Switch (if equipped) (P.2-82) 5. Front Fog Light Switch (if equipped) (P.2-78) 6. Engine Hood Release Handle (P.5-63) 7. Horn (P.2-82) 8. Ignition Switch (P.3-3) 9. Transfer Switch (if equipped) (P.3-15) 10. “ESP OFF” Switch (if equipped) (P.3-34)/Hill descent control Switch (if equipped) (P.3-35) EXAMPLE 1 6 5 2 7 6 7 8 3 8 9 4 10 9 11 10 79K136 79K21-03E Location of Warning Messages: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 14 LOCATION OF WARNING MESSAGES Read and follow all of the warnings (labels etc.) on your vehicle. Make sure you understand all of them. Keep them on the vehicle. Do not remove the messages for any reason. If a label comes off or the messages become difficult to be read, have it corrected by your SUZUKI dealer. 1. Air bag warning labels (on both sun visors) 2. Rollover warning label 3. Passenger seat belt warning label 4. Jacking warning label 5. Jacking warning label 6. Fuel filler cap message 7. Transfer switch warning label 8. Brake fluid cap message 9. Engine cooling fan warning label 10. Radiator cap warning label 11. Air conditioner warning label 12. Battery label 13. Side air bag warning label 14. Rear outboard seat belt warning label 15. Rear center seat belt warning label 16. Luggage compartment cover warning label 6 16 4 5 15 14 13 14 14 13 13 Driver 1 Passenger 3 2 12 7 8 9 10 11 79K115 79K21-03E FUEL RECOMMENDATION FUEL RECOMMENDATION 1 Fuel Recommendation ........................................................ 1-1 65D394 79K21-03E Fuel Recommendation: 1, 2 FUEL RECOMMENDATION Fuel Recommendation Gasoline Containing MTBE Fuel Pump Labeling Unleaded gasoline containing MTBE (methyl tertiary butyl ether) may be used in your vehicle if the MTBE content is not greater than 15%. This oxygenated fuel does not contain alcohol. In some states, pumps that dispense oxygenated fuels are required to be labeled for the type and percentage of oxygenate and whether important additives are present. Such labels may provide enough information for you to determine if a particular blend of fuel meets the requirements listed above. In other areas, pumps may not be clearly labeled as to the content or type of oxygenate and additives. If you are not sure that the fuel you intend to use meets these requirements, check with the service station operator or the fuel supplier. Gasoline/Ethanol blends Blends of unleaded gasoline and ethanol (grain alcohol), also known as gasohol, may be used in your vehicle if the ethanol content is not greater than 10%. 60A004 Your vehicle requires regular unleaded gasoline with a minimum rating of 87 pump octane ((R + M)/2 method). In some areas, the only fuels that are available are oxygenated fuels. Oxygenated fuels which meet the minimum octane requirement and the requirements described below may be used in your vehicle without jeopardizing the New Vehicle Limited Warranty. NOTE: Oxygenated fuels are fuels which contain oxygen-carrying additives such as MTBE or alcohol. Gasoline/Methanol blends Fuels containing 5% or less methanol (wood alcohol) may be suitable for use in your vehicle if they contain cosolvents and corrosion inhibitors. Do NOT USE fuels containing more than 5% methanol under any circumstances. Fuel system damage or vehicle performance problems resulting from the use of such fuels are not the responsibility of SUZUKI and may not be covered under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty. NOTE: To help clean the air, SUZUKI recommends you use the oxygenated fuels. However, if you are not satisfied with the driveability or fuel economy of your vehicle when you are using an oxygenated fuel, switch back to the regular unleaded gasoline. CAUTION Be careful not to spill fuel containing alcohol while refueling. If fuel is spilled on the vehicle body, wipe it up immediately. Fuels containing alcohol can cause paint damage, which is not covered under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty. 1-1 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING BEFORE DRIVING 60G404 Keys ...................................................................................... 2-1 Door Locks .......................................................................... 2-1 2 Keyless Start System Remote Controller/Keyless Entry System Transmitter ............................................................. 2-4 Theft Deterrent Light ........................................................... 2-15 Windows .............................................................................. 2-15 Mirrors .................................................................................. 2-17 Front Seats .......................................................................... 2-18 Rear Seats ............................................................................ 2-22 Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems ........................... 2-26 Supplemental Restraint System (air bags) ....................... 2-43 Instrument Cluster .............................................................. 2-54 Warning and Indicator Lights ............................................ 2-55 Speedometer ....................................................................... 2-65 Tachometer .......................................................................... 2-65 Fuel Gauge ........................................................................... 2-65 Temperature Gauge ............................................................ 2-66 Brightness Control .............................................................. 2-66 Information Display (if equipped) ...................................... 2-67 Lighting Control Lever ........................................................ 2-75 Front Fog Light Switch (if equipped) ................................ 2-78 Turn Signal Control Lever .................................................. 2-78 Hazard Warning Switch ...................................................... 2-79 Windshield Wiper and Washer Lever ................................ 2-79 Tilt Steering Lock Lever ..................................................... 2-82 Horn ...................................................................................... 2-82 Rear Window Defroster and Outside Rearview Mirrors Defroster (if equipped) Switch ........................................... 2-82 79K21-03E Keys: 8 Spare Tire Nut Lock: 5 BEFORE DRIVING Keys Ignition Key Reminder A buzzer sounds intermittently to remind you to remove the ignition key if it is in the ignition switch when the driver’s door is opened. EXAMPLE Door Locks WARNING Always lock all doors when driving. Locking the doors helps to prevent occupants from being thrown from the vehicle in the event of an accident. It also helps prevent unintended opening of the doors. Side Door Locks UNLOCK 54G489 LOCK Your vehicle comes with a pair of identical keys. Keep the spare key in a safe place. One key can open all of the locks on the vehicle. The key identification number is stamped on a metal tag provided with the keys. Keep the tag in a safe place. If you lose your keys, you will need this number to have new keys made. Write the number below for your future reference. KEY NUMBER: Rear Front 60A009 To lock a front door from outside the vehicle: • Insert the key and turn the top of the key toward the front of the vehicle, or • Turn the lock knob forward and close the door. 2-1 79K21-03E Door Locks: 3, 5, 8 BEFORE DRIVING To unlock a front door from outside the vehicle, insert the key and turn the top of the key toward the rear of the vehicle. Power Door Locking System (if equipped) Driver’s side EXAMPLE UNLOCK UNLOCK LOCK LOCK UNLOCK LOCK Rear 79K005 Front Front passenger’s side 64J003 64J002 To lock a door from inside the vehicle, turn the lock knob forward. Turn the lock knob rearward to unlock the door. To lock a rear side door from outside the vehicle, turn the lock knob forward and close the door. You can lock and unlock all doors (including the tailgate) simultaneously by: • Turning the key in the driver’s door lock, or • Pushing the power door locking switch located on the door panel of either front door. LOCK UNLOCK (when using the key) To lock all doors simultaneously, insert the key in the driver’s door lock, and turn the key to the LOCK side. To unlock all doors simultaneously, insert the key in the driver’s door lock and turn the key to the UNLOCK side twice. 79K006 2-2 79K21-03E Door Locks: 3, 5, 8 BEFORE DRIVING (when using the power door locking switch) To lock or unlock all the doors simultaneously, depress the front or rear of the switch respectively. NOTE: • If your vehicle is equipped with the keyless entry system, you can also lock or unlock all doors by operating the remote controller/transmitter. Refer to “Keyless Start System Remote Controller/Keyless Entry System Transmitter” in this section. • If your vehicle is equipped with the keyless start system, you can also lock or unlock all doors by pushing the request switch on the door handle. Refer to “Keyless Start System Remote Controller/ Keyless Entry System Transmitter” in this section. Child Lock System (rear doors) Tailgate You can lock or unlock the tailgate by using the key in the driver’s door lock. NOTE: When, in parked condition on a road, the tailgate is open and hides the lights, it is necessary to indicate the presence of the vehicle, for example by means of a warning triangle or other devices according to national requirements for use on the road. (2) (1) 79K009 (1) LOCK (2) UNLOCK Each of the rear doors is equipped with a child lock which can be used to help prevent unwanted opening of the door from inside the vehicle. When the lock lever is in the “LOCK” position (1), the rear door can only be opened from outside. When the lock lever is in the “UNLOCK” position (2), the rear door can be opened from inside or outside. If you cannot unlock the tailgate due to a discharged battery or malfunction, follow the procedures below to unlock the tailgate from inside the vehicle. 1) Remove the luggage compartment cover. 2) Fold the rear seat forward for easier access. Refer to the “Folding Rear Seats” section for details on how to fold the rear seat forward. WARNING Be sure to place the child lock system in the “LOCK” position whenever children are seated in the rear. 2-3 79K21-03E Door Locks: 3, 5, 8 BEFORE DRIVING Keyless Start System Remote Controller/Keyless Entry System Transmitter (2) Type A Type B (1) 64J202 64J203 3) Remove the cap (1) by hand. 4) Break the vinyl using a jack handle or a flat blade screwdriver to access the emergency lever (2). 5) Push down on the emergency lever (2) using a jack handle or a flat blade screwdriver. To lock the tailgate, push up on the emergency lever (2). WARNING To avoid injury, do not use your finger to push the emergency lever. After using the emergency lever, be sure to see your SUZUKI dealer. 66J111 Your vehicle is equipped with either a keyless start system remote controller (Type A) or a keyless entry system transmitter (Type B). The remote controller has a keyless entry system and a keyless start system. The transmitter has only a keyless entry system. For details, refer to the following explanations. 2-4 79K21-03E Door Locks: 3, 5, 8 BEFORE DRIVING Keyless Start System Remote Controller (Type A) The remote controller enables the following operations: • You can lock or unlock the doors by operating the LOCK/UNLOCK buttons on the remote controller. Refer to the explanation in this section. • You can lock or unlock the doors (including the tailgate) by pushing the request switch on the door handle of each door or the tailgate. For details, refer to the explanation in this section. • You can start the engine without using an ignition key. For details, refer to “Ignition Switch” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section. (1) (2) (3) “LOCK” button (1) / “UNLOCK” button (2) function You can lock or unlock all doors (including the tailgate) simultaneously by operating the remote controller near the vehicle. • To lock the doors, push the “LOCK” button (1). • To unlock the driver’s door, push the “UNLOCK” button (2) once. • To unlock other doors, wait a second or two, then push the “UNLOCK” button (2) a second time. If you “double-click” too fast, the doors will not unlock. The turn signal lights will flash once when the doors are locked. When the doors are unlocked: • The turn signal lights will flash twice. • If the interior light switch is in the “DOOR” position, the interior light will turn on for about 15 seconds and then fade out. If you push in the ignition switch or insert the key during this time, the light will start to fade out immediately. NOTE: • The maximum operating distance of the remote controller is about 5 m (16 ft.), but this can vary depending on the surroundings, especially near other transmitting devices such as radio towers or CB (Citizen’s Band) radios. • The door locks cannot be operated with the remote controller if the ignition switch is in a position other than “LOCK”, or the ignition key is inserted in the ignition switch. If any door is open, you cannot lock the door by operating the remote controller, however unlock the door. • You cannot lock the door unless all of the doors are closed completely. • If you lose one of the remote controllers, ask your SUZUKI dealer as soon as possible for a replacement. Be sure to have your dealer program the new remote controller code in your vehicle’s memory so that the old code is erased, or perform the programming procedure yourself according to the instructions in this section. Be sure the doors are locked after you operate the “LOCK” button (1). 66J114 (1) “LOCK” button (2) “UNLOCK” button (3) “PANIC” button If no door is opened within about 30 seconds after the “UNLOCK” button (2) is operated, the doors will automatically lock again. 2-5 79K21-03E Door Locks: 3, 5, 8 BEFORE DRIVING “PANIC” button (3) function This function is to get the attention of others. Press the “PANIC” button (3) for more than 1 second. The headlights and taillights will blink for about 30 seconds. Also, the horn will sound intermittently for about 30 seconds at the same time. To cancel the “PANIC” mode, press any button (PANIC, LOCK or UNLOCK) on the remote controller. You can also insert the key in the ignition switch and turn to the “ON” position to cancel the “PANIC” mode. NOTE: The “PANIC” button function will not activate when the key is in the ignition switch. Keyless unlocking/locking using the request switches EXAMPLE When the doors are unlocked: • The turn signal lights will flash twice. • If the interior light switch is in the “DOOR” position, the interior light will turn on for about 15 seconds and then fade out. If you push in the ignition switch or insert the key during this time, the light will start to fade out immediately. Be sure the doors are locked after you operate the request switch to lock the doors. (1) (1) 78K143 When the remote controller is within the operating range described in this section, you can lock or unlock the doors by pushing the request switch (1) on the door handle of each door or the tailgate. To lock all doors when all doors are unlocked: • Push the request switch on one of the door handles once. The turn signal lights will flash once when the doors are locked. NOTE: • The door locks cannot be operated by the request switch under the following conditions: – If any door is open or is not completely closed. – If the ignition switch is in a position other than “LOCK”. – If the ignition key is inserted in the ignition switch. • If no doors are opened within about 30 seconds after unlocking the doors by pushing the request switch, the doors will be locked again automatically. To unlock a door or all doors: • Push the request switch on the door handle once to unlock only one door. • Push the request switch on the door handle twice to unlock all doors. 2-6 79K21-03E Door Locks: 3, 5, 8 BEFORE DRIVING EXAMPLE (1) (1) (1) • If a spare remote controller is in the vehicle, the request switches may not operate normally. • The remote controller will only operate a request switch if it is within the switch’s operating range. For example, if the remote controller is within the operating range of the driver’s door request switch but not the front passenger’s door request switch or the tailgate request switch, the driver’s door switch can be operated but the front passenger’s door switch or tailgate switch cannot be operated. 78K001 (1) 80 cm (2 1/2 feet) When the remote controller is within approximately 80 cm (2 1/2 feet) from a front door handle or the tailgate switch, you can lock or unlock the doors by pushing the request switch. NOTE: • If the remote controller is outside the request switch operating range described above, you will not be able to operate the request switch. • If the battery of the remote controller runs down or there are strong radio waves or noise, the request switch operating range may be reduced or the remote controller may be inoperative. • If the remote controller is too close to the door, the request switches may not operate. CAUTION The remote controller is a sensitive electronic instrument. To avoid damaging the remote controller: • Do not expose it to impacts, moisture or high temperature such as by leaving it on the dashboard under direct sunlight. • Keep the remote controller away from magnetic objects such as a television. NOTE: The keyless start system may not function correctly in certain environments or under certain operating conditions such as the following: • When there are strong signals coming from a television, power station or a cellular phone. • When the remote controller is in contact with or covered by a metal object. • When a radio wave type remote keyless entry is used nearby. • When the remote controller is placed near an electronic device such as personal computer. Some additional precautions you should take and information you should be aware of are: • Make sure the ignition key is stowed in the remote controller. If the remote controller becomes unreliable, you will not be able to lock or unlock the doors or start the engine. • Be sure that the driver always carries the remote controller. • If you lose one of the remote controllers, ask your SUZUKI dealer as soon as possible for a replacement. Be sure to have your dealer program the new remote controller code in your vehicle’s memory so that the old code is erased, or perform the programming procedure yourself according to the instructions in this section. 2-7 79K21-03E Door Locks: 3, 5, 8 BEFORE DRIVING • You can use up to four remote controllers and ignition keys for your vehicle. Ask your SUZUKI dealer for details. • The battery life of the remote controller is about two years, but it can vary depending on usage conditions. 63J281 To stow the ignition key into the remote controller, push the key in the remote controller until you hear a click. (A) 63J282 To remove the key from the remote controller, push the button (A) in the direction of the arrow and pull the key out from the remote controller. • If you open the driver’s door and lock the door by turning the lock knob forward or pushing the power door locking switch, the driver’s door will be automatically unlocked. • If you open a door other than the driver’s door and lock the front passenger’s door by turning the lock knob forward or pushing the power door locking switch, the front passenger’s door will be automatically unlocked. Reminder function EXAMPLE 79K116 If the remote controller is not in the vehicle under the following conditions, a buzzer sounds intermittently for about 2 seconds and the keyless start system indicator light on the instrument cluster blinks in red: • When the vehicle speed is over 10 km/h (6 mph). • When one or more doors are opened and all of the doors are later closed with the ignition switch in a position other than “LOCK”. NOTE: • The reminder will not operate when the remote controller is on the instrument panel, in the glove box, in a storage compartment, in the sun visor or on the floor etc. • Be sure that the driver always carries the remote controller. • Do not leave the remote controller in the vehicle when leaving the vehicle. The red indicator light will turn off within several seconds after the remote controller is returned to an area of the vehicle other than the rear luggage area. If the remote controller is left in the vehicle and you lock the driver’s door or front passenger’s door as described below, the door will be automatically unlocked. 2-8 79K21-03E Door Locks: 3, 5, 8 BEFORE DRIVING Replacement of the battery If the remote controller becomes unreliable, replace the battery. CAUTION The transmitter/remote controller is a sensitive electronic instrument. To avoid damaging it, do not expose it to dust or moisture or tamper with internal parts. To replace the battery of the remote controller: (1) 66J017 66J016 1) Insert a flat blade screwdriver covered with a soft cloth in the slot of the remote controller and pry it open. 2) Replace the battery (1) (Lithium disc type CR2032 or equivalent) so its + terminal faces the bottom of the case as shown in the illustration. 3) Close the remote controller firmly. 4) Make sure the door locks can be operated with the remote controller. 5) Dispose of the used battery properly according to applicable rules or regulations. Do not dispose of lithium batteries with ordinary household trash. WARNING Swallowing a lithium battery may cause serious internal injury. Do not allow anyone to swallow a lithium battery. Keep lithium batteries away from children and pets. If swallowed, contact a physician immediately. 2-9 79K21-03E Door Locks: 3, 5, 8 BEFORE DRIVING Programming/erasing the remote controller code yourself Your new vehicle was originally equipped with two remote controllers. If you have lost one of the remote controllers, you should change the remote controller code in your vehicle’s memory as soon as possible for security. If you purchase additional remote controllers, the new remote controllers need to be programmed into your vehicle’s memory. You can perform this yourself by using the following procedure: NOTE: • You can program up to four remote controller codes into your vehicle’s memory. The four codes may be the same or different. • If you try to program a fifth code, the four remote controller codes that are programmed will be cleared automatically. • If you program a new remote controller code, all of the old remote controller codes that are in your vehicle’s memory will be erased automatically. When you program a new remote controller, you should reprogram any additional remote controllers at the same time. • To purchase new remote controllers, see your SUZUKI dealer. • Before you begin programming, have all of your remote controllers available. To program a new remote controller 1) Close all the doors of the vehicle. 2) Sit in the driver’s seat and confirm that the driver’s door is unlocked. 3) Insert the key into the ignition switch. 4) Complete steps 1 through 6 described below within 25 seconds after step 3). UNLOCK (2) LOCK (1) 79K005 1. Push the power door locking switch of the driver’s door to the lock position and then push it to the unlock position. 2. Repeat step 1 two more times. 3. Push the power door locking switch of the driver’s door to the lock position. 4. Remove the key from the ignition switch and then insert it again. 5. Repeat step 4 three more times. 6. To start the engine, turn the ignition switch to the “START” position. Wait for 3 seconds. 7. Proceed to step 5) within 60 seconds after the engine has started. NOTE: You cannot program the remote controller if you don’t complete steps 1 through 6 within 25 seconds. You cannot program the remote controller if you do not proceed to step 5) within 60 seconds after the engine has started. 5) Turn the ignition switch to the “LOCK” position. A buzzer will sound twice and the door lock switch will be activated from the lock position to the unlock position automatically. 6) Press the “LOCK”, “UNLOCK” or “PANIC” button on the remote controller. A buzzer will sound twice and the door lock switch will be activated from the lock position to the unlock position automatically. If you want to program an additional remote controller, repeat the procedure of step 6) using the additional remote controller. NOTE: Complete step 6) within 30 seconds. You can program up to four remote controllers. 2-10 79K21-03E Door Locks: 3, 5, 8 BEFORE DRIVING 7) To complete programming, remove the key from the ignition switch or turn the ignition switch to the “ON” position. 8) Make sure that the keyless start system and keyless entry system operate properly by operating each remote controller. If you cannot operate the keyless start system and/or keyless entry system, repeat this programming procedure again. If you still cannot operate the systems, see your SUZUKI dealer. To change the old remote controller codes in your vehicle’s memory If you have lost one of the remote controllers, you should change the remote controller codes in your vehicle’s memory as soon as possible for security. To erase the remote controller code(s) in your vehicle’s memory, you should program the new remote controller code. The old codes in your vehicle’s memory will be erased automatically. If you have more remote controller(s), you must program all of the remote controller codes at the same time. You cannot operate the keyless start system and keyless entry system using any remote controller that is not programmed at the same time. For details on how to program, refer to the programming procedure in this section. When you complete programming, make sure that the keyless start system and key- less entry system operate properly by operating each remote controller. Keyless Entry System Transmitter (Type B) 1. For USA This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: 1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and 2) This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. NOTE: Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment. 2. For Canada This device complies with Industry Canada Standard RSS-210. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: 1) This device may not cause interference, and 2) This device must accept any interference, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device. The term “IC:” before the certification/registration number only signifies that the Industry Canada technical specifications were met. (1) (2) (3) 52D209 (1) “LOCK” button (2) “UNLOCK” button (3) “PANIC” button “LOCK” button (1) / “UNLOCK” button (2) function You can lock or unlock all doors (including the tailgate) simultaneously by operating the transmitter near the vehicle. • To lock the doors, push the “LOCK” button (1). • To unlock the driver’s door, push the “UNLOCK” button (2) once. • To unlock other doors, wait a second or two, then push the “UNLOCK” button (2) a second time. If you “double-click” too fast, the doors will not unlock. 2-11 79K21-03E Door Locks: 3, 5, 8 BEFORE DRIVING The turn signal lights will flash once when the doors are locked. When the doors are unlocked: • The turn signal lights will flash twice. • If the interior light switch is in the “DOOR” position, the interior light will turn on for about 15 seconds and then fade out. If you insert the key into the ignition switch during this time, the light will start to fade out immediately. Be sure the doors are locked after you operate the “LOCK” button (1). If no door is opened within about 30 seconds after the “UNLOCK” button (2) is operated, the doors will automatically lock again. NOTE: • The maximum operating distance of the keyless entry system transmitter is about 5 m (16 ft.), but this can vary depending on the surroundings, especially near other transmitting devices such as radio towers or CB (Citizen’s Band) radios. • The door locks cannot be operated with the transmitter, if the ignition key is inserted in the ignition switch. • If you lose one of the transmitters, ask your SUZUKI dealer as soon as possible for a replacement. Be sure to have your dealer program the new transmitter code in your vehicle’s memory so that the old code is erased, or perform the program- ming procedure yourself according to the instructions in this section. CAUTION Replacement of the battery If the transmitter becomes unreliable, replace the battery. To replace the battery of the transmitter: The transmitter is a sensitive electronic instrument. To avoid damaging the transmitter: • Do not expose it to impacts, moisture or high temperature such as by leaving it on the dashboard under direct sunlight. • Keep the transmitter away from magnetic objects such as a television. “PANIC” button (3) function This function is to get the attention of others. Press the “PANIC” button (3) for more than 1 second. The headlights and taillights will blink for about 30 seconds. Also, the horn will sound intermittently for about 30 seconds at the same time. To cancel the “PANIC” mode, press any button (PANIC, LOCK or UNLOCK) on the transmitter. You can also insert the key in the ignition switch and turn to the “ON” position to cancel the “PANIC” mode. 52D210 1) Put the edge of a coin or a flat blade screwdriver in the slot of the transmitter and pry it open. NOTE: The “PANIC” button function will not activate when the key is in the ignition switch. 2-12 79K21-03E Door Locks: 3, 5, 8 Windows: 3, 8 BEFORE DRIVING CAUTION The transmitter/remote controller is a sensitive electronic instrument. To avoid damaging it, do not expose it to dust or moisture or tamper with internal parts. (1) Programming/removing a transmitter code yourself Your new vehicle was originally equipped with two transmitters. 52D211 2) Replace the battery (1) (Lithium disctype CR2025 or equivalent) so its + terminal faces the “+” mark of the transmitter. 3) Close the transmitter firmly. 4) Make sure the door locks can be operated with the transmitter. 5) Dispose of the used battery properly according to applicable rules or regulations. Do not dispose of lithium batteries with ordinary household trash. WARNING Swallowing a lithium battery may cause serious internal injury. Do not allow anyone to swallow a lithium battery. Keep lithium batteries away from children and pets. If swallowed, contact a physician immediately. If you have lost one of the transmitters, you should change the transmitter code in your vehicle’s memory as soon as possible for security. If you purchase additional transmitters, the new transmitters need to be programmed into your vehicle’s memory. You can perform this yourself by using the following procedure: NOTE: • You can program up to three transmitter codes into your vehicle’s memory. The three codes may be the same or different. • If you try to program a fourth code, the oldest code will be cleared automatically. • To purchase new transmitters, see your SUZUKI dealer. • Before you begin programming, have all of your transmitters available. To program a new transmitter 1) Confirm that all the doors are closed and the ignition key is out of the ignition switch. 2) Open the driver’s door. 3) Insert the key, turn the ignition switch to the “ON” position, turn the ignition switch to the “LOCK” position and remove the key within 10 seconds. (1) 66J018 4) Push and release the driver’s door switch (1) 3 times, insert the key, and turn the ignition switch to the “ON” position within 20 seconds. 5) Turn the ignition switch to the “LOCK” position and remove the key within 10 seconds. All doors will lock/unlock to confirm that this procedure has been properly completed. 2-13 79K21-03E Windows: 3, 8 BEFORE DRIVING To change the old transmitter codes in your vehicle’s memory If you have lost one of the transmitters, you should change the transmitter codes in your vehicle’s memory as soon as possible for security. To remove one of the transmitter codes from your vehicle’s memory, first replace all three of the transmitter codes in your vehicle’s memory, then program additional transmitters as follows: (2) 52D212 6) Press the “UNLOCK” button (2) on the transmitter one time within 20 seconds (after step 5). All the doors will lock/ unlock to confirm that the procedure has been completed and the transmitter has been programmed. 7) If you want to program an additional transmitter, repeat the procedure from step 1) through step 6). 8) Make sure that the keyless entry system operates properly by operating each transmitter. 1) Program one of your transmitters three times, by repeating the programming procedure shown in this section. This will replace all the old transmitter codes in the vehicle’s memory with the code for the transmitter you are using. 2) If you want to program up to two additional transmitters, repeat the programming procedure shown in this section. 3) Make sure that the keyless entry system operates properly by operating each transmitter. 1. For USA This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: 1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and 2) This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. NOTE: Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment. 2. For Canada This device complies with Industry Canada Standard RSS-210. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: 1) This device may not cause interference, and 2) This device must accept any interference, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device. The term “IC:” before the certification/registration number only signifies that the Industry Canada technical specifications were met. 2-14 79K21-03E Windows: 3, 8 Mirrors: 3, 8 BEFORE DRIVING Theft Deterrent Light Windows Passenger’s door EXAMPLE Power Window Controls (if equipped) EXAMPLE (3) Driver’s side (1) (4) (2) 79K011 78K013 This light will blink with the ignition switch in the “OFF” or “ACC” position. The blinking light is intended to deter theft by leading others to believe that the vehicle is equipped with a security system. (5) The passenger’s door has a switch (3) to operate the passenger’s window. 79K010 The power windows can only be operated when the ignition switch is in the “ON” position. The driver’s door has switches (1), (2), (4), (5), to operate the driver’s window, the front passenger’s window, the rear left window and right window, respectively. 2-15 79K21-03E Mirrors: 3, 8 BEFORE DRIVING Lock switch WARNING EXAMPLE CLOSE OPEN 81A009 To open a window, push the top part of the switch and to close the window lift up the top part of the switch. The driver’s window has an “auto-down” feature for added convenience (at toll booths or drive-through restaurants, for example). This means you can open the window without holding the window switch in the “Down” position. Press the driver’s window switch completely down and release it. To stop the window before it reaches the bottom, pull the switch up briefly. 79K012 The driver’s door also has a lock switch for the passenger’s window(s). When you push in the lock switch, the passenger’s window(s) cannot be raised or lowered by operating either of the switches (2), (3), (4) or (5). To restore normal operation, release the lock switch by pushing again. • You should always lock the passenger’s window operation when there are children in the vehicle. Children can be seriously injured if they get part of their body caught by the window during operation. • To avoid injuring an occupant by window entrapment, be sure no part of the occupant’s body such as hands or head is in the path of the electric windows when closing them. • Always remove the ignition key when leaving the vehicle even if only for a short time. Also do not leave children alone in a parked vehicle. Unattended children could use the electric window switches and get trapped by the window. NOTE: If you drive with one of the rear windows open, you may hear a loud sound caused by air vibration. To reduce the sound, open the driver’s or front passenger’s window, or narrow the rear window opening. 2-16 79K21-03E Seat Adjustment: 14 BEFORE DRIVING Mirrors Outside Rearview Mirrors WARNING Inside Rearview Mirror Day driving • Always adjust the mirror with the selector set to the day position. • Only use the night position if it is necessary to reduce glare from the headlights of vehicles behind you. Be aware that in this position you may not be able to see some objects that could be seen in the day position. Night driving (1) 64J014 78K033 You can adjust the inside rearview mirror by hand so as to see the rear of your vehicle in the mirror. To adjust the mirror, set the selector tab (1) to the day position, then move the mirror up, down or sideways by hand to obtain the best view. When driving at night, you can move the selector tab to the night position to reduce glare from the headlights of vehicles behind you. Adjust the outside rearview mirrors so you can just see the side of your vehicle in the mirrors. The passenger’s side mirror is a convex (curved surface) mirror. Objects seen in this mirror will look smaller and appear farther away than when seen in a flat mirror. WARNING Be careful when judging the size or distance of a vehicle or other object seen in the side convex mirror. Be aware that objects look smaller and appear farther away than when seen in a flat mirror. 2-17 79K21-03E Seat Adjustment: 14 Head Restraints: 3 BEFORE DRIVING Power Mirror Control (if equipped) Mirrors Defroster (if equipped) Switch” in this section. Front Seats Seat Adjustment WARNING (1) (1) (2) (3) (4) (2) (3) Never attempt to adjust the driver’s seat or seatback while driving. The seat or seatback could move unexpectedly, causing loss of control. Make sure that the driver’s seat and seatback are properly adjusted before you start driving. (4) 64J015 The switch to control the power rearview mirrors is located on the driver’s door panel. You can adjust the mirrors when the ignition switch is in the “ACC” or “ON” position. To adjust the mirrors: WARNING To avoid excessive seat belt slack, which reduces the effectiveness of the seat belts as a safety device, make sure that the seats are adjusted before the seat belts are fastened. 1) Move the selector switch to the left or right to select the mirror you wish to adjust. 2) Press the outer part of the switch that corresponds to the direction in which you wish to move the mirror. 3) Return the selector switch to the center position to help prevent unintended adjustment. NOTE: If your vehicle is equipped with the outside rearview mirrors defroster, refer to “Rear Window Defroster and Outside Rearview 2-18 79K21-03E Head Restraints: 3 Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14 BEFORE DRIVING Adjusting Seat Position Adjusting Seatbacks WARNING All seatbacks should always be in an upright position when driving, or seat belt effectiveness may be reduced. Seat belts are designed to offer maximum protection when seatbacks are in the upright position. 78K034 64J016 The adjustment lever for each front seat is located under the front of the seat. To adjust the seat position, pull up on the adjustment lever and slide the seat forward or rearward. After adjustment, try to move the seat forward and rearward to ensure that it is securely latched. If the driver’s seat is equipped with a seat height adjuster lever on the outboard side of the seat, raise or lower the seat by pulling up or down the adjuster lever. 64J018 To adjust the seatback angle of front seat, pull up the lever on the outboard side of the seat, move the seatback to the desired position, and release the lever to lock the seatback in place. 2-19 79K21-03E Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14 BEFORE DRIVING Head Restraints WARNING (1) All head restraints must be reinstalled to properly protect vehicle occupants. (3) WARNING • Never drive the vehicle with the head restraints removed. • Do not attempt to adjust the head restraint while driving. (2) EXAMPLE 78K035 63J256 (1) Head restraint (2) Bars (3) Release knob Head restraints are designed to help reduce the risk of neck injuries in case of an accident. Adjust the head restraint to the position which places the center of the head restraint closest to the top of your ears. If this is not possible for very tall passengers, adjust the head restraint as high as possible. To raise the head restraint, pull upward on the restraint until it clicks. To lower the restraint, push down on the restraint while holding in the release knob (3). If a head restraint must be removed (for cleaning, replacement, etc.), push in the release knob and pull the head restraint all the way out. WARNING All occupants, including the driver, should not operate a vehicle or sit in a vehicle’s seat until the head restraints are placed in their proper positions in order to minimize the risk of severe injury in the event of a crash. 79K087 Each front seats is equipped with a head restraint. NOTE: It may be necessary to recline the seatback to provide enough overhead clearance to remove the head restraint. 2-20 79K21-03E Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14 BEFORE DRIVING Front Seat Heater (if equipped) EXAMPLE (4) 79K036 To reinstall the head restraint, insert the head restraint bars into the holes (4) and push the head restraint down. 86G064 78K138 With the ignition switch in the “ON” position, push in one or both of the seat heater switches to warm the corresponding seat(s). The indicator light below the switch will also come on. To turn off the seat heater, push in the switch again. The indicator light below the switch will go off. WARNING Improperly using the seat heater can be hazardous. An occupant can suffer burns even if the heating temperature is fairly low, if the occupant is wearing thin pants, a thin skirt or shorts and leaves the heater on for long periods. Avoid using the seat heater for these occupants: • People who have reduced feeling in their legs, including the elderly or those with certain disabilities. • Small children, or anyone with sensitive skin. • People who are asleep or under the influence of alcohol or other drugs which make them tired. 2-21 79K21-03E Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14 BEFORE DRIVING CAUTION To avoid damaging the heater element: • Do not subject the front seats to heavy impacts, such as children jumping on them. • Do not cover the seat with any insulating materials such as blankets or cushions. Rear Seats Seat Adjustment WARNING To avoid excessive seat belt slack, which reduces the effectiveness of the seat belts as a safety device, make sure that the seats are adjusted before the seat belts are fastened. Adjusting Seatbacks WARNING All seatbacks should always be in an upright position when driving, or seat belt effectiveness may be reduced. Seat belts are designed to offer maximum protection when seatbacks are in the upright position. 64J019 To adjust the seatback angle of the rear seats: 1) Pull up the lever on the top of a split folding seat. 2) Move the seatback to one of the lock positions. The number of the lock positions depends on the vehicle specification. 3) Release the lever to lock the seatback in position. After adjustment, try moving the seatback to make sure it is securely locked. 2-22 79K21-03E Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14 BEFORE DRIVING Head Restraints Head restraints are designed to help reduce the risk of neck injuries in case of an accident. Adjust the head restraint to the position which places the center of the head restraint closest to the top of your ears. If this is not possible for very tall passengers, adjust the head restraint as high as possible. EXAMPLE (3) (1) WARNING All occupants, including the driver, should not operate a vehicle or sit in a vehicle’s seat until the head restraints are placed in their proper positions in order to minimize the risk of severe injury in the event of a crash. WARNING All head restraints must be reinstalled to properly protect vehicle occupants. WARNING • Never drive the vehicle with the head restraints removed. • Do not attempt to adjust the head restraint while driving. (2) EXAMPLE 79K088 Your vehicle is equipped with three head restraints on the rear seat. 79K095 (1) Head restraint (2) Bars (3) Release knob To raise the rear head restraint, pull upward on the restraint until it clicks. To lower the restraint, push down on the restraint while holding in the release knob (3). If a head restraint must be removed (for cleaning, replacement, etc.), push in the release knob and pull the head restraint all the way out. When installing a child restraint system, raise the head restraint to the most upper position. 2-23 79K21-03E Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14 BEFORE DRIVING Folding Rear Seats The rear seat(s) of your vehicle can be folded forward to provide additional cargo space. 3) Lower the adjustable head restraint fully. To fold the rear seats forward: 1) Remove the luggage compartment cover. (1) 64J088 64J087 4) Pull the release lever forward on the top of each split seat, and fold the seatbacks forward. 66J211 2) Stow the seat belt buckles of the center and left seating position into the pocket of the seat cushion as shown in the illustration. CAUTION Make sure the belt webbing is not caught by the seat. 5) Pull the lock release strap (1) rearward to unlatch the seat cushion. WARNING When you unlatch the rear seat cushion, be careful that your face or hands are not injured from the seat popping up. CAUTION When you fold the rear seatback forward, stow the seat belt buckles of the center and left seating position into the pocket first. This helps prevent being caught by the seat and being damaged. 2-24 79K21-03E Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14 BEFORE DRIVING WARNING Luggage or other cargo should be stowed in the luggage compartment with the rear seat in an upright position, whenever possible. If you need to carry cargo in the passenger compartment with the rear seat back folded forward, be sure to secure the cargo or it may be thrown about, causing injury. Never pile cargo higher than the seatbacks. (4) 64J089 6) Fold the entire seat forward. 66J196 8) Hook the strap (4) to the front seat head restraint and re-tighten the adjuster to apply a tension on the strap as shown in the illustration. To return the seat to the normal position, follow the procedure below. CAUTION (2) When securing the folded rear seat with a strap, adjust the strap length so that the rear seat will not move. (3) 64J175 66J195 7) Push down the adjuster (2) to make the strap slack, and then unhook the strap by pushing down the hook (3). 1) Unhook the strap from the head restraint and stow the strap to the back of the seat cushion as shown in the illustration. Make sure to adjust the strap length to avoid any slack or twist. 2-25 79K21-03E Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14 BEFORE DRIVING CAUTION • When returning the rear seat cushion to the normal position, make sure that there is nothing around the striker. Any foreign materials prevent the seat cushion from being locked securely. • When returning the rear seat cushion to the normal position, make sure that there is nothing under the seat cushion. This prevents damage to the seat cushion. Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems 64J091 2) Pull down the seat cushion until it locks into place. 65D231S WARNING WARNING When returning the rear seat cushion to the normal position, be careful that your finger is not caught between the lock and the floor. 64J092 3) Raise the seatback until it locks into place. An air bag supplements, or adds to, the frontal crash protection offered by seat belts. The driver and all passengers must be properly restrained by wearing seat belts at all times, whether or not an air bag is mounted at their seating position, to minimize the risk of severe injury or death in the event of a crash. After returning the seat, try moving the seat and seatback to make sure they are securely latched. 2-26 79K21-03E Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14 BEFORE DRIVING Above the pelvis Across the pelvis 65D606 WARNING • Never allow persons to ride in the cargo area of a vehicle. In the event of an accident, there is a much greater risk of injury for persons who are not riding in a seat with their seat belt securely fastened. • Seat belts should always be adjusted as follows: – the lap portion of the belt should be worn low across the pelvis, not across the waist. – the shoulder straps should be worn on the outside shoulder only, and never under the arm. – the shoulder straps should be away from your face and neck, but not falling off your shoulder. (Continued) as low as possible across the hips 65D201 WARNING (Continued) • Seat belts should never be worn with the straps twisted and should be adjusted as tightly as is comfortable to provide the protection for which they have been designed. A slack belt will provide less protection than one which is snug. (Continued) 65D199 WARNING (Continued) • Pregnant women should use seat belts, although specific recommendations about driving should be made by the woman’s medical advisor. Remember that the lap portion of the belt should be worn as low as possible across the hips, as shown in the diagram. • Make sure that each seat belt buckle is inserted into the proper buckle catch. It is possible to cross the buckles in the rear seat. (Continued) 2-27 79K21-03E Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14 BEFORE DRIVING Lap-Shoulder Belt WARNING (Continued) • Do not wear your seat belt over hard or breakable objects in your pockets or on your clothing. If an accident occurs, objects such as glasses, pens, etc. under the seat belt can cause injury. • Never use the same seat belt on more than one occupant and never attach a seat belt over an infant or child being held on an occupant’s lap. Such seat belt use could cause serious injury in the event of an accident. • Periodically inspect seat belt assemblies for excessive wear and damage. Seat belts should be replaced if webbing becomes frayed, contaminated, or damaged in any way. It is essential to replace the entire seat belt assembly after it has been worn in a severe impact, even if damage to the assembly is not obvious. • Children age 12 and under should ride properly restrained in the rear seat, if equipped. (Continued) WARNING (Continued) • Infants and small children should never be transported unless they are properly restrained. Restraint systems for infants and small children can be purchased commercially and should be used. Make sure that the system you purchase meets Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards. Read and follow all the directions provided by the manufacturer. • Avoid contamination of seat belt webbing by polishes, oils, chemicals and particularly battery acid. Cleaning may safely be carried out using mild soap and water. • For children, if the shoulder belt irritates the neck or face, move the child closer to the center of the vehicle. • All seatbacks should always be in an upright position when driving, or seat belt effectiveness may be reduced. Seat belts are designed to offer maximum protection when seatbacks are in the upright position. Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR) The lap-shoulder seat belt has an emergency locking retractor (ELR), which is designed to lock the seat belt only during a sudden stop or impact. It also may lock if you pull the belt across your body very quickly. If this happens, let the belt go back to unlock it, then pull the belt across your body more slowly. Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) The front passenger’s seat belt and the rear seat belts have emergency locking retractors (ELRs) that can be temporarily converted to function as automatic locking retractors (ALRs). The ALR mode should be used if you need to secure a child restraint system in the seat. Refer to the “Child Restraint Systems” section for details. 2-28 79K21-03E Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14 BEFORE DRIVING by pulling the shoulder portion of the belt upward through the latch plate. The length of the diagonal shoulder strap adjusts itself to allow freedom of movement. Safety reminder Sit up straight and fully back Low on hips 60A036 60A038 Low on hips To fasten the seat belt, sit up straight and well back in the seat, pull the latch plate attached to the seat belt across your body and press it into the buckle until you hear a “click”. 60A040 To reduce the risk of sliding under the belt during a collision, position the lap portion of the belt across your lap as low on your hips as possible and adjust it to a snug fit 2-29 79K21-03E Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14 BEFORE DRIVING Seat Belt Reminder Driver’s seat belt reminder light EXAMPLE 78K126 60A039 NOTE: The word “CENTER” is molded into the buckle for the rear seat center belt. The buckles are designed so a latch plate cannot be inserted into the wrong buckle. To unfasten the belt, push the red “PRESS” button on the buckle and allow the belt to retract. 79K117 Front passenger’s seat belt reminder light 66J243 When the driver and front passenger don’t buckle their seat belts, the driver’s seat belt 2-30 79K21-03E Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14 BEFORE DRIVING reminder light in the instrument cluster and the front passenger’s seat belt reminder light in the center of the instrument panel will come on and a buzzer will sound as a reminder to the driver and front passenger to buckle their seat belts. Flow chart Ignition Switch “ON” Seat belt is buckled Seat belt is unbuckled WARNING It is absolutely essential that the driver and passengers wear their seat belts at all times. Persons who are not wearing seat belts have a much greater risk of injury if an accident occurs. Make a regular habit of buckling your seat belt before putting the key in the ignition. The seat belt reminder functions as shown in the figure below. There are some differences between the driver’s seat belt reminder and the front passenger’s seat belt reminder. For more details, refer to the explanation below. No reminder Seat belt is unbuckled Reminder 1 30 sec. Vehicle speed: below 8 km/h Vehicle speed: below 8 km/h Vehicle speed: over 8 km/h Vehicle speed: over 8 km/h Vehicle speed: increase to 8 km/h Reminder 2 3 min. Reminder 3 No reminder 52D219 Reminder 1 – 3 For each reminder 1 – 3, the reminder light comes on for about 20 seconds, then blinks for about 55 seconds. When the reminder light first comes on, a buzzer sounds intermittently for about 6 seconds. 2-31 79K21-03E Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14 BEFORE DRIVING Driver’s seat belt reminder If the driver’s seat belt remains unbuckled with the ignition key in the “ON” position, the driver’s seat belt reminder works as follows: 1) The driver’s seat belt reminder light will come on for about 20 seconds when the ignition key is turned to the “ON” position then will blink for about 55 seconds. When the light comes on, a buzzer will also sound intermittently for about 6 seconds (Reminder 1). 2) If the vehicle is driven (vehicle speed > 8 km/h), Reminder 2 will operate about 30 seconds after Reminder 1 has finished. If the vehicle is not driven (vehicle speed < 8 km/h), Reminder 2 will operate when driving starts (vehicle speed > 8 km/h). 3) Reminder 3 will operate about 3 minutes after Reminder 2 has finished. 4) Even if the driver’s seat belt remains unbuckled after Reminder 3, there will be no further reminders. If the driver has buckled his or her seat belt and later unbuckles the seat belt, the reminder system will be activated from Reminder 1 or Reminder 2 according to the vehicle speed. (Refer to the flow chart.) The driver’s seat belt reminder will be automatically canceled when the driver’s seat belt is buckled or the ignition switch is turned off. Front passenger’s seat belt reminder The front passenger’s seat belt reminder will activate only when there is a passenger sitting in the front seat. In some situations, however, such as when you place heavy objects in the front seat, the seat belt reminder can be activated as if there were a passenger present. The front passenger’s seat belt reminder works in the same manner as the driver’s seat belt reminder, except that it is not activated until 10 seconds after the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position. Shoulder anchor height adjuster (if equipped) EXAMPLE 64J198 Adjust the shoulder anchor height so that the shoulder belt rides on the center of the outside shoulder. To upward, slide the anchor up. To downward, slide the anchor down while pulling the lock knob out. After adjustment, make sure that the anchor is securely locked. WARNING Be sure that the shoulder belt is positioned on the center of the outside shoulder. The belt should be away from your face and neck, but not falling off your shoulder. Misadjustment of the belt could reduce the effectiveness of the safety belt in a crash. 2-32 79K21-03E Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14 BEFORE DRIVING Seat Belt Inspection Child Restraint Systems WARNING EXAMPLE 65D209 Periodically inspect the seat belts to make sure they work properly and are not damaged. Check the webbing, buckles, latch plates, retractors, anchorages and guide loops. Replace any seat belts which do not work properly or are damaged. Be sure to inspect all seat belt assemblies after any collision. Any seat belt assembly which was in use during a collision (other than a very minor one) should be replaced, even if damage to the assembly is not obvious. Any seat belt assembly which was not in use during a collision should be replaced if it does not function properly, it is damaged in any way or the seat belt pretensioners were activated (that is, if the front air bags were activated). 60G332 Infant restraint - rear seat only EXAMPLE 65D202 2-33 79K21-03E Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14 BEFORE DRIVING Infant restraint - rear seat only SUZUKI highly recommends that you use a child restraint system to restrain infants and small children. Many different types of child restraint systems are available; make sure that the restraint system you select meets Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards. 65D584 Booster seat EXAMPLE All child restraint systems are designed to be secured in vehicle seats by either seat belts (lap belts or the lap portion of lapshoulder belts) or by special rigid lower anchor bars built into the seats. Whenever possible, SUZUKI recommends that child restraint systems be installed on the rear seat. According to accident statistics, children are safer when properly restrained in rear seating positions than in front seating positions. If you must use a front-facing child restraint in the front passenger’s seat, be sure to move the front passenger’s seat as far back as possible. WARNING Children could be endangered in a crash if their child restraints are not properly secured in the vehicle. When installing a child restraint system, be sure to follow the instructions below. Be sure to secure the child in the restraint system according to the manufacturer’s instructions. WARNING In an accident or sudden stop, the rear seat armrest (if equipped) could fall forward. If there is a child in a rear-facing child restraint in the center seating position, the falling armrest could injure the child. Make sure the armrest is back in the seat and locked when not in use. 65D203 2-34 79K21-03E Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14 BEFORE DRIVING Installation with Lap-Shoulder Seat Belts (Child Restraint with No Top Strap) 65D607 65D608 WARNING NOTE: There are two types of lap-shoulder belts depending on the vehicle’s specification, A-ELR (Automatic-Emergency Locking Retractor) type and ELR (Emergency Locking Retractor) type. The A-ELR type belts have emergency locking retractors (ELRs) that can be temporarily converted to function as automatic locking retractors (ALRs). The ELR type belts have ELRs that cannot be converted to function as ALRs. To identify the belt is the A-ELR type or the ELR type, slowly pull all of the shoulder webbing out of the retractor. Then let the webbing retract a little and pull it out, and repeat this a few times. If the belt is locked each time you pull the belt, the belt is the A-ELR type. If the belt is not locked, the belt is the ELR type. Do not install a rear-facing child restraint in the front passenger’s seat. If the passenger’s air bag inflates, a child in a rear-facing child restraint could be seriously injured. The back of a rear-facing child restraint would be too close to the inflating air bag. Please note that the methods to secure the child restraint system with the ELR lapshoulder belt and with the A-ELR lapshoulder belt are different. 65D609 CAUTION Before installing a child restraint system in the rear seat, raise the head restraint to the most upper position. 2-35 79K21-03E Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 14 Supplemental Restraint System (air bags): 3, 9, 12 BEFORE DRIVING A-ELR type belt ELR type belt EXAMPLE A-ELR type EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 65D233 Install your child restraint system according to the instructions provided by the child restraint system manufacturer. Make sure that the seat belt is securely latched. Try to move the child restraint system in all directions to make sure it is securely installed. 83E031 Install your child restraint system according to the instructions provided by the child restraint system manufacturer. If you install the child restraint system in the front seat, be sure to slide the seat to the rearmost position. After making sure that the seat belt is securely latched: 83E035 1) Pull all of the remaining webbing out of the retractor. You will hear a click, which means that the emergency locking retractor (ELR) has converted to function as an automatic locking retractor (ALR). 2-36 79K21-03E Supplemental Restraint System (air bags): 3, 9, 12 BEFORE DRIVING A-ELR type A-ELR type EXAMPLE A-ELR type EXAMPLE EXAMPLE Move to check 83E032 83E036 2) Allow the extra webbing to retract, and pull the webbing toward the retractor to take up any slack. Make sure that the lap portion of the belt is tight around the child restraint system and the shoulder portion of the belt is positioned so that it cannot interfere with the child’s head or neck. 3) Make sure that the retractor has converted to the ALR mode by trying to pull webbing out of the retractor. If the retractor is in the ALR mode, the belt will be locked. 65D234 A-ELR type EXAMPLE Pull to tighten WARNING If the retractor is not in the ALR mode, the child restraint system can move or tip over when your vehicle turns or stops abruptly. 65D235 4) Try moving the child restraint system in all directions, to make sure it is securely installed. If you need to tighten the belt, pull more webbing toward the retractor. 2-37 79K21-03E Supplemental Restraint System (air bags): 3, 9, 12 BEFORE DRIVING Installation with the LATCH System To revert from ALR to ELR EXAMPLE and Tethers for Children.) The anchors are located where the rear of the seat cushion meets the bottom of the seatback. Install a LATCH-type child restraint system according to the instructions provided by the child restraint system manufacturer. After installing the child restraint system, try moving it in all directions, especially forward to make sure the flexible straps or rigid connecting bars are securely latched to the anchors. Rigid lower connecting bar type 65D267 When you unbuckle the seat belt and allow it to retract to a certain length, the retractor will automatically revert back to the normal ELR mode. Flexible lower connecting strap type 66J162 Rear seat NOTE: Although there are three second row seating positions, you cannot install three LATCH type child restraints in the rear seat. You can install one or two LATCH restraint(s). Be sure to install the LATCH type child restraint(s) in the outboard seating positions. If your LATCH restraint has flexible lower connecting straps, these general instructions apply: 1) If possible, fold the seatback rearward for easier installation. 2) Place the child restraint in the rear seat. 64J027 Your vehicle is equipped with lower anchors for securing up to two standard LATCH-type child restraints in the rear seats. (LATCH stands for Lower Anchors 2-38 79K21-03E Supplemental Restraint System (air bags): 3, 9, 12 BEFORE DRIVING owner’s manual. Attach the top tether strap, if applicable. EXAMPLE EXAMPLE If your LATCH restraint has rigid lower connecting bars, these general instructions apply: 1) If possible, fold the seatback rearward for easier installation. 2) Place the child restraint in the rear seat, inserting the connecting bars through the slots in the seat cushion or the slots in the seatback bottom. EXAMPLE 65D340 3) Snap the strap hooks to the anchors. Take care not to pinch your fingers. 65D342 5) Make sure the child restraint is securely fastened by trying to move the child restraint system in all directions, especially forward. EXAMPLE WARNING The seatback should always be securely latched in a fairly upright position when any type of child seat is installed. An unlatched or reclined seatback will reduce the intended effectiveness of the child restraint system. 54G183 3) Use your hands to carefully align the connecting bar tips with the anchors. Take care not to pinch your fingers. 65D341 4) Return the seatback to the normal, upright position. Tighten the lower straps as described in the child restraint 2-39 79K21-03E Supplemental Restraint System (air bags): 3, 9, 12 BEFORE DRIVING EXAMPLE Installation-Child Restraint with Top Strap EXAMPLE Rear seat EXAMPLE Front 54G184 54G185 4) Push the child restraint toward the anchors so that the connecting bar tips are partially hooked to the anchors. Use your hands to confirm the position. 5) Grasp the front of the child restraint and push the child restraint forcefully to latch the connecting bars. Make sure they are securely latched by trying to move the child restraint system in all directions, especially forward. 6) Return the seatback if folded. Attach the top tether strap, if applicable. WARNING The seatback should always be securely latched in a fairly upright position when any type of child seat is installed. An unlatched or reclined seatback will reduce the intended effectiveness of the child restraint system. 79K026 Some child restraint systems require the use of a top strap. Top strap anchor brackets are located on the back of the rear seat as shown in the illustration. Install the child restraint system as follows: 1) Remove the luggage compartment cover. 2) Secure the child restraint on the rear seat using the procedure described above for securing a restraint system that does not require a top strap. 3) Hook the top strap to the anchor bracket and tighten the top strap according to the instructions provided by the child restraint system manufacturer. Be sure to attach the top strap to the corresponding anchor located directly behind the child restraint. Do 2-40 79K21-03E Supplemental Restraint System (air bags): 3, 9, 12 BEFORE DRIVING not attach the top strap to the luggage restraint loops (if equipped). WARNING Do not attach the child restraint top strap to the luggage restraint loops (if equipped). Incorrectly attached top strap will reduce the intended effectiveness of the child restraint system. how to raise or lower the head restraint.) 5) Make sure that cargo does not interfere with routing of the top strap. Seat Belt Extender Type 1 65D613 (1) Center of body (2) Less than 152 mm (6 inches) (3) Open end of extender buckle Type 2 86G032 4) When routing the top strap, be sure to pass it between the head restraint and the rear seatback as shown. (Refer to “Head Restraints” section for details on If a seat belt cannot be fastened securely because it is not long enough, see your authorized SUZUKI dealer for a seat belt extender. Seat belt extenders are available for each seating position except for the rear center position. After inspecting the relationship between the seat belt length, the occupant’s body size, and the seat adjustment (the driver’s seat should always be adjusted as far back as possible while still maintaining control of the vehicle, and other adjustable seats should be adjusted as far back as possible), your dealer can select the appropriate seat belt extender. • A seat belt extender should only be used for the person, vehicle and seating location it was provided for. • When using the extender, ensure that both ends are latched securely. Do not use the extender if the open end of the extender’s buckle is within 152 mm (6 inches) of the center of the occupant’s body (See diagram). Use of the extender when the buckle is too close to the center of the body could increase the risk of abdominal injury in the event of an accident, and could cause the shoulder belt to be positioned incorrectly. • Make sure to use the correct buckle corresponding to your seating position. • Seat belt extenders are not intended for use by pregnant women, and should only be used upon approval by their medical advisors. • Remove and stow the extender when it is not being used. 2-41 79K21-03E Supplemental Restraint System (air bags): 3, 9, 12 BEFORE DRIVING WARNING Seat Belt Pretensioner System (for front seat belt only) sensors and the electronic controller of the air bag system also control the seat belt pretensioners. The pretensioners are triggered only when the air bags are triggered and the seat belts are fastened. If the seat belts are not fastened, the respective pretensioner system will not be activated. For precautions and general information including servicing the pretensioner system, refer to the “Supplemental Restraint System (air bags)” section in addition to this “Seat Belt Pretensioner System” section, and follow all those precautions. Failure to follow these instructions may increase the risk of injury in a crash. • Only use an extender for the person, vehicle and seating position it was provided for. • Do not use if open end of extender’s buckle is within 152 mm (6 inches) of center of occupant’s body (See diagram). • Remove and stow the extender when it is not being used. 52D011 WARNING This section of the owner’s manual describes your SUZUKI’s SEAT BELT PRETENSIONER SYSTEM. Please read and follow ALL these instructions carefully to minimize your risk of severe injury or death. Your vehicle is equipped with a seat belt pretensioner system at the front seating positions. You can use the pretensioner seat belts in the same manner as ordinary seat belts. The seat belt pretensioner system works with the SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (advanced air bags). The crash The pretensioner is located in each front seat belt retractor. The pretensioner tightens the seat belt in the event of a frontal crash or a rollover. The retractors will remain locked after the pretensioners are activated. Upon activation, some noise will occur and some smoke may be released. These conditions are not harmful and do not indicate a fire in the vehicle. The driver and all passengers must be properly restrained by wearing seat belts at all times, whether or not a pretensioner is equipped at their seating position, to help minimize the risk of severe injury or death in the event of a frontal crash or a rollover. Sit fully back in the seat; sit up straight; do not lean forward or sideways. Adjust the belt so the lap portion of the belt is worn low across the pelvis, not across the waist. Please refer to the “Seat Adjustment” sec- 2-42 79K21-03E Supplemental Restraint System (air bags): 3, 9, 12 BEFORE DRIVING tion and the instructions and precautions about the seat belts in this “Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems” section for details on proper seat and seat belt adjustments. Please note that the pretensioners along with the front air bags will activate in severe frontal collisions. Also, the pretensioners along with the side curtain air bags will activate in severe rollovers. They are not designed to activate in rear impacts, side impacts, or minor frontal collisions. The pretensioners can be activated only once. If the pretensioners are activated (that is, if the front air bags and/or the side curtain air bags are activated), have the pretensioner system serviced by an authorized SUZUKI dealer as soon as possible. If the “AIR BAG” light on the instrument cluster does not blink or come on briefly when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position, stays on for more than 10 seconds, or comes on while driving, the pretensioner system or the air bag system may not work properly. Have both systems inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer as soon as possible. Service on or around the pretensioner system components or wiring must be performed only by an authorized SUZUKI dealer who is specially trained. Improper service could result in unintended activation of pretensioners or could render the pretensioner inoperative. Either of these two conditions may result in personal injury. To prevent damage or unintended activation of the pretensioners, be sure the battery is disconnected and the ignition switch has been in the “LOCK” position for at least 90 seconds before performing any electrical service work on your SUZUKI. Do not touch pretensioner system components or wiring. The wires are wrapped with yellow tape or yellow tubing, and the couplers are yellow. When scrapping your SUZUKI, ask your SUZUKI dealer, body repair shop or scrap yard for assistance. Supplemental Restraint System (air bags) EXAMPLE 54G022 WARNING This section of the owner’s manual describes the protection provided by your SUZUKI’s SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (air bags). Please read and follow ALL these instructions carefully to minimize your risk of severe injury or death in the event of a collision. Your vehicle has advanced front air bags and side air bags for the driver and right front passenger. Your vehicle also has side curtain air bags. 2-43 79K21-03E Supplemental Restraint System (air bags): 3, 9, 12 BEFORE DRIVING 9 7 2 11 10 8 3 4 66J132 6 8 Your vehicle is equipped with a Supplemental Restraint System consisting of the following components in addition to a lapshoulder belt at each front seating position. 5 3 10 79K137 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. Driver’s front air bag Front passenger’s front air bag Seat belt pretensioners Air bag controller Occupant classification module “PASS AIR BAG OFF” indicator Forward crash sensor Side air bags Side curtain air bags Side crash sensor Front passenger’s sensor mat 2-44 79K21-03E Supplemental Restraint System (air bags): 3, 9, 12 BEFORE DRIVING Front Air Bags dashboard. The words “SRS AIRBAG” are molded into the air bag covers to identify the location of the air bags. EXAMPLE Frontal collision range 63J030 If the “AIR BAG” light on the instrument cluster does not blink or come on when the ignition switch is first turned to the “ON” position, or the “AIR BAG” light stays on, or comes on while driving, the air bag system (or the seat belt pretensioner system) may not work properly. Have the air bag system inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer as soon as possible. 63J259 EXAMPLE 60G032 Front air bags are designed to inflate only in severe frontal collisions. 78K128 The driver’s front air bag is located behind the center pad of the steering wheel and the front passenger’s front air bag is located behind the passenger’s side of the 2-45 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING Front air bags will not inflate Front air bags are not designed to inflate in rear impacts, side impacts, rollovers or minor frontal collisions, since they would offer no protection in those types of accidents. Remember, since air bags deploy only one time during an accident, seat belts are needed to restrain occupants from further movements during the accident. Side Air Bags and Side Curtain Air Bags EXAMPLE Therefore, an air bag is NOT a substitute for seat belts. To maximize your protection, ALWAYS WEAR YOUR SEAT BELTS. Be aware that no system can prevent all possible injuries that may occur in an accident. 65D236 Front air bags will probably not inflate WARNING 68KM090 An air bag supplements, or adds to, the crash protection offered by seat belts. The driver and all passengers must be properly restrained by wearing seat belts at all times, whether or not air bags are mounted at their seating position, to minimize the risk of severe injury or death in the event of a crash. 65D237 Your vehicle has “dual stage” front air bags, which adjust the air bag inflation force according to crash severity. Also, your vehicle has a front passenger sensing system, which turns off the front passenger’s air bag and seat belt pretensioner under certain conditions. 78K037 Side air bags are located in the part of the front seatbacks closest to the doors. The words “SRS AIRBAG” are molded into the 2-46 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING side air bag cover to identify the location of the side air bags. Side air bags will not inflate Side collision range 64J036 64J034 Side curtain air bags are located in the roof lining. The words “SRS AIRBAG” are molded into the pillar to identify the location of the side curtain air bags. Side air bags are designed to inflate only in severe side impact collisions. Side curtain air bags are designed to inflate in severe side impact collisions and/ or rollovers. 54G027 Side curtain air bags will not inflate 79K037 2-47 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING Side air bags and side curtain air bags will probably not inflate Front Passenger Sensing System WARNING An air bag supplements, or adds to, the crash protection offered by seat belts. The driver and all passengers must be properly restrained by wearing seat belts at all times, whether or not air bags are mounted at their seating position, to minimize the risk of severe injury or death in the event of a crash. WARNING 54G028 Side air bags and side curtain air bags are not designed to inflate in frontal or rear collisions or minor side collisions, since they would offer no protection in these types of accidents. In a severe side impact, only the side air bag and side curtain air bag on the side of the vehicle that is struck will inflate. In a severe rollover, the side curtain air bags on both sides of the vehicle will inflate. Remember, since an air bag deploys only one time during an accident, seat belts are needed to restrain occupants from further movements during the accident. If the “AIR BAG” light in the instrument cluster ever comes on and stays on, it means that something may be wrong with the air bag system. If this ever happens, have the vehicle serviced immediately, because the air bags may not offer the protection for which they were designed. The front passenger sensing system will turn off the front passenger’s front air bag and seat belt pretensioner under certain conditions. This system works using a sensor mat that is part of the front passenger’s seat. The front passenger sensing system is designed to detect whether an occupant is present in the seat and, if an occupant is present, to determine whether the front passenger’s front air bag and seat belt pretensioner should be enabled or disabled (turned off). NOTE: The front passenger’s side air bag and the side curtain air bag are not controlled by the front passenger sensing system. Therefore, an air bag is NOT a substitute for seat belts. To maximize your protection, ALWAYS WEAR YOUR SEAT BELTS. Be aware that no system can prevent all possible injuries that may occur in an accident. 2-48 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING “PASS AIR BAG OFF” Indicator 66J244 The “PASS AIR BAG OFF” indicator is located on the center of the instrument panel. When the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position, the “PASS AIR BAG OFF” indicator comes on for several seconds to let you know the system is working. When the front passenger sensing system has turned off the front passenger’s front air bag including the seat belt pretensioner, the “PASS AIR BAG OFF” indicator will come on and stay on to remind you that the front passenger’s front air bag is off. The front passenger sensing system uses front seat pressure measurements and pressure locations to determine whether to activate or deactivate the front passenger’s front air bag. The front passenger sensing system may or may not turn off the front air bag, depending on the front passenger’s seating posture and body build. The air bag should be turned off in the following situations: • There is no occupant in the front passenger seat. • The occupant of the front passenger seat lifts his or her weight off of the seat for a period of time. • The occupant of the front passenger seat is an infant or small child in a child restraint system or a small child in a booster seat. • A smaller person, such as a child who has outgrown child restraints or a very small adolescent is seated in the front passenger seat. ing the vehicle, the “PASS AIR BAG OFF” indicator is still not lit, check to make sure that the vehicle’s seatback is not pressing the child restraint into the seat cushion. If this happens, slightly recline the vehicle’s seatback and adjust the seat cushion if possible. Also make sure the child restraint is not trapped under the vehicle head restraint. If this happens, adjust the head restraint. If the “PASS AIR BAG OFF” indicator is still not on, secure the child in the child restraint or booster seat in a rear seat position in the vehicle and check with your dealer. NOTE: If the front passenger seat is unoccupied, the “PASS AIR BAG OFF” indicator will not come on but the front passenger’s front air bag will not deploy and the seat belt pretensioner will not operate. If you have secured a child in the front passenger seat in a forward-facing child restraint system or booster seat and the “PASS AIR BAG OFF” indicator light is not on, turn the vehicle off, remove the child restraint or booster seat from the vehicle and reinstall it following the child restraint or booster seat manufacturer’s directions. Also refer to “Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems” in this section. If, after reinstalling the child restraint and restart- 2-49 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING front air bag when the system senses a properly-seated adult in the front passenger’s seat. When the passenger sensing system has allowed the air bag to be enabled, the “PASS AIR BAG OFF” indicator will remain off to remind you that the air bag is active. 65D607 WARNING Do not install a rear-facing child restraint in the front passenger’s seat. If the passenger’s front air bag inflates, a child in a rear-facing child restraint could be seriously injured. The back of a rear-facing child restraint would be too close to the inflating air bag. According to accident statistics, children are safer when properly restrained in rear seating positions than in front seating positions. Whenever possible, SUZUKI recommends you install child restraints in the rear seat. If a person of adult size is sitting in the front passenger’s seat and the “PASS AIR BAG OFF” indicator comes on, it could be because that person isn’t sitting properly in the seat. If this happens, unfasten the seat belts, sit upright in the center of the seat with the seatback nearly vertical and your legs outstretched, and refasten the seat belt. 52D258 When seated as shown in the above illustration, the front passenger sensing system senses a properly-seated occupant and enables the air bag. When using a seat belt extender, follow the instructions in the “Seat Belt Extender” section. WARNING Do not place any heavy objects on the front passenger’s seat. The pressure sensors in the sensor mat could be damaged and the front passenger sensing system may not work properly. The front passenger sensing system is designed to enable the front passenger’s 2-50 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING How the System Works WARNING The front passenger sensing system may not work properly in the following situations: • The occupant is sitting near the dashboard or is not sitting in the proper position. • Objects placed under the seat are pushing up on the seat cushion. WARNING If the “PASS AIR BAG OFF” indicator on the instrument panel turns on even though there is no occupant or an adult occupant in the front passenger’s seat, it means that something may be wrong with the passenger sensing system. Have the system inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer as soon as possible. WARNING • Do not spill any liquids on the seat. Liquids can damage the sensors under the front seat. • Have front passenger’s sensor mat inspected by your dealer after a collision. • Do not replace the front seats. If you replace them, the air bags and front passenger sensing system may not work properly. • Do not use a seat cover. If you use a seat cover, the front passenger sensing system may not work properly. In a frontal collision, the crash sensors will detect rapid deceleration and send a signal to the controller. If the controller judges that the deceleration represents a severe frontal crash, the controller will trigger the inflators. The controller also judges: • Whether the front air bags should deploy at reduced power or at full power according to crash severity. • Whether the front passenger’s front air bag should deploy or not based on classification of the occupant of the front passenger’s seat. Since your vehicle is equipped with side air bags, and side curtain air bags, crash sensors will detect a side collision, and if the controller judges that the side collision is severe enough, it will trigger the side air bag and side curtain air bag inflators. Your vehicle also has rollover sensors that work with the controller to predict whether a rollover may occur and if the controller judges that a severe rollover is about to occur, it triggers the side curtain air bag inflators on both sides of the vehicle. The inflators inflate the appropriate air bags with nitrogen or argon gas. The inflated air bags provide a cushion for your head (front air bags and side curtain air bags only) and upper body. The air bag inflates and deflates so quickly that you may not even realize that it has activated. 2-51 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING The air bag will neither hinder your view nor make it harder to exit the vehicle. Air bags must inflate quickly and forcefully in order to reduce the chance of serious or fatal injuries. However, an unavoidable consequence of the quick inflation is that the air bag may irritate bare skin, such as the facial area against a front air bag. Also, upon inflation, a loud noise will occur and some powder and smoke will be released. These conditions are not harmful and do not indicate a fire in the car. Be aware, however, that some air bag components may be hot for a while after inflation. WARNING 65D610 A seat belt helps keep you in the proper position for maximum protection when an air bag inflates. Adjust your seat as far back as possible while still maintaining control of the vehicle. Sit fully back in your seat; sit up straight; do not lean over the steering wheel or dashboard. Front occupants should not lean on or sleep against the door. Please refer to the “Seat Adjustment” section and the “Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems” section in the “BEFORE DRIVING” section for details on proper seat and seat belt adjustments. • The driver should not lean over the steering wheel. The front passenger should not rest his or her body against the dashboard, or otherwise get too close to the dashboard. For vehicles with side air bags and side curtain air bags, occupants should not lean on or sleep against the door. In these situations, the out-of-position occupant would be too close to an inflating air bag, and may suffer severe injury. • Do not attach any objects to, or place any objects over, the steering wheel or dashboard. Do not place any objects between the air bag and the driver or front passenger. These objects may interfere with air bag operation or may be propelled by the air bag in the event of a crash. Either of these conditions may cause severe injury. (Continued) 54G582 2-52 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING Servicing the Air Bag System WARNING (Continued) • For vehicles with side air bags, do not place seat covers on the front seats, because seat covers could restrict the air bag’s inflation. Also, do not place any cup holders or other objects on the door, as these objects could be propelled by the air bag in the event of a crash. Either of these conditions may cause severe injury. Note that even though your vehicle may be moderately damaged in a collision, the collision may not have been severe enough to trigger the front, side, or side curtain air bags to inflate. If your car sustains ANY front-end or side damage, have the air bag system inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer to ensure it is in proper working order. Your vehicle is equipped with a diagnostic module which records information about the air bag system if the air bags deploy in a crash. The module records information about overall system status, which sensors activated the deployment, and whether the front seat belts were in use. If the air bags inflate, have the air bags and related components replaced by an authorized SUZUKI dealer as soon as possible. If your vehicle ever gets in deep water and the driver’s floor is submerged, the air bag controller could be damaged. If this happens, have the air bag system inspected by the SUZUKI dealer as soon as possible. Special procedures are required for servicing or replacing an air bag. For that reason, only an authorized SUZUKI dealer should be allowed to service or replace your air bags. Please remind anyone who services your SUZUKI that it has air bags. Service on or around air bag components or wiring must be performed only by an authorized SUZUKI dealer. Improper service could result in unintended air bag deployment or could render the air bags inoperative. Either of these two conditions may result in severe injury. To prevent damage or unintended inflation of the air bag system, be sure the battery is disconnected and the ignition switch has been in the “LOCK” position for at least 90 seconds before performing any electrical service work on your SUZUKI. Do not touch air bag system components or wires. The wires are wrapped with yellow tape or yellow tubing, and the couplers are yellow for easy identification. Scrapping a car that has an undeployed air bag can be hazardous. Ask your dealer, body repair shop or scrap yard for help with disposal. If it is necessary to modify the advanced front air bag system to accommodate a person with disabilities, owners in the continental United States can call American Suzuki toll-free at 1-800-934-0934, or write to: American Suzuki Motor Corporation Automotive Customer Relations 3251 East Imperial Highway Brea, CA 92821-6795 If you purchased your SUZUKI in Canada please contact the Suzuki Canada Customer Relations Department by telephone at 1-905-889-2677 extension 2254 or in writing at: Suzuki Canada Inc. Customer Relations 100 East Beaver Creek Road Richmond Hill, On L4B 1J6 2-53 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING Instrument Cluster 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. Speedometer Tachometer Fuel gauge Temperature gauge Information display MODE/ILL knob TRIP knob Warning and indicator lights EXAMPLE 2 1 8 7 5 3 6 8 4 79K118 2-54 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING Warning and Indicator Lights Front Passenger’s Seat Belt Reminder Light For details about the seat belt reminder, refer to “Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems” in this section. Low Tire Pressure Warning Light WARNING It is absolutely essential that the driver and passengers wear their seat belts at all times. Persons who are not wearing seat belts have a much greater risk of injury if an accident occurs. Make a regular habit of buckling your seat belt before putting the key in the ignition. 66J246 The front passenger’s seat belt reminder light is located in the center of the instrument panel. If there is a passenger in the front seat and the front passenger’s seat belt is unbuckled about 10 seconds after the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position, this light will come on and then blink. When the light comes on, a buzzer will also sound intermittently for about 6 seconds. The reminder will repeat several times under certain conditions until the front passenger’s seat belt is buckled. After repeating several times, the reminder will be canceled even if the front passenger’s seat belt remains unbuckled. 52D305 As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with a tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) that uses a low tire pressure warning light to inform you when one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated. When the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position, the low tire pressure warning light comes on briefly so you can check that the light is working. When the low tire pressure warning light is lit, one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated. You should stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure as indicated on the vehicle’s tire information placard. Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle’s handling and stopping ability. Each tire, including the spare, should be checked at least once a month when cold and set to the recommended 2-55 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING inflation pressure as specified in the vehicle placard and owner’s manual. The low tire pressure warning light is also used to inform you of a TPMS malfunction. When the system detects a malfunction, this light will flash for approximately one minute and then remain continuously illuminated. This sequence will be repeated approximately ten minutes after subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists. NOTE: The low tire pressure warning light may not come on immediately if you have a sudden loss of air pressure. WARNING If the low tire pressure warning light does not come on when the ignition is turned to the “ON” position, or comes on and blinks while driving there may be a problem with the tire pressure monitoring system. Have your vehicle inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer. Even if the light turns off after blinking, indicating that the monitoring system has recovered, make sure to have an authorized SUZUKI dealer check the system. WARNING The load rating of your tires is reduced at lower inflation pressures. If your tires become even moderately under-inflated, the vehicle load may exceed the load rating of the tires, which can lead to tire failure. The low tire pressure warning light will not alert you of this condition. The warning light will only come on when one or more of your tires become significantly under-inflated. Check and adjust your tire inflation pressure at least once a month. Refer to “Tires” in the “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section. WARNING If the low tire pressure warning light comes on and stays on, reduce your speed and avoid abrupt steering and braking. Stop in a safe place as soon as possible and check your tires. • If you have a flat tire, replace it with the spare tire. Refer to “Jacking Instructions” in the “EMERGENCY SERVICE” section. Refer to “Replacing Tires and/or Wheels” for instructions on how to restore normal operation of the tire pressure monitoring system after you have had a flat tire. • If one or more of your tires is under-inflated, adjust the inflation pressure in all of your tires to the recommended inflation pressure as soon as possible. Be aware that driving on a significantly under-inflated tire can cause the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure, and may affect steering control and brake effectiveness. This could lead to an accident, resulting in severe injury or death. Refer to “Tire Pressure Monitoring System” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section for additional details on the tire pressure monitoring system. Refer to “Tires” in the “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” 2-56 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING section for information on maintaining proper tire pressure. WARNING Remember that stopping distance may be longer, you may have to push harder on the pedal, and the pedal may go down farther than normal. Brake System Warning Light 65D477 This light comes on briefly when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position. The light also comes on under the following conditions: 1) when the parking brake is engaged, and 2) when the fluid in the brake fluid reservoir falls below the specified level. The light should go out after fully releasing the parking brake, if the fluid level in the brake fluid reservoir is adequate. If the brake system warning light comes on while you are driving the vehicle, it may mean that there is something wrong with the vehicle’s brake system. If this happens, you should: 1) Pull off the road and stop carefully. NOTE: Because the disc brake system is selfadjusting, the fluid level will drop as the brake pads become worn. Replenishing the brake fluid reservoir is considered normal periodic maintenance. 2) Test the brakes by carefully starting and stopping on the shoulder of the road. 3) If you determine that it is safe, drive cautiously at low speed to the nearest dealer for repairs, or 4) Have the vehicle towed to the nearest dealer for repairs. WARNING If any of the following conditions occur, you should immediately ask your SUZUKI dealer to inspect the brake system. • If the brake system warning light does not go out after the parking brake has been fully released. • If the brake system warning light does not come on when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position. • If the brake system warning light comes on at any time during vehicle operation. 2-57 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Warning Light details on how to reactivate the ESP® systems, refer to “SLIP Indicator Light” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section. SLIP Indicator Light For details of the ESP® systems, refer to “Electronic Stability Program (ESP®)” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section. 79K019 65D529 When the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position, the light comes on briefly so you can check that the light is working. If the light stays on, or comes on when driving, there may be something wrong with the ABS. If the ABS light and the brake system warning light stay on, or come on simultaneously when driving, then there may be something wrong with both the rear brake proportioning valve function and anti-lock function of the ABS system. If one of these happens, have the system inspected by your SUZUKI dealer. If the ABS becomes inoperative, the brake system will function as an ordinary brake system that has no ABS. For details of the ABS, refer to “Anti-Lock Brake system (ABS)” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section. ESP® is a registered trademark of Daimler AG. WARNING The ESP® systems cannot prevent accidents. Always drive carefully. This light blinks 5 times per second when one of the following systems is activated. • Stability control system • Traction control system • Hill descent control system (if equipped) If this light blinks, drive carefully. When the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position, the light comes on briefly so you can check that the light is working. If the light stays on, or comes on when driving and remains on, there may be something wrong with the ESP® systems (other than ABS). You should have the system inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer. NOTE: When you disconnect and re-connect the battery, ESP® system functions other than ABS will be deactivated and the slip indicator light will blink 1 time per second. For 2-58 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING “ESP” (Electronic Stability Program) Warning Light “ESP OFF” Indicator Light systems (other than ABS) will turn on automatically and the light will go out. • If your vehicle is equipped with a hill descent control system and a hill hold control system, these systems will not be turned off when the “ESP OFF” switch is pushed to turn off the ESP® systems. 66J032 66J031 When the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position, the light comes on briefly so you can check that the light is working. If the light stays on, or comes on when driving, there may be something wrong with the ESP® systems (other than ABS). You should have the system inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer. For details of the ESP® systems, refer to “Electronic Stability Program (ESP®)” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section. NOTE: The information display shows the warning and indicator message when this light comes on. When the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position, this light comes on briefly so you can check that the light is working. For details of the ESP® systems, refer to “Electronic Stability Program (ESP®)” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section. When the “ESP OFF” switch is pushed to turn off the ESP® systems (other than ABS), the “ESP OFF” light comes on and stays on. NOTE: • If the vehicle speed is greater than approximately 30 km/h (19 mph), the ESP® systems (other than ABS) will turn on automatically and the light will go out. • When the transfer switch (if equipped) is turned to the “4L LOCK” position, the ESP® systems (other than ABS) will be canceled automatically. The light will come on and stay on. • If the ESP® systems operate continuously such as when driving on slippery roads, the traction control functions of the ESP® systems may be canceled temporarily to avoid overheating the brake pads, and the light will come on. After a short period of time, the ESP® 2-59 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING Hill descent control Indicator Light Oil Pressure Light Charging Light 79K050 50G051 50G052 When the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position, this light comes on briefly so you can check that the light is working. This light comes on when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position, and goes out when the engine is started. The light will come on and remain on if there is insufficient oil pressure. If the light comes on when driving, pull off the road as soon as you can and stop the engine. Check the oil level and add oil if necessary. If there is enough oil, the lubrication system should be inspected by your SUZUKI dealer before you drive the vehicle again. This light comes on when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position, and goes out when the engine is started. The light will come on and remain on if there is something wrong with the battery charging system. If the light comes on when the engine is running, the charging system should be inspected immediately by your SUZUKI dealer. When you push the hill descent control switch and the hill descent control operating conditions are fulfilled, the hill descent control indicator comes on. If the hill descent control indicator blinks, the hill descent control will not be activated. For details of the hill descent control system, refer to “Hill descent control System” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section. CAUTION • If you operate the engine with this light on, severe engine damage can result. • Do not rely on the Oil Pressure Light to indicate the need to add oil. Be sure to periodically check the engine oil level. 2-60 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING Driver’s Seat Belt Reminder Light “AIR BAG” Light Malfunction Indicator Light 60G049 63J030 65D530 If the driver’s seat belt is unbuckled when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position, this light will come on and then blink. When the light comes on, a buzzer will also sound intermittently for about 6 seconds. The reminder will repeat several times under certain conditions until the driver’s seat belt is buckled. After repeating several times, the reminder will be canceled even if the driver’s seat belt remains unbuckled. This light monitors inflators, crash sensors, seat belt pretensioners, the front passenger sensing system, and corresponding electrical circuits. This light blinks for several seconds when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position so you can check if the light is working. The light will come on and stay on if there is a problem in the air bag system or the seat belt pretensioner system. Your vehicle has a computer-controlled emission control system. A malfunction indicator light is provided on the instrument panel to indicate when it is necessary to have the emission control system serviced. The malfunction indicator light comes on when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position to let you know the light is working and goes out when the engine is started. For details about the seat belt reminder, refer to “Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems” in this section. WARNING It is absolutely essential that the driver and passengers wear their seat belts at all times. Persons who are not wearing seat belts have a much greater risk of injury if an accident occurs. Make a regular habit of buckling your seat belt before putting the key in the ignition. WARNING If the “AIR BAG” light does not blink when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position or stays on or comes on when driving, the air bag system or the seat belt pretensioner system (if equipped) may not work properly. Have both systems inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer. If the malfunction indicator light comes on or blinks when the engine is running, service to the emission control system is necessary. Bring the vehicle to your SUZUKI dealer to have the emission control system serviced right away and avoid hard acceleration until the service is performed. CAUTION Continuing to drive the vehicle when the malfunction indicator light is on or blinking can cause permanent damage to the vehicle’s emission control system, and can affect fuel economy and driveability. 2-61 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING NOTE: If the fuel filler cap is not installed fully, the electrical system gets wet (such as by driving through a deep puddle of water) or the fuel tank gets nearly empty, the malfunction indicator lamp may come on. If so, the lamp will go off after driving a few times after the fuel filler cap is installed fully, the electrical system dries out or the fuel tank is filled. Low Fuel Warning Light Open Door Warning Light “CRUISE” Indicator Light (if equipped) 54G391 This light remains on until all doors (including the tailgate) are completely closed. NOTE: The information display shows the warning and indicator message when this light comes on. 52D113 When the cruise control system is on, this light will be on. “SET” Indicator Light (if equipped) 54G343 If this light comes on, fill the fuel tank immediately. NOTE: The activation point of this light varies depending on road conditions (for example, slope or curve) and driving conditions because of fuel moving in the tank. 65D474 When the vehicle’s speed is controlled by the cruise control system, this light will be on. NOTE: The information display shows the warning and indicator message when this light comes on. 2-62 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING Keyless Start System Indicator Light (if equipped) Turn Signal Indicators Daytime Running Light (D.R.L.) Indicator Light (if equipped) 50G055 62J041 When you push the ignition switch for vehicle with the keyless start system, this light will come on in blue or red. If this light comes on in blue, you can turn the ignition switch without using an ignition key. If this light comes on in red, you cannot turn the ignition switch without using an ignition key. For details, refer to “Ignition Switch” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section. When you turn on the left or right turn signals, the corresponding green arrow on the instrument panel will flash along with the respective turn signal lights. When you turn on the hazard warning switch, both arrows will flash along with all of the turn signal lights. High Beam Indicator Light If this light blinks in red, it reminds you that the remote controller is not in the vehicle. For details, refer to “Keyless Start System Remote Controller/Keyless Entry System Transmitter” in this section. 60B245 With the D.R.L. system, the headlights light, but are dimmer than the low beam, when the following three conditions are all met. Whenever the D.R.L. system is operating, the D.R.L. indicator light remains on. Conditions for D.R.L. system operation 1) The engine is running. 2) The parking brake is released. 3) The headlights are off, or the lighting switch is in the “AUTO” position and it is light around the light sensor. 50G056 This indicator comes on when headlight high beams are turned on. 2-63 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING Illumination Indicator Light Transfer Position Indicator Light (if equipped) NOTE: The information display shows the warning and indicator message when the transfer system is operated, or has a problem. 64J045 This indicator light comes on while the position lights, tail lights and/or the headlights are on. If the indicators (all lights) continue to blink, there is a problem in the transfer system and you should have your vehicle inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer. Master Warning Indicator Light (1) (2) (3) 64J044 These indicators show the 4WD operating mode as described below. When the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position, these lights come on briefly to let you know that the lights are working. (1): Neutral (2): 4-wheel drive high range center differential lock mode (2) & (3): 4-wheel drive low range center differential lock mode No indicators: 4-wheel drive high range mode 78K049 This light blinks or comes on for several seconds when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position so you can check if the light is working. When the information display shows warning and indicator messages, this indicator light may also come on or blink. For details, refer to “Information Display” in this section. For details, refer to “Using the Transfer Switch” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section. 2-64 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING Speedometer Tachometer EXAMPLE Fuel Gauge EXAMPLE (2) (1) 79K119 78K039 64J052 The speedometer indicates vehicle speed in km/h and mph. The tachometer indicates engine speed in revolutions per minute. This gauge gives an approximate indication of the amount of fuel in the fuel tank. “F” stands for full and “E” stands for empty. If the indicator gets off the graduation of “E” (not character “E”), refill the tank as soon as possible. CAUTION Never drive with the engine speed indicator in the red zone or severe engine damage can result. When downshifting to a lower gear, make sure not to operate with excessive revolution speeds of the engine. NOTE: The indicator moves a little depending on road conditions (for example, slope or curve) and driving conditions because of fuel moving in the tank. If the low fuel warning light (1) comes on, fill the fuel tank immediately. 2-65 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING NOTE: The information display shows the warning and indicator message when this light comes on. Temperature Gauge Brightness Control CAUTION Avoid driving with an extremely low fuel level. Running out of fuel could cause the engine to misfire, damaging the catalytic converter. NOTE: The activation point of the low fuel warning light (1) varies depending on road conditions (for example, slope or curve) and driving conditions because of fuel moving in the tank. The mark (2) indicates that the fuel filler door is located on the right side of the vehicle. (1) 64J053 79K120 When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position, this gauge indicates the engine coolant temperature. Under normal driving conditions, the indicator should stay within the normal, acceptable temperature range between “H” and “C”. If the indicator approaches “H”, overheating is indicated. Follow the instructions in the “If the Engine Overheats” of “EMERGENCY SERVICE” section. When the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position, the instrument panel lights come on. CAUTION Continuing to drive the vehicle when engine overheating is indicated can result in severe engine damage. Your vehicle has a system to automatically dim the brightness of the instrument panel lights when the position lights or headlights are on. You can change the brightness of the instrument panel lights regardless of whether the position lights or headlights are off or on. To increase the brightness of the instrument panel lights, turn the brightness control knob (1) clockwise. To reduce the brightness of the instrument panel lights, turn the brightness control knob (1) counterclockwise. 2-66 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING Information Display (if equipped) EXAMPLE The information display shows the following information. The information display is shown when the ignition switch is in the “ON” position. Display (B) Warning and Indicator Messages/Fuel Consumption/Driving Range/Average Speed 79K062 NOTE: • If you do not turn the brightness control knob within about 5 seconds of activating the brightness control display, the brightness control display will be canceled automatically. • When you reconnect the battery, the brightness of the instrument panel lights will be reinitialized. Readjust the brightness according to your preference. NOTE: If you select the lowest brightness level when the parking lights or headlights are on, the instrument panel lights other than meter lights are turned off. (A) (B) (C) Display (A) A/T selector position indicator (for automatic transmission) (D) Display (C) Trip meter/Thermometer Display (D) Odometer (1) (3) (2) 79K048 (1) TRIP knob (2) MODE/ILL knob (3) Information display 79K063 NOTE: • When the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position, the message shown in the above illustration will appear on the display for several seconds. • Some warning and indicator messages may appear on the display when the ignition switch is in the “ACC” or the “LOCK” position. 2-67 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING A/T Selector Position (for automatic transmission) To switch the display indication, push the MODE/ILL knob (2) quickly. EXAMPLE EXAMPLE NOTE: The value of fuel consumption, driving range and average speed shown in the display are affected by conditions such as the following; • road condition • surrounding traffic condition • driving condition • vehicle condition • a malfunction which causes the malfunction indicator light to come on or blink (a) 79K121 (b) The display (A) shows the automatic transmission selector position. Fuel Consumption/Driving Range/ Average Speed When there are no warning or indicator messages on the display (B), you can select one of the following five indications to appear on the display, instantaneous fuel consumption, average fuel consumption, driving range, average speed, or no indication. (c) (d) (e) 79K065 (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) Instantaneous fuel consumption Average fuel consumption Driving range Average speed No indication 2-68 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING Instantaneous fuel consumption If you selected instantaneous fuel consumption the last time you drove the vehicle, the display does not show the bar graph when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position. The display shows the bar graph only when the vehicle is moving. Average fuel consumption If you selected average fuel consumption the last time you drove the vehicle, the display shows the last value of average fuel consumption from previous driving when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position. Unless you reset the value of average fuel consumption, the display indicates the value of average fuel consumption which includes average fuel consumption during previous driving. NOTE: When you reconnect the negative (–) terminal to the battery, the value of average fuel consumption will be shown after driving for a while. You can select when the value of average fuel consumption is reset from among the following three methods; • Reset after refuel: the value of average fuel consumption will be reset automatically by refueling. • Reset with trip A: the value of average fuel consumption will be reset automatically by resetting trip meter A. • Reset manually: the value of average fuel consumption will be reset by pushing and holding the MODE/ILL knob (2) when the display indicates the average fuel consumption. To change when the value of average fuel consumption is reset, refer to “Setting Mode” later in this section. NOTE: If you add only a small amount of fuel when you select “Reset after refuel”, the average fuel consumption value may not be reset. Driving range If you selected driving range the last time you drove the vehicle, the display indicates “---” for a few seconds and then indicates the current driving range when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position. The driving range shown in the display is the approximate distance you can drive until the fuel gauge indicates “E”, based on current driving conditions. When the remaining fuel in fuel tank reaches a low level, the display “---” will appear. If the low fuel warning light comes on, fill the fuel tank immediately regardless of the value of driving range shown in the display. As the driving range after refueling is calculated based on the most recent driving condition, the value is different each time you refuel. NOTE: • If you refuel when the ignition switch is in the “ON” position, the driving range may not indicate the correct value. • When you reconnect the negative (–) terminal to the battery, the value of driving range will be shown after driving for a while. 2-69 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING Average speed If you selected average speed the last time you drove the vehicle, the display indicates the last value of average speed from previous driving when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position. Unless you reset the value of average speed, the display indicates the value of average speed which includes average speed during previous driving. Odometer/Trip meter/Thermometer When the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position, the display (C) shows one of the following three indications, trip meter A, trip meter B and thermometer. Also, the display (D) shows the odometer reading. EXAMPLE (f) To reset the value of average speed, push and hold the MODE/ILL knob (2) for about 2 seconds when the display indicates an average speed. The display shows “---” and then indicates a new average speed after driving for a short time. NOTE: When you reconnect the negative (–) terminal to the battery, the value of average speed will be shown after driving for a while. (i) (g) CAUTION Keep track of your odometer reading and check the maintenance schedule regularly for required services. Increased wear or damage to certain parts can result from failure to perform required services at the proper mileage intervals. Trip meter The trip meter can be used to measure the distance traveled on short trips or between fuel stops. You can use the trip meter A or trip meter B independently. (h) 79K122 (f) (g) (h) (i) Odometer The odometer records the total distance the vehicle has been driven. Trip meter A Trip meter B Thermometer Odometer To reset the trip meter to zero, push and hold the TRIP knob (1) for about 2 seconds when the display shows the trip meter. To switch the display indication (C), push the TRIP knob (1) quickly. 2-70 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING Thermometer The thermometer indicates the outside temperature. Setting Mode EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 79K069 79K068 79K067 If the outside temperature nears freezing, the message shown in the above illustration will appear on the display. NOTE: The outside temperature indication is not the actual outside temperature when driving at low speed, or when stopped. When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position and the vehicle is stationary, you can enter the setting mode of the information display by pushing and holding the MODE/ILL knob (2) for more than 3 seconds. • To select the setting that you want to change, turn the MODE/ILL knob (2) left or right. • To change the setting, push the MODE/ ILL knob (2). • To exit the setting mode, select “Back” and push the MODE/ILL knob (2). NOTE: Current settings appear with reversed text and background colors. NOTE: • If you push and hold the MODE/ILL knob to enter the setting mode when the display (B) shows average fuel consumption or average speed, the value will be reset simultaneously. If you do not want to reset the value, push the MODE/ILL knob quickly to switch the indication of the display. • If you turn the ignition switch or start to move the vehicle when the display shows the setting mode, the setting mode will be canceled automatically. 2-71 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING Distance units You can change the units odo/trip meter distance is displayed in. NOTE: When you change the units odo/trip meter distance is displayed in, the trip meter will be reset automatically. Fuel economy units You can change the units that fuel consumption is displayed in. Warning and Indicator Messages The display shows the warning and indicator messages to let you know about certain vehicle problems. A tone may also sound to alert you. the message will appear again after 5 seconds. If warning and indicator messages appear on the display, follow the messages. Master warning indicator Language You can change the language of the information display. Avg. fuel economy reset You can change when the value of average fuel consumption is reset. Temperature units You can change the units that temperature is displayed in. NOTE: When you change the units that temperature is displayed in, the air conditioning system temperature display units will be changed automatically. Default setting If you select “YES” and push the MODE/ ILL knob (2), all settings will be reinitialized. 78K049 When the display shows warning and indicator messages, the master warning indicator may also come on or blink. NOTE: • When the problem that causes a message to appear is corrected, the message will disappear. • If a message is displayed, and other problems requiring a message occur, the message for each of the problems will be alternately displayed about every 5 seconds. • When you push and hold the MODE/ILL knob for about 2 seconds while a message is displayed, the message will disappear temporarily. If the problem that caused the message is not corrected, 2-72 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING Warning and Indicator messages Warning and Indicator message Master Warning Indicator Sound Cause and Remedy Blinks Ding Any door (including the tailgate) is open when the vehicle is moving. Close all doors completely. Off Off Any door (including the tailgate) is open when the vehicle is stopped. (#1) Close all doors completely. Blinks Ding There may be a problem with the ESP® system. Have your vehicle inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer. Blinks Ding There may be problem with the hill descent control system and the hill hold control system. Have your vehicle inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer. Blinks Continuous Beep Front position lights, license plate lights, instrument lights and/or head lights are left on. Turn the lighting switch to the “OFF” position. 79K070 79K070 79K071 79K072 79K073 (#1) This message will disappear for a while even if the problem that caused the message to appear is not corrected. 2-73 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING Warning and Indicator message Master Warning Indicator Sound Cause and Remedy Blinks Off There may be a problem with the 4WD system. Have your vehicle inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer. Off Ding Fuel is low. (#1) Fill the fuel tank immediately. Off Off The outside temperature is near freezing. The road may be icy. (#1) You should drive carefully. 79K074 79K075 79K067 (#1) This message will disappear for a while even if the problem that caused the message to appear is not corrected. NOTE: • When you operate the transfer switch (if equipped), the information display may show messages other than those in the above chart. Refer to “Using the Transfer Switch” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section for details. • When you operate the ESP OFF switch (if equipped), the information display may show messages other than those in the above chart. Refer to “Electronic Stability Program (ESP®)” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section for details. 2-74 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING Lighting Control Lever Your vehicle’s lighting system is controlled by three main systems: the Lighting switch, the Auto-On Headlight System (when the lighting switch is in the “AUTO” position) and the Daytime Running Light (D.R.L.) system. (4) (3) (1) (2) 79K014 65D611 WARNING To avoid possible injury, do not operate controls by reaching through the steering wheel. 52D183 2-75 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING The three systems work together to operate your lights as shown in the following chart: E/G: Engine IG: Ignition switch ON: Lights ON LIGHT: When it is light around the light sensor (5). DARK: When it is dark around the light sensor (5). Lighting switch position IG OFF Main lights to be operated D.R.L. (1) OFF (2) AUTO (3) (4) (4) (3) IG ON E/G OFF E/G OFF E/G RUNNING LIGHT DARK LIGHT DARK LIGHT DARK – – – – ON ON (2) (1) Position lights, Tail lights – – – – – – Head lights – – – – – – D.R.L. – – – – ON – Position lights, Tail lights – – – ON – ON Head lights – – – ON – ON D.R.L. – – – – ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON Head lights – – – – – – D.R.L. – – – – – – Position lights, Tail lights ON ON ON ON ON ON Head lights ON ON ON ON ON ON Position lights, Tail lights Lighting Operation 79K015 To turn the lights on or off, twist the knob on the end of the lever. There are four positions: OFF (1) All lights are off. AUTO (2) Refer to “Auto-On Headlight system” for details. (3) Front position lights, tail-lights, license plate light and instrument lights are on, but headlights are off. (4) Front position lights, tail-lights, license plate light, instrument lights and head lights are on. 2-76 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING Auto-On Headlight System WARNING HIGH It takes about 5 seconds for the light sensor to react to a change in lighting conditions. To help avoid an accident due to reduced visibility, turn on your headlights before driving into a tunnel, parking structure or the like. LOW (5) NOTE: This system does not react to all types of ambient light. As the sensor is infrared type, it will not work correctly with ambient lights that do not contain infrared rays. PASS 79K016 With the headlights on, push the lever forward to switch to the high beams or pull the lever toward you to switch to the low beams. When the high beams are on, a light on the instrument panel will come on. To momentarily activate the high beams as a passing signal, pull the lever slightly toward you and release it when you have completed the signal. 66J026 The Auto-on headlight system automatically turns on all lights that are operated by the lighting control lever on the steering column, when the following four conditions are all met. Conditions for Auto-on headlight system operation: 1) It is dark around the light sensor (5). 2) The lighting control lever in the “AUTO” position. 3) The ignition switch is in the “ON” position. 4) The parking brake is released. This system is operated by the signal from the light sensor (5) on the right end of the instrument panel. Do not cover the sensor (5). If you do, the system will not work correctly. 2-77 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING Daytime Running Light (D.R.L.) System The headlights light, but are dimmer than the low beam, when the following three conditions are all met. Also, the D.R.L. indicator light on the instrument panel comes on. Front Fog Light Switch (if equipped) Turn Signal Control Lever Conditions for D.R.L. system operation: 1) The engine is running. 2) The parking brake is released. 3) The headlights are off, or the lighting switch in the “AUTO” position and it is light around the light sensor. NOTE: Be sure to turn the headlights on at night or at any time of the day when driving or weather conditions require the headlights to operate at full brightness and the taillights to be on. Lights “On” reminder A buzzer sounds to remind you to turn off the lights if they are left on when the ignition key is removed and the driver’s door is opened. 65D611 64J058 The front fog light comes on when the fog light switch is pushed in with: • the headlights are on and the beams set to the low beam position, or • the auto-on headlight system on and the beams set to the low beam position. WARNING To avoid possible injury, do not operate controls by reaching through the steering wheel. NOTE: The warning and indicator message and the illumination indicator light will be shown on the information display when this reminder is activated. 2-78 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING Turn Signal Operation With the ignition switch in the “ON” position, move the lever up or down to activate the right or left turn signals. Hazard Warning Switch Windshield Wiper and Washer Lever 64J054 Push in the hazard warning switch to activate the hazard warning lights. All turn signal lights and both turn signal indicators will flash simultaneously. To turn off the lights, push the switch again. 79K017 Normal turn signal Move the lever all the way upward or downward to signal. When the turn is completed, the signal will cancel and the lever will return to its normal position. Use the hazard warning lights to warn other traffic during emergency parking or when your vehicle could otherwise become a traffic hazard. 65D611 WARNING To avoid possible injury, do not operate controls by reaching through the steering wheel. Lane change signal Some times, such as changing lanes, the steering wheel is not turned far enough to cancel the turn signal. For convenience, you can flash the turn signal by moving the lever part way and holding it there. The lever will return to its normal position when you release it. 2-79 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING Windshield Wipers Windshield Washer EXAMPLE EXAMPLE EXAMPLE MIST OFF INT LO HI 63J302 63J301 To turn the windshield wipers on, move the lever up and down to one of the four operating positions. In the “INT” position (if equipped), the wipers operate intermittently. The “INT” position is very convenient for driving in mist or light rain. In the “LO” position, the wipers operate at a steady low speed. In the “HI” position, the wipers operate at a steady high speed. To turn off the wipers, move the lever back to the “OFF” position. Move the lever up and hold it to the “MIST” position, the windshield wipers will turn on continuously at low speed. If the lever is equipped with the “INT TIME” control, turn the control forward or rearward to adjust the intermittent wiper operation to the desired interval. 63J303 To spray windshield washer fluid, pull the lever toward you. The windshield wipers will automatically turn on at low speed if they are not already on and if the “INT” position is equipped. WARNING • To prevent windshield icing in cold weather, turn on the defroster to heat the windshield before and during windshield washer use. • Do not use radiator antifreeze in the windshield washer reservoir. It can severely impair visibility when sprayed on the windshield, and can also damage your vehicle’s paint. 2-80 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING Rear Window Wiper/Washer Switch CAUTION To help prevent damage to windshield wiper and washer system components, you should take the following precautions: • Do not continue to hold in the lever when there is no windshield washer fluid being sprayed or the washer motor can be damaged. • Do not attempt to remove dirt from a dry windshield with the wipers or you can damage the windshield and the wiper blades. Always wet the windshield with washer fluid before operating the wipers. • Clear ice or packed snow from the wiper blades before using the wipers. • Check the washer fluid level regularly. Check it often when the weather is bad. • Only fill the washer fluid reservoir 3/4 full during cold weather to allow room for expansion if the temperature falls low enough to freeze the solution. CAUTION EXAMPLE Washer Wiper Clear ice or snow from the rear window and rear wiper blade before using the rear wiper. Accumulated ice or snow could prevent the wiper blade from moving, causing damage to the wiper motor. Intermittent wiper 63J304 To turn the rear wiper on, twist the rear wiper switch on the end of the lever forward to the “ON” position. If your vehicle is equipped with the “INT” position, the rear wiper operates intermittently when you twist the switch forward to the “INT” position. To turn the rear wiper off, twist the switch rearward to the “OFF” position. To spray window washer fluid, twist the switch rearward from the “OFF” position, or twist the switch forward from the “ON” position. The rear wiper will turn on automatically while spraying the window washer fluid. 2-81 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING Tilt Steering Lock Lever Horn Rear Window Defroster and Outside Rearview Mirrors Defroster (if equipped) Switch EXAMPLE UNLOCK LOCK (1) 78K074 When the rear window is fogged, push this switch to clear the window. EXAMPLE 64J037 78K130 The lock lever is located under the steering column. To adjust the steering wheel height: Press the horn pad on the steering wheel to sound the horn. The horn will sound with the ignition switch in any position. 1) Pull up the lock lever to unlock the steering column. 2) Adjust the steering wheel to the desired height and lock the steering column by pulling down the lock lever. 3) Try moving the steering wheel up and down to make sure it is securely locked in position. WARNING Never attempt to adjust the steering wheel height while the vehicle is moving or you could lose control of the vehicle. (2) 64J258 If the outside rearview mirror has the mark (2), it is also equipped with the outside rearview mirrors defroster. When you push the switch (1), both the outside rearview mirrors defroster and the rear window defroster will operate simultaneously. 2-82 79K21-03E BEFORE DRIVING An indicator light will be lit when the defroster is on. The defroster will only work when the engine is running. To turn off the defroster, push the switch (1) again. CAUTION The rear window defroster and the outside rearview mirrors use a large amount of electricity. Be sure to turn off the defroster after the window has become clear. NOTE: • The defogger will work only when the engine is running. • The defogger will automatically turn off after the defogger remains on for 15 minutes to prevent discharging of the battery. 2-83 79K21-03E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Exhaust Gas Warning ......................................................... 3-1 Daily Inspection Checklist .................................................. 3-2 Ignition Switch ..................................................................... 3-3 Parking Brake Lever ........................................................... 3-7 3 Pedals ................................................................................... 3-8 Starting the Engine ............................................................. 3-9 Engine Block Heater (if equipped) ..................................... 3-10 Using the Transmission ..................................................... 3-11 Using the Transfer Switch (if equipped) ........................... 3-15 Cruise Control ..................................................................... 3-26 Braking ................................................................................. 3-28 Electronic Stability Program (ESP®) ................................. 3-31 Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) (if equipped) ......................................................................... 3-37 60G408 79K21-03E Exhaust Gas Warning: NO OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Exhaust Gas Warning WARNING 52D334 WARNING Avoid breathing exhaust gases. Exhaust gases contain carbon monoxide, a potentially lethal gas that is colorless and odorless. Since carbon monoxide is difficult to detect by itself, be sure to take the following precautions to help prevent carbon monoxide from entering your vehicle. • Do not leave the engine running in garages or other confined areas. (Continued) (Continued) • Do not park with the engine running for a long period of time, even in an open area. If it is necessary to sit for a short time in a parked vehicle with the engine running, make sure the air intake lever is set to “FRESH AIR” and the fan is at high speed. • Avoid operating the vehicle with the rear door, tailgate or rear window open. If it is necessary to operate the vehicle with the rear door, tailgate or rear window open, make sure the folding sunroof (if equipped) and all the windows are closed, and the fan is at high speed with the air intake selector set to “FRESH AIR”. • To allow proper operation of your vehicle’s ventilation system, keep the air inlet grille in front of the windshield clear of snow, leaves or other obstructions at all times. • Keep the exhaust tailpipe area clear of snow and other material to help reduce the buildup of exhaust gases under the vehicle. This is particularly important when parked in blizzard conditions. (Continued) WARNING (Continued) • Have the exhaust system inspected periodically for damage and leaks. Any damage or leaks should be repaired immediately. 3-1 79K21-03E Daily Inspection Checklist: NO Starting the Engine: 1 OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Daily Inspection Checklist Before Driving 60A187S 1) Make sure that windows, mirrors, lights and reflectors are clean and unobstructed. 2) Visually check the tires for the following points: – the depth of the tread groove – abnormal wear, cracks and damage – loose wheel nuts – existence of foreign material such as nails, stones, etc. Refer to “Tires” in “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section for details. 3) Look for fluid, oil leaks. NOTE: It is normal for water to drip from the air conditioning system after use. 4) Make sure the hood is fully closed and latched. 5) Check the headlights, turn signal lights, brake lights and horn for proper operation. 6) Lock all doors. 7) Adjust the seat and adjustable head restraints (if equipped). 8) Check the brake pedal and the parking brake lever. 9) Adjust the mirrors. 10)Make sure that you and all passengers have properly fastened your seat belts. 11)Make sure that all warning lights come on as the key is turned to the “ON” position. 12)Check all gauges. 13)Make sure that the BRAKE SYSTEM WARNING light turns off when the parking brake is released. ing for proper latch operation. See the item “All Latches, Hinges and Locks” of “CHASSIS AND BODY” in the “Periodic Maintenance Schedule” in the “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section for lubrication schedule. WARNING Make sure the hood is fully closed and latched before driving. If it is not, it can fly up unexpectedly during driving, obstructing your view and resulting in an accident. Once a month, or each time you fill your fuel tank, check the tire pressure using a tire pressure gauge. Also check the tire pressure of the spare tire. Once a week, or each time you fill your fuel tank, perform the following under-hood checks: 1) 2) 3) 4) 5) 6) 7) Engine oil level Coolant level Brake fluid level Power steering (if equipped) fluid level Windshield washer fluid level Battery solution level Hood latch operation Pull the hood release handle inside the vehicle. Make sure that you cannot open the hood all the way without releasing the secondary latch. Be sure to close the hood securely after check- 3-2 79K21-03E Starting the Engine: 1 OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Ignition Switch Vehicle Without Keyless Start System Manual transmission EXAMPLE Push Turn to “LOCK” 60A055 65D611 60B041 WARNING To avoid possible injury, do not operate controls by reaching through the steering wheel. The ignition switch has the following four positions: LOCK This is the normal parking position. It is the only position in which the key can be removed. It locks the ignition, and prevents normal use of the steering wheel after the key is removed. • Manual transmission vehicles You must push in the key to turn it to the “LOCK” position. It locks the ignition, and prevents normal use of the steering wheel after the key is removed. • Automatic transmission vehicles The gearshift lever must be in the “P” (Park) position to turn the key to the “LOCK” position. It locks the ignition and prevents normal use of the steering wheel and gearshift lever. To release the steering lock, insert the key and turn it clockwise to one of the other positions. If you have trouble turning the key to unlock the steering, try turning the steering wheel slightly to the right or left while turning the key. 3-3 79K21-03E Starting the Engine: 1 Engine Block Heater: 1 OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE ACC Accessories such as the radio can operate, but the engine is off. Vehicle With Keyless Start System (3) ON This is the normal operating position. All electrical systems are on. START This is the position for starting the engine using the starter motor. The key should be released from this position as soon as the engine starts. Ignition key reminder A buzzer sounds intermittently to remind you to remove the ignition key if it is in the ignition switch when the driver’s door is opened. (2) (4) (1) EXAMPLE 79K116 56KN076 The ignition switch can be operated without using an ignition key when the remote controller is in an area of the vehicle other than the rear luggage area. To turn the ignition switch, first push in the switch. • Manual transmission vehicle You must push in the ignition switch to turn it from the “LOCK” position to the “ACC” position. To return to the “LOCK” position from the “ACC” position, turn the ignition switch counterclockwise while pushing in the switch. • Automatic transmission vehicle To turn the ignition switch, push the switch. If the keyless start system blue indicator light illuminates on the instrument cluster, you can turn the ignition switch. If the red indicator light illuminates, you cannot turn the ignition switch. NOTE: • The ignition switch can be turned to the “ACC” position when the keyless start system blue indicator light illuminates. The blue indicator light will illuminate for several seconds when you push in the ignition switch and then will turn off to protect the system. In this case, you must release the ignition switch and push it in again to illuminate the blue indicator light. • If the keyless start system red indicator light illuminates, the remote controller may not be in the vehicle or the battery 3-4 79K21-03E Engine Block Heater: 1 Using the Transmission: 10 OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE of the remote controller may be unreliable. NOTE: • If the battery of the remote controller runs down or there are strong radio waves or noise, the operating range may be narrower or the remote controller may be inoperative. • If the remote controller is too close to the door, it may not operate. • The ignition switch may not turn when the remote controller is on the instrument panel, in the glove box, in a storage compartment, in the sun visor or on the floor. CAUTION The remote controller is a sensitive electronic instrument. To avoid damaging the remote controller: • Do not expose it to impacts, moisture or high temperature such as by leaving it on the dashboard under direct sunlight. • Keep the remote controller away from magnetic objects such as a television. You can also turn the ignition switch by inserting the ignition key into the slot. The ignition switch has the following four positions: If you leave any of the doors open with the ignition switch in the “ACC” position for a while (and no key inserted), the engine may not start when you turn the ignition switch to “START”. If the engine does not start, close all doors completely or turn the ignition switch back to the “LOCK” position, then start the engine. LOCK (1) This is the normal parking position. It is the only position in which the key can be removed. It locks the ignition, and prevents normal use of the steering wheel. For vehicles with an automatic transmission, the gearshift lever must be in the “P” (Park) position to turn the key to the “LOCK” position. To release the steering lock, turn the ignition switch clockwise to one of the other positions. If you have trouble turning the ignition switch to unlock the steering, try turning the steering wheel slightly to the right or left while turning the switch. • Manual transmission vehicle You must push in the ignition switch to turn it from the “LOCK” position to the “ACC” position. To return to the “LOCK” position from the “ACC” position, turn the ignition switch counterclockwise while pushing in the switch. • Automatic transmission vehicle To turn the ignition switch, push the switch. ACC (2) Accessories such as the radio can operate, but the engine is off. 3-5 79K21-03E Using the Transmission: 10 OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE ON (3) This is the normal operating position. All electrical systems are on. You can also turn the ignition switch by inserting the ignition key into the slot. START (4) This is the position for starting the engine using the starter motor. The switch should be released from this position as soon as the engine starts. Ignition switch reminder (When using the keyless start system) A buzzer sounds intermittently to remind you to return the ignition switch to the “LOCK” position if it is in the “ACC” position when the driver’s door is opened. (1) 80JM139 The ignition switch cap (1) is installed to make the ignition switch turn easily. If you use the ignition key to turn the ignition switch, remove the cap (1) by pinching both side of the cap and pull it out. NOTE: If you remove the cap, be careful not to lose it. 81A297S WARNING • Never return the ignition switch to the “LOCK” position and remove the ignition key while the vehicle is moving. The steering wheel will lock and you will not be able to steer the vehicle. (Continued) Ignition key reminder (When using the ignition key) A buzzer sounds intermittently to remind you to remove the ignition key if it is in the ignition switch when the driver’s door is opened. 3-6 79K21-03E Using the Transmission: 10 OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE WARNING (Continued) • Always return the ignition switch to the “LOCK” position and remove the ignition key and the remote controller (if equipped) when leaving the vehicle even if only for a short time. Also do not leave children or pets alone in a parked vehicle. Unattended children could cause accidental movement of the vehicle or could tamper with power windows or a power sunroof. Children or pets could also suffer from heatstroke in warm or hot weather, which could result in severe injury or even death. CAUTION • Do not turn the starter motor for more than 15 seconds at a time. If the engine does not start, wait 15 seconds before trying again. If the engine does not start after several attempts, check the fuel and ignition systems or consult your SUZUKI dealer. • Do not leave the ignition switch in the “ON” position if the engine is not running or the battery will discharge. Parking Brake Lever cult to shift out of “P” when you are ready to drive the vehicle. When preparing to drive the vehicle, move the gearshift lever out of the “P” position before releasing the parking brake. EXAMPLE (1) WARNING (2) (3) 64J081 (1) To set (2) To release (3) To release The parking brake lever is located between the seats. To set the parking brake, hold the brake pedal down and pull the parking brake lever all the way up. To release the parking brake, hold the brake pedal down, pull up slightly on the parking brake lever, push the button on the end of the lever with your thumb and lower the lever to its original position. For automatic transmission vehicles, always set the parking brake before moving the gearshift lever to the “P” (Park) position. If you park on an incline and shift into “P” before you set the parking brake, the weight of the vehicle may make it diffi- • Never drive your vehicle with the parking brake set: rear brake effectiveness can be reduced from overheating, brake life may be shortened or permanent brake damage may result. • If the parking brake does not hold the vehicle securely or does not fully release, have your vehicle inspected immediately by an authorized SUZUKI dealer. WARNING Always set the parking brake fully before leaving your vehicle or it may move, causing injury or damage. When parking, make sure the gearshift lever for manual transmission vehicles is in 1st gear or “R” (Reverse) and the gearshift lever for automatic transmission vehicles is in “P” (Park). Never leave the transfer lever (if equipped) in “N” (Neutral) when you are parked. Remember, even though the transmission is in gear or in Park, you must set the parking brake fully. 3-7 79K21-03E Using the Transmission: 10 Using the Transfer Switch: 10 OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Pedals Clutch Pedal (1) (For manual transmission) The clutch pedal is used to disengage the drive to the wheels when starting the engine, stopping or shifting the gearshift lever or transfer lever (if equipped). Depressing the pedal disengages the clutch. Manual transmission EXAMPLE CAUTION (3) (2) (1) 64J082 Automatic transmission Do not drive with your foot resting on the clutch pedal. It could result in excessive clutch wear, clutch damage, or unexpected loss of engine braking. WARNING Do not “ride” the brakes by applying them continuously or resting your foot on the pedal. This will result in overheating of the brakes which could cause unpredictable braking action, longer stopping distances or permanent brake damage. Accelerator Pedal (3) This pedal controls the speed of the engine. Depressing the accelerator pedal increases power output and speed. Brake Pedal (2) Your SUZUKI vehicle is equipped with front and rear disc brakes. Depressing the brake pedal applies both sets of brakes. EXAMPLE You may hear occasional brake squeal when you apply the brakes. This is a normal condition caused by environmental factors such as cold, wet, snow, etc. WARNING (2) (3) If brake squeal is excessive and occurs each time the brakes are applied, you should have the brakes checked by your SUZUKI dealer. 64J083 3-8 79K21-03E Using the Transfer Switch: 10 OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Starting the Engine NOTE: Automatic transmission vehicles have a starter interlock device which is designed to keep the starter from operating if the transmission is in any of the drive positions. Before Starting the Engine WARNING Make sure that the parking brake is set fully and the transmission is in Neutral (or Park for vehicles with an automatic transmission) before attempting to start the engine. Starting a Cold Engine 64J140 1) Make sure the parking brake is set fully. 2) Manual Transmission – Shift into “N” (Neutral) and depress the clutch pedal all the way to the floor. Hold the clutch pedal while starting the engine. Automatic Transmission – If the gearshift lever is not in “P” (Park) position, shift into “P”. (If you need to re-start the engine while the vehicle is moving, shift into “N”.) NOTE: The engine of manual transmission vehicle will not start unless the clutch pedal is depressed. 1/3 of its travel and try cranking the engine again. Release the key and accelerator pedal when the engine starts. If the engine still does not start, try holding the accelerator pedal all the way to the floor while cranking. This should clear the engine if it is flooded. If you are unable to start the engine using this procedure, consult your SUZUKI dealer. Starting a Warm Engine Use the same procedure as for “Starting a Cold Engine”. With your foot off the accelerator pedal, crank the engine by turning the ignition key to “START”. Release the key when the engine starts. CAUTION • Stop turning the starter immediately after the engine has started or the starter system can be damaged. • Do not crank the engine for more than 15 seconds at a time. If the engine doesn’t start on the first try, wait about 15 seconds before trying again. If the engine does not start after 15 seconds of cranking, wait about 15 seconds, then press down the accelerator pedal to 3-9 79K21-03E Using the Transfer Switch: 10 OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Engine Block Heater (if equipped) NOTE: Activate the heater at least four hours before you start the engine. However, as the heating time varies depending on the ambient temperature and other factors, adjust the time by observing the engine cranking condition. EXAMPLE 3) Close the engine hood securely before starting the engine. WARNING 79K040 The engine block heater will help you start the engine more easily in very cold weather (–18°C (0°F) or below). To use the engine block heater: 1) Turn off the engine. 2) Open the engine hood. 3) Untie the block heater cord and remove the block heater plug cap. When the engine block heater is not in use, ensure the heater cord is secured to prevent contact with any moving parts. 4) Using a heavy-duty, three-prong grounded extension cord, plug the female end into the block heater socket and the male end into a normal, grounded 110-volt AC outlet. To avoid serious personal injury caused by electrical shock or fire: • Do not plug the cord into a nongrounded outlet. Only use a properly grounded three-prong 110-volt AC outlet. • Do not use a 2-wire (non-grounded) extension cord. • Only use a heavy-duty, three-prong extension cord rated for at least 15 amps. After using the block heater: 1) Unplug the extension cord and reinstall the plug cap. 2) Tie the block heater cord back to its original position. CAUTION Secure the block heater cord back to its original position or to the routed position. A loose cord could get caught in the engine accessory drive belt(s) or other moving parts. 3-10 79K21-03E Using the Transfer Switch: 10 OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Using the Transmission 5-Speed Automatic Transmission WARNING Manual Transmission 65D449 Starting off To start off, depress the clutch pedal all the way to the floor and shift into 1st gear. After releasing the parking brake, gradually release the clutch. When you hear a change in the engine’s sound, slowly press the accelerator while continuing to gradually release the clutch. Shifting All forward gears are synchronized, which provides for quiet, and easy shifting. Always push in the clutch pedal fully before shifting gears. Make sure the engine speed does not rise into the red zone of the tachometer. • Reduce your speed and downshift to a lower gear before going down a long or steep hill. Downshifting will allow the engine to provide braking. Avoid riding the brakes or they may overheat, resulting in brake failure. • When driving on slippery roads, be sure to slow down before downshifting. Large and sudden changes in engine speed may cause loss of traction, which could cause you to lose control. • Make sure that the vehicle is completely stopped before you shift into reverse. 66J003 D: 5-speed automatic transmission mode 4: 4-speed automatic transmission mode CAUTION • To help avoid clutch damage, do not use the clutch pedal as a footrest while driving or use the clutch to keep the vehicle stationary on a hill. Depress the clutch fully when shifting. • When shifting or starting off, do not race the engine. Racing the engine can shorten engine life and affect smooth shifting. The 4-speed mode is suitable for the following driving conditions: • Driving on hilly, winding roads – You can drive more smoothly with less frequent gearshifting • Going down a steep hill – Some engine braking is provided NOTE: With the transfer switch in the “4L LOCK” position, the 5-speed automatic transmission will remain in the 4-speed mode. 3-11 79K21-03E Using the Transfer Switch: 10 OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Gearshift lever Use the gearshift lever positions as described below: speed is, the more you will need to press the accelerator pedal to get a downshift. P (Park) Use this position to lock the transmission when the vehicle is parked or when starting the engine. Shift into Park only when the vehicle is completely stopped. 4 (Low 3) Use this position for driving on moderate uphill and downhill gradients. The engine braking effect on moderate downhills can be used in this position. The transmission shifts up only to 4th gear. WARNING If you have a 4-wheel drive vehicle, never leave the transfer switch in “N” (Neutral) position when parked. Otherwise the vehicle may roll even if the transmission is in Park. 66J004 The gearshift lever is designed that it cannot be shifted out of the “P” position unless the ignition switch is in the “ON” position and the brake pedal is depressed. WARNING Always depress the brake pedal before shifting from “P” (Park) (or “N” (Neutral) if the vehicle is stationary) to a forward or reverse gear, to help prevent the vehicle from moving unexpectedly when you shift. R (Reverse) Use this position to back the vehicle from stop. Make sure that the vehicle is completely stopped before shifting into Reverse. N (Neutral) Use this position for starting the engine if the engine stalls and you need to restart it while the vehicle is moving. You may also shift into Neutral and depress the brake pedal to hold the vehicle stationary during idling. 3 (Low 2) Use this position to provide extra power when climbing hills, or to provide engine braking when going down hills. L (Low 1) Use this position to provide maximum power when climbing steep hills or driving through deep snow or mud, or to provide maximum engine braking when going down steep hills. NOTE: If you move the gearshift lever to a lower gear while driving faster than the maximum allowable speed for the lower gear, the transmission will not actually downshift until your speed drops below the maximum speed for the lower gear. D (Drive) Use this position for all normal driving. With the selector in “D” range, you can get an automatic downshift by pressing the accelerator pedal. The higher the vehicle 3-12 79K21-03E Using the Transfer Switch: 10 OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE 4-Speed Automatic Transmission Gearshift lever CAUTION Be sure to take the following precautions to help avoid damage to the automatic transmission: • Make sure that the vehicle is completely stopped before shifting into “P” or “R”. • Do not shift from “P” or “N” to “R”, “D”, “4”, “3” or “L” when the engine is running above idle speed. • Do not rev the engine with the transmission in a drive position (“R”, “D”, “4”, “3” or “L”) and the rear wheels not moving. • Do not use the accelerator to hold the vehicle on a hill. Use the vehicle’s brakes. EXAMPLE 64J142 79K027 D: 4-speed automatic transmission mode 3: 3-speed automatic transmission mode The 3-speed mode is suitable for the following driving conditions: • Driving on hilly, winding roads – You can drive more smoothly with less frequent gearshifting • Going down a steep hill – Some engine braking is provided The gearshift lever is designed that it cannot be shifted out of the “P” position unless the ignition switch is in the “ON” position and the brake pedal is depressed. WARNING Always depress the brake pedal before shifting from “P” (Park) (or “N” (Neutral) if the vehicle is stationary) to a forward or reverse gear, to help prevent the vehicle from moving unexpectedly when you shift. NOTE: With the transfer switch in the “4L LOCK” position, the 4-speed automatic transmission will remain in the 3-speed mode. 3-13 79K21-03E Using the Transfer Switch: 10 OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Use the gearshift lever positions as described below: D (Drive) Use this position for all normal driving. P (Park) Use this position to lock the transmission when the vehicle is parked or when starting the engine. Shift into Park only when the vehicle is completely stationary. With the gearshift lever in “D” range you can get an automatic downshift by pressing the accelerator pedal. The higher the vehicle speed is, the more you need to press the accelerator pedal to get a downshift. WARNING If you have a 4-wheel drive vehicle, never leave the transfer switch in “N” (Neutral) position when parked. Otherwise the vehicle may roll even if the transmission is in Park. R (Reverse) Use this position to reverse the vehicle from stop. Make sure that vehicle is completely stationary before shifting into Reverse. N (Neutral) Use this position for starting the engine if the engine stalls and you need to restart it while the vehicle is moving. You may also shift into Neutral and depress the brake pedal to hold the vehicle stationary during idling. 3 (Low 3) Use this position for driving on moderate uphill and downhill gradients. The engine braking effect on moderate downhills can be used in this position. The transmission shifts up only to 3rd gear. 2 (Low 2) Use this position to provide extra power when climbing hills, or to provide engine braking when going down hills. CAUTION Be sure to take the following precautions to help avoid damage to the automatic transmission: • Make sure that the vehicle is completely stationary before shifting into “P” or “R”. • Do not shift from “P” or “N” to “R”, “D”, “3”, “2”, or “L” when the engine is running above idle speed. • Do not rev the engine with the transmission in a drive position (“R”, “D”, “3”, “2”, or “L”) and the rear wheels not moving. • Do not use the accelerator to hold the vehicle on a hill. Use the vehicle’s brakes. L (Low 1) Use this position to provide maximum power when climbing steep hills or driving through deep snow or mud, or to provide maximum engine braking when going down steep hills. NOTE: If you move the gearshift lever to a lower gear while driving faster than the maximum allowable speed for the lower gear, the transmission will not actually downshift until your speed drops below the maximum speed for the lower gear. 3-14 79K21-03E Using the Transfer Switch: 10 OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE If You Cannot Shift Automatic Transmission Gearshift Lever Out of “P” (PARK) 5) With inserting the key or the flat end rod into the slot in the hole, shift the gearshift lever to the desired position. Using the Transfer Switch (if equipped) This procedure is for emergency use only. If repeated use of this procedure is necessary, or the procedure does not work as described, take the vehicle to your dealer for repair. (1) 78K043 66J168 Vehicles with an automatic transmission have an electrically operated park-lock feature. If the vehicle’s battery is discharged, or there is some other electrical failure, the automatic transmission cannot be shifted out of Park in the normal way. Jump starting may correct the condition. If not, follow the procedure described below. This procedure will permit shifting the transmission out of Park. Your vehicle is equipped with a four-mode full-time 4x4 system. You can use the transfer switch to select any of the four modes: N, 4H, 4H LOCK, 4L LOCK. 1) Be sure the parking brake is firmly applied. 2) If the engine is running, stop the engine. 3) Make sure the key is in the “ON” or “ACC” position. 4) Remove the cover (1) on the hole. 3-15 79K21-03E Using the Transfer Switch: 10 Braking: 6 OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE (4) (2) (3) (6) (7) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) (10) (11) (9) (5) Front differential Engine Transmission High/Low clutch Transfer case Center differential Differential lock clutch Chain Rear propeller shaft Rear differential Front propeller shaft (8) (10) (1) (11) 64J143 3-16 79K21-03E Braking: 6 OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Description of Transfer Switch Positions In this position, engine power is not supplied to the front or rear axles. Only use this position for towing your vehicle. When you turn the transfer switch to the “N” position, “N” indicator will come on with the buzzer sound. N (Neutral) WARNING Never leave the transfer switch in “N” (Neutral) when parked. When the transfer switch is in “N” (Neutral), the vehicle may roll even if the transmission is in gear or in Park. 64J223 3-17 79K21-03E Braking: 6 OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE 4H (4-wheel drive high range) In this position, engine power is supplied to the front and rear axles. Use this position for normal driving. 64J220 3-18 79K21-03E Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS): OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE 4H LOCK (4-wheel drive high range center differential lock) In this position, engine power is supplied to the front and rear axles and you get better traction than when driving in “4H”. Use this position when you need better traction than “4H” provides, such as when driving on slippery roads etc. 64J221 3-19 79K21-03E Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS): OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE 4L LOCK (4-wheel drive low range center differential lock) In this position, engine power is supplied to the front and rear axles and you get better traction and more low-speed torque than when driving in “4H”. Use this position when you need better traction than “4H” provides and more low-speed torque than “4H LOCK” provides, such as when climbing or descending steep, slippery hills etc. NOTE: When the transfer switch (if equipped) is turned to the “4L LOCK” position, the ESP® systems (other than ABS) will be canceled to provide improved vehicle traction, and the “ESP OFF” indicator light will come on. When the transfer switch (if equipped) is turned to the “4L LOCK” position, braketraction control can be activated. Braketraction control brakes the spinning wheel to distribute drive power to the other wheels for increased climbing ability or for better performance on a rolling hill or a slippery surface. ESP® is a registered trademark of Daimler AG. 64J222 3-20 79K21-03E Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS): Break-In: 6 OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Transfer Switch Operation Operate the transfer switch according to the appropriate procedure described below: From N to 4H Stop the vehicle completely, place the transmission in “N” (Neutral) and depress the brake pedal and the clutch pedal fully (if equipped), then push in and turn the switch to shift into “4H”. From 4H to 4H LOCK You can operate the transfer switch either when the vehicle is stopped or while the vehicle is moving. Position the front wheels straight ahead and turn the switch to shift into “4H LOCK”. If the vehicle is moving, we recommend that the speed be less than 100 km/h (60 mph) during this operation. CAUTION Do not operate the transfer switch while tires are racing. NOTE: If it is difficult to shift between “4H” and “4H LOCK” while the vehicle is moving, try accelerating and decelerating your vehicle several times after turning the transfer switch. Be sure to wait until traffic conditions allow you to accelerate and decelerate safety before using this procedure. From 4H LOCK to 4L LOCK Stop the vehicle completely, place the transmission in “N” (Neutral) and depress the brake pedal and the clutch pedal fully (if equipped), then push in and turn the switch to shift into “4L LOCK”. From 4H to N (1) From 4L LOCK to 4H LOCK Stop the vehicle completely, place the transmission in “N” (Neutral) and depress the brake pedal and the clutch pedal fully (if equipped), then push in and turn the switch to shift into “4H LOCK”. From 4H LOCK to 4H You can operate the transfer switch either when the vehicle is stopped or while the vehicle is moving. Position the front wheels straight ahead and turn the switch to shift into “4H”. If the vehicle is moving, we recommend that the speed be less than 100 km/h (60 mph) during this operation. CAUTION Do not operate the transfer switch while tires are racing. 64J209 Stop the vehicle completely, place the transmission in “N” (Neutral) and depress the brake pedal and the clutch pedal fully (if equipped), then push in and turn the switch to the mark (1) at the left of the “N” position, and hold the switch in this position for 5 seconds until the “N” indicator blinks, then turn the switch to the “N” position. When you turn the transfer switch to the “N” position, “N” indicator will come on with the buzzer sound. NOTE: If it is difficult to shift between “4H” and “4H LOCK” while the vehicle is moving, try accelerating and decelerating your vehicle several times after turning the transfer switch. Be sure to wait until traffic conditions allow you to accelerate and decelerate safety before using this procedure. 3-21 79K21-03E Catalytic Converter: NO OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE CAUTION CAUTION • Be sure to stop the vehicle completely before operating the transfer switch to shift between “N” and “4H”, or between “4H LOCK” and “4L LOCK”. • Do not shift between “4H” and “4H LOCK” unless the front wheels are in the straight-ahead position and we recommend that the vehicle speed be less than 100 km/h (60 mph). Do not operate the transfer switch while tires are racing. • Do not operate your vehicle in “4H LOCK” or “4L LOCK” on dry, hard surfaces. (Continued) (Continued) • Do not operate the vehicle while a 4WD mode indicator is blinking except when shifting between “4H” and “4L LOCK”. If you operate the vehicle while a 4WD mode indicator is blinking, a buzzer will sound and the transfer will shift to “N” (Neutral) to prevent transfer case damage. In this case, use the following procedure. 1) Release your foot from the accelerator pedal and depress the brake pedal to stop the vehicle completely. 2) Depress the clutch pedal fully (if equipped) or shift the automatic transmission gearshift lever to the “N” position. 3) If the transfer does not shift from “N” although you perform 1) and 2), turn the transfer switch to the position previously selected and operate the switch again. NOTE: The information display shows the warning and indicator message when the transfer system is operated, or has a problem. 3-22 79K21-03E Catalytic Converter: NO Improving Fuel Economy: NO OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE The basic operation for transfer switch Current Position Current Indicator N Target Position Target Indicator 4H – N 4H – 4H LOCK 4H – 4H LOCK 4L LOCK 4L LOCK 4H LOCK N: Neutral 4H: 4-wheel drive high range mode 4H LOCK: 4-wheel drive high range center differential lock mode 4L LOCK: 4-wheel drive low range center differential lock mode 3-23 79K21-03E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Warning and Indicator messages Transfer Switch Warning and Indicator messages Operation In any position Master Warning Indicator Sound Cause and Remedy Blinks Off There may be a problem with the 4WD system. Have your vehicle inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer. Blinks Series of Beeps This message informs you that the transfer switch is in “N”, which is used only for towing your vehicle. Move the transfer switch to a different position unless you are planning to tow your vehicle. Off Off This message informs you the 4WD mode is switching. Blinks Off Tires are slipping. Turn the transfer switch to “4H LOCK” position. 79K074 In “N” position 79K077 Switching between “4H” and “4H LOCK” 79K078 In “4H” position 79K079 3-24 79K21-03E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Transfer Switch Operation Warning and Indicator messages Switching between “4H LOCK” and “4L LOCK” Switching between “4H” and “N” Master Warning Indicator Sound Cause and Remedy Off Series of Beeps (For automatic transmission) The desired transfer gear has not been engaged. Release your foot from the accelerator pedal. Depress the brake pedal. Shift the automatic transmission gearshift lever to the “N” position. Off Series of Beeps (For manual transmission) The desired transfer gear has not been engaged. Release your foot from the accelerator pedal. Depress the brake pedal and clutch pedal. Off Beep or Off The desired transfer gear has not been engaged. Turn the transfer switch back to the previously selected position, and operate the transfer switch again. Off Off This message informs you the 4WD mode is switching. Do not move your vehicle. 79K080 79K081 79K082 79K083 3-25 79K21-03E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Cruise Control (if equipped) To Set Cruising Speed WARNING To help avoid loss of vehicle control, do not use the cruise control system when driving in heavy traffic, on slippery or winding roads, or on steep downgrades. 1) Turn on the cruise control system by pushing the “ON/OFF” switch (1). When the “CRUISE” indicator light comes on, you can set cruising speed. 2) Accelerate or decelerate to the desired speed. 3) Push the “SET/COAST” switch (3) and turn on the “SET” indicator light. Take your foot off the accelerator pedal and the set speed will be maintained. WARNING If the cruising speed is set by accident, you cannot decelerate or could loose control of the vehicle. This could lead to an accident, resulting in severe injury or death. (2) 79K032 (4) (1) The cruise control system allows you to maintain a steady speed without keeping your foot on the accelerator pedal. The controls for operating the cruise control system are on the steering wheel. You can use the cruise control system with the following conditions: • For manual transmission vehicle, the gear position is in 4th or 5th. • For 4-Speed automatic transmission vehicle, the gearshift lever is in “D” or “3” position. • For 5-Speed automatic transmission vehicle, the gearshift lever is in “D” or “4” position. • The vehicle speed is between approximately 45 km/h (28 mph) or higher. (3) 79K049 (1) (2) (3) (4) “ON/OFF” switch “CANCEL” switch “SET/COAST” switch “RES/ACC” switch Turn off the cruise control system and make sure the “CRUISE” indicator light is off when the system is not in use. NOTE: If the transfer switch (if equipped) is in the “4L LOCK” position, you cannot use the cruise control system. Refer to “Using the Transfer Switch (if equipped)” in this section. 3-26 79K21-03E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE To Change Speed Temporarily “CRUISE” indicator light When the cruising speed is maintained, you can temporarily accelerate or decelerate. To accelerate, depress the accelerator pedal. When you take your foot off the pedal, your vehicle will return to the set speed. 52D113 When you push the “ON/OFF” switch, the system is on and a “CRUISE” indicator light on the instrument cluster will be on. “SET” indicator light 65D474 When the vehicle’s speed is controlled by the cruise control system, a “SET” indicator light on the instrument cluster will be on. To decelerate, depress the brake pedal. The set speed will be canceled and “SET” indicator light will go off. To resume the previously set speed, push the “RES/ACC” switch (4) and turn on the “SET” indicator light again when vehicle speed is above 45 km/h (28 mph). The vehicle will accelerate to and maintain the previously set speed. NOTE: For 4-Speed/5-Speed automatic transmission vehicle, when the cruising speed is maintained, you cannot decelerate by using the engine brake if you shift the gearshift lever from “D” to “3” position for 4Speed automatic transmission vehicle, and from “D” to “4” position for 5-Speed automatic transmission vehicle. To decelerate while the cruise control is on, depress the brake pedal or push the “SET/ COAST” switch (3). To Change Cruising Speed Using the accelerator pedal To reset at a faster cruising speed, accelerate to the desired speed using the accelerator pedal and push the “SET/COAST” switch (3). The new speed will be maintained. Using the brake pedal To reset at a slower cruising speed, decelerate to the desired speed using the brake pedal and push the “SET/COAST” switch (3). The new speed will be maintained. NOTE: When the brake pedal is depressed, the “SET” indicator light goes off until reset the cruising speed. Using the cruise control switch To reset at a faster cruising speed, press repeatedly or hold in the “RES/ACC” switch (4). Vehicle speed will steadily increase. When you release the switch, the new speed will be maintained. To reset at a slower cruising speed, press repeatedly or hold in the “SET/COAST” switch (3) until the vehicle has slowed to the desired speed, then release the switch. The new speed will be maintained. NOTE: You can adjust the set speed by approximately 1.5 km/h (1.0 mph) by pushing a cruise control switch quickly. 3-27 79K21-03E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Cancellation of the Cruise Control The “SET” indicator light will go off and the cruise control will be canceled temporarily with following procedures: • Push the “CANCEL” switch (2). • Depress the brake pedal. • For manual transmission, depress the clutch pedal. • For 4-Speed automatic transmission vehicle, shift the gearshift lever into “2” or “L” position. • For 5-Speed automatic transmission vehicle, shift the gearshift lever into “3”, “2”, or “L” position. • The vehicle speed falls more than 20 km/h (12.5 mph) below the set speed. • Any time the vehicle speed falls below 40 km/h (25 mph). • When the vehicle skids and ESP® (if equipped) is activated. To resume the previously set speed, push the “RES/ACC” switch (4) and turn on the “SET” indicator light. Besides, the vehicle speed has to be above 45 km/h (28 mph) when the vehicle is not in the above conditions. NOTE: If you turn off the cruise control system, the previously set speed in the memory is cleared. Reset your cruising speed again. Braking 60G165 The distance needed to bring any vehicle to a halt increases with the speed of the vehicle. The braking distance needed, for example, at 60 km/h (37 mph) will be approximately 4 times greater than the braking distance needed at 30 km/h (19 mph). Start to brake the vehicle when there is plenty of distance between your vehicle and the stopping point, and slow down gradually. To turn off the cruise control system, push the “ON/OFF” switch (1) and make sure the “CRUISE” indicator light is off. Also, if the malfunction indicator light in the instrument cluster comes on or blinks, the cruise control system will be turned off. 3-28 79K21-03E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) WARNING If water gets into the brake drums, brake performance may become poor and unpredictable. After driving through water or washing the underside of the vehicle, test the brakes while driving at a slow speed to see if they have maintained their normal effectiveness. If the brakes are less effective than normal, dry them by repeatedly applying the brakes while driving slowly until the brakes have regained their normal effectiveness. WARNING Even without reserve power in the brake system, you can still stop the vehicle by pressing the brake pedal harder than normally required. However, the stopping distance may be longer. Brake Assist System When you slam the brakes on, the brake assist system judges as an emergency stop and provides more powerful braking for a driver who cannot hold down the brake pedal firmly. Power-Assisted Brakes Your vehicle has power-assisted brakes. If power assistance is lost due to a stalled engine or other failures, the system is still fully operational on reserve power and you can bring the vehicle to a complete stop by pressing the brake pedal once and holding it down. The reserve power is partly used up when you depress the brake pedal and reduces each time the pedal is pressed. Apply smooth and even pressure to the pedal. Do not pump the pedal. NOTE: If you quickly and forcefully depress the brakes, you may hear a clicking sound in the brake pedal. This is normal and indicates that the brake assist system is activated properly. ABS will help you avoid skidding by electronically controlling braking pressure. It will also help you maintain steering control when braking on slippery surfaces or when braking hard. The ABS works automatically, so you do not need any special braking technique. Just push the brake pedal down without pumping. The ABS will operate whenever it senses that the wheels are locking up. You may feel the brake pedal pulsate while the ABS is operating. NOTE: The ABS will not work if vehicle speed is under about 6 km/h (4 mph). 3-29 79K21-03E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE WARNING • On some types of loose surfaces (such as gravel, snow-covered roads, etc.), the stopping distance required for an ABS-equipped vehicle may be slightly greater than for a comparable vehicle with a conventional brake system. With a conventional brake system, skidding tires are able to “plow” the gravel or snow layer, shortening the stopping distance. ABS minimizes this resistance effect. Allow for extra stopping distance when driving on loose surfaces. • On regular paved roads, some drivers may be able to obtain slightly shorter stopping distances with conventional brake systems than with ABS. • In both of the above conditions, ABS will still offer the advantage of helping you maintain directional control. However, remember that ABS will not compensate for bad road or weather conditions or poor driver judgment. Use good judgment and do not drive faster than conditions will safely allow. WARNING or (1) (Continued) If the warning light comes on briefly then turns off, the system is normal. If the warning light still stays on, have the system inspected by your SUZUKI dealer immediately. If the ABS system becomes inoperative, the brake system will function as an ordinary brake system that has no ABS. (2) (3) 65D451 (1) ABS warning light Type 1 (2) ABS warning light Type 2 (3) Brake system warning light WARNING If the ABS warning light ((1) or (2)) on the instrument panel comes on and stays on while driving, there may be a problem with the ABS system. If this happens: 1) Pull off the road and stop carefully. 2) Turn the ignition switch to “LOCK” and then start the engine again. (Continued) WARNING If the ABS warning light ((1) or (2)) and the Brake system warning light (3) on the instrument panel simultaneously stay on or come on when driving, both anti-lock function and rear brake force control function (Proportioning valve function) of the ABS system may have failed. This could cause the rear wheels to skid or the vehicle to spin during braking on a slippery road or hard braking on a dry paved road. If both warning lights come on, drive carefully, avoiding hard braking as much as possible, and ask your SUZUKI dealer to inspect the ABS system immediately. 3-30 79K21-03E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE How the ABS Works A computer continuously monitors wheel speed. The computer compares the changes in wheel speed when braking. If the wheels slow suddenly, indicating a skidding situation, the computer will change braking pressure several times each second to prevent the wheels from locking. When you start your vehicle or when you accelerate after a hard stop, you may hear a momentary motor or clicking sound as the system resets or checks itself. WARNING The ABS may not work properly if tires or wheels other than those specified in the owner’s manual are used. This is because the ABS works by comparing changes in wheel speed. When replacing tires or wheels, use only the size and type specified in this owner’s manual. Electronic Stability Program (ESP®) The ESP® has the following three systems: ESP® is a registered trademark of Daimler AG. The vehicle stability control system helps provide integrated control of systems such as anti-lock brakes, traction control, engine control, etc. This system automatically controls the brakes and engine to help prevent the vehicle from skidding when cornering on a slippery road surface or when turning the steering wheel abruptly. The Electronic Stability Program (ESP®) helps to control the vehicle during cornering if front wheels or rear wheels skid. It also assists you in maintaining traction while accelerating on loose or slippery road surfaces. It does this by regulating the engine’s output, and by selectively applying the brakes. In addition, ESP® helps to avoid skidding by controlling braking pressure. WARNING ESP® The cannot enhance the vehicle’s driving stability in all situations and does not control your vehicle’s entire braking system. The ESP® cannot prevent accidents, including those resulting from excessive speed in turns, or hydroplaning. Only a safe and attentive driver can prevent accidents. The capabilities of an ESP®equipped vehicle must never be used as a substitute for careful driving. Stability Control System Traction Control System The traction control system automatically helps prevent the spinning of wheels when the vehicle is started or accelerated on slippery road surfaces. The system operates only if it senses that some of the wheels are spinning or beginning to lose traction. When this happens, the system operates the front or rear brakes and reduces engine power to limit wheel spin. NOTE: You may hear a clicking sound in the engine compartment for a few seconds when you start the engine or just after the vehicle begins to move. This means that the above systems are in the self-check mode. This sound does not indicate a malfunction. 3-31 79K21-03E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Anti-Lock Braking System (ABS) ABS will help you avoid skidding by electronically controlling braking pressure. It will also help you maintain steering control when braking on slippery surfaces or when braking hard. The ABS works automatically, so you do not have to use any special braking technique. Just push the brake pedal down without pumping. The ABS will operate whenever it senses that wheels are locking up. You may feel the brake pedal pulsate while the ABS is operating. (For more information on ABS, see “Braking” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section.) NOTE: If the ABS system is activated, you may hear a clunking noise and/or feel pulsating in the brake pedal. This is normal and indicates that the brake fluid pressure is being controlled properly. WARNING • The ESP® may not work properly if tires or wheels other than those specified in the Owner’s Manual are used. When replacing tires or wheels, use only the size and type specified in this Owner’s Manual. • The ESP® may not work properly if tires are not inflated to the recommended tire inflation pressure. • The ESP® may not work properly if tires are fitted with tire chains. • The ESP® may not work properly if the tires are excessively worn. Be sure to replace tires when the tread wear indicators in the grooves appear on the tread surface. • The ESP® is not a substitute for winter tires or tire chains on a snow covered road. WARNING • The ESP® may not work properly if engine related parts such as the muffler are not equivalent to standard equipment or are extremely deteriorated. • Do not modify the vehicle’s suspension since the ESP® may not operate correctly. The ESP® indicator lights are described below: SLIP Indicator Light 79K019 The SLIP indicator light in the instrument cluster blinks 5 times per second when one of the following systems is activated. • Stability control system • Traction control system • Hill descent control system (if equipped) CAUTION If the SLIP indicator light comes on and stays on while driving, there may be a malfunction of the ESP® systems (other than ABS). You should have the systems inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer. NOTE: When the SLIP indicator light comes on and stays on while driving, indicating a malfunction of the ESP® systems (other than ABS), the brake system will function as an ordinary ABS with no additional ESP® functions. 3-32 79K21-03E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE NOTE: When you disconnect and re-connect the battery, ESP® system functions other than ABS will be deactivated and the slip indicator light will blink 1 time per second. In this case, use the following procedure to reactivate the ESP® systems: 1) Drive your vehicle straight ahead without tire slippage at a speed greater than approximately 15 km/h (9 mph) for a few seconds 2) The slip indicator light will go out and the ESP® systems (other than ABS) will be re-activated It may take more than few seconds before the slip indicator light goes out depending on the road surface condition. “ESP” Warning Light “ESP OFF” Indicator Light 66J031 66J032 When the ESP® systems (other than ABS) have a system malfunction, the “ESP” warning light in the instrument cluster comes on. You should turn the ESP® on during your ordinary driving, so that you have the benefits of all of the ESP® systems. CAUTION If the “ESP” warning light comes on, or stays on while driving, there may be a malfunction of the ESP® systems (other than ABS). You should have the systems inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer. It may be required to turn the ESP® systems (other than ABS) off if your vehicle is stuck in sand, mud, or snow, or when driving in extreme off-road conditions where wheel spin is necessary. NOTE: When the “ESP” warning light comes on, or stays on while driving, indicating a malfunction of the ESP® systems (other than ABS), the brake system will function as an ordinary ABS that has no additional ESP® functions. NOTE: The information display shows the warning and indicator message when this light comes on. 3-33 79K21-03E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE “ESP OFF” switch (without hill descent control) (1) 78K045 (1) “ESP OFF” switch (with hill descent control) (1) 78K046 (1) “ESP OFF” switch When the “ESP OFF” switch located at the center of the instrument panel is pushed and held to turn off the ESP® systems (other than ABS), the “ESP OFF” indicator light in the instrument cluster comes on. When you push and hold the “ESP OFF” switch again, the “ESP OFF” indicator light will go out and all of the ESP® systems will be activated. light will come on. After a short period of time, the ESP® systems (other than ABS) will turn on automatically and the “ESP OFF” indicator light will go out. • If your vehicle is equipped with a hill descent control system and a hill hold control system, these systems will not be turned off when the “ESP OFF” switch is pushed to turn off the ESP® systems. NOTE: • When the vehicle speed is greater than approximately 30 km/h (19 mph), the ESP® systems (other than ABS) will turn on automatically and the “ESP OFF” indicator light will go out. • When the transfer switch (if equipped) is turned to the “4L LOCK” position, the ESP® systems (other than ABS) will be canceled to provide improved vehicle traction, and the “ESP OFF” indicator light will come on. When the transfer switch (if equipped) is turned to the “4L LOCK” position, braketraction control can be activated. Braketraction control brakes the spinning wheel to distribute drive power to the other wheels for increased climbing ability or for better performance on a rolling hill or a slippery surface. • If the ESP® systems operate continuously, such as when driving on slippery roads, the traction control functions of the ESP® systems may be canceled temporarily to avoid overheating the brake pads, and the “ESP OFF” indicator NOTE: If you push the “ESP OFF” switch when the transfer switch is in the “4H” position, the ESP® systems will not be turned off, and the message shown in the above illustration will appear on the information display. You should turn the transfer switch to the “4H LOCK” position to turn off the ESP® systems. Refer to “Using the Transfer Switch” in this section. 79K084 ABS Warning Light / Brake System Warning Light See “Braking” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section. 3-34 79K21-03E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Hill descent control System (if equipped) Hill descent control switch The hill descent control system is designed to reduce the driver’s workload when going down steep, rough and/or slippery hills where the vehicle cannot decelerate enough by engine braking alone. The hill descent control system helps to control vehicle speed by automatically engaging the vehicle’s brakes, as needed, so you can concentrate on steering the vehicle. (1) WARNING Do not rely excessively on the hill descent control system. The hill descent control system may not control vehicle speed on a hill under all load or road conditions. Always be prepared to control vehicle speed by applying the brakes. Failure to pay attention and control vehicle speed using the brakes when necessary may result in loss of control or an accident. 79K051 (1) Hill descent control switch To activate the hill descent control system: 1) Turn the transfer switch to the “4H LOCK” or “4L LOCK” position. 2) Shift the gearshift lever into a forward gear or reverse gear. 3) Push the hill descent control switch (1) when the vehicle speed is under 25 km/ h (15 mph). The hill descent control indicator on the instrument cluster will come on and the hill descent control system will be activated. approximately 5 km/h (3 mph) when going down a hill. The brake/tail lights come on and the slip indicator light blinks while the hill descent control system applies the brakes to maintain the vehicle speed. If the accelerator or brake pedal is depressed while the hill descent control system is activated, the system will stop working temporarily. As soon as the accelerator or brake pedal is released, the hill descent control system begins to function again if the hill descent control operating conditions are fulfilled. However, when the vehicle speed exceeds 25 km/h (15 mph), the hill descent control system will be deactivated automatically. To deactivate the hill descent control system, push the hill descent control switch again. If the transfer switch is in the “4H LOCK” position, vehicle speed is maintained at approximately 10 km/h (6 mph) when going down a hill. If the transfer switch is in the “4L LOCK” position, the vehicle speed is maintained at 3-35 79K21-03E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Hill descent control Indicator Light CAUTION • When the hill descent control system is used continuously for a long time, the temperature of the brake system may increase and the hill descent control system may be deactivated temporarily to protect the device of the brake system. The hill descent control indicator blinks to let you know the system is deactivated. Depress the brake pedal and stop the vehicle in a safe place. When the temperature of the brake system goes down, the hill descent control indicator will come on and the system is activated again. • The hill descent control system may be activated when the gearshift lever is in the “N” (Neutral) position, but engine braking will not work. Always use the hill descent control system with the gearshift lever in a forward gear or reverse gear. NOTE: You may hear a sound coming from the engine when the hill descent control system is activated. This sound is normal and does not indicate a malfunction. 79K050 When the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” position, this light comes on briefly so you can check that the light is working. NOTE: If any of the following conditions occur, there may be a problem with the hill descent control system or the ESP® system. Have your vehicle inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer. • The hill descent control indicator does not come on or blink when you push the hill descent control switch. • The hill descent control indicator stays on when driving without pushing the hill descent control switch. When you push the hill descent control switch and the hill descent control operating conditions are fulfilled, the hill descent control indicator comes on. If the hill descent control indicator blinks, the hill descent control will not be activated. 79K072 NOTE: If the hill descent control indicator blinks when you push the hill descent control switch, following conditions may not be fulfilled. • The transfer switch is in the “4H LOCK” or “4L LOCK” position • The gearshift lever is in a forward gear or reverse gear • The vehicle speed is under 25 km/h (15 mph) • The brake system is under normal operating temperature If the message shown in the above illustration appears on the information display, there may be a problem with the hill descent control system and the hill hold control system. Have your vehicle inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer. NOTE: You cannot activate the hill descent control system while this message is displayed. 3-36 79K21-03E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Hill hold control System (if equipped) The hill hold control system is designed to assist you in starting to move up steep or slippery hills. When you start to move up a hill, the system helps to prevent the vehicle from rolling downward temporarily (for approximately 2 seconds) while you move your foot from the brake pedal to the accelerator pedal. WARNING • Do not rely excessively on the hill hold control system. The hill hold control system may not prevent the vehicle from rolling downward on a hill under all load or road conditions. Always be prepared to depress the brake pedal to prevent the vehicle from rolling downward. Failure to pay attention and depress the brake pedal to hold the vehicle on a hill when necessary, may result in loss of control or an accident. • The hill hold control system is not designed to stop the vehicle on a hill. (Continued) WARNING (Continued) • After you release your foot from the brake pedal, start the vehicle to move up immediately. If you release your foot from the brake pedal over 2 seconds, the hill hold control system will be canceled. If so, the vehicle may roll downward depends on the degree of the slope which can result in an accident. And, the engine may stall and the power assist for the steering and brakes will not work so steering and braking will be much harder than usual which can result in an accident or vehicle damage. 79K072 If the message shown in the above illustration appears on the information display, there may be a problem with the hill descent control system and the hill hold control system. Have your vehicle inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer. NOTE: The hill hold control system will not activate while this message is displayed. The hill hold control system activates for approximately 2 seconds if your foot is moved from the brake pedal when the following condition are all fulfilled. 1) The transfer switch is in a position other than “N”. 2) The gearshift lever is in a forward gear or reverse gear. 3) The parking brake is released. NOTE: You may hear a sound coming from the engine when the hill hold control system is activated. This sound is normal and does not indicate a malfunction. 3-37 79K21-03E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) (if equipped) The tire pressure monitoring system is designed to alert you when one or more of the tires on your vehicle is significantly under-inflated. A Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) sensor containing a unique identification code is mounted on each wheel. The TPMS sensors transmit tire pressure signals to a central receiver which relays the information to a tire pressure monitoring system controller. When the inflation pressure of one or more tires indicates significant under-inflation, the low tire pressure warning light shown below comes on. NOTE: The TPMS controller is not programmed to recognize the ID code of the TPMS sensor in your spare tire. The tire pressure monitoring system will only work with the spare tire if you bring your vehicle to an authorized SUZUKI dealer to register the ID code of the spare tire sensor. Refer to “Replacing Tires and/or Wheels” in this section. Low Tire Pressure Warning Light WARNING 52D305 WARNING Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be checked monthly when cold and inflated to the inflation pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehicle has tires of a different size than the size indicated on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label, you should determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those tires.) As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with a tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated. (Continued) (Continued) Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you should stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure. Driving on a significantly underinflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle’s handling and stopping ability. Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire maintenance, and it is the driver’s responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure, even if under-inflation has not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure telltale. 3-38 79K21-03E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE WARNING The tire pressure monitoring system is not a substitute for regular tire pressure inspections. Check tire inflation pressures monthly when cold and set to the recommended inflation pressure as specified on the vehicle’s tire information placard and in the owner’s manual. Refer to “Tires” in the “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section. WARNING If the low tire pressure warning light does not come on when the ignition is turned to the “ON” position, or comes on and blinks while driving there may be a problem with the tire pressure monitoring system. Have your vehicle inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer. Even if the light turns off after blinking, indicating that the monitoring system has recovered, make sure to have an authorized SUZUKI dealer check the system. WARNING The load rating of your tires is reduced at lower inflation pressures. If your tires become even moderately under-inflated, the vehicle load may exceed the load rating of the tires, which can lead to tire failure. The low tire pressure warning light will not alert you of this condition. The warning light will only come on when one or more of your tires become significantly under-inflated. Check and adjust your tire inflation pressure at least once a month. Refer to “Tires” in the “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section. WARNING If the low tire pressure warning light comes on and stays on, reduce your speed and avoid abrupt steering and braking. Stop in a safe place as soon as possible and check your tires. • If you have a flat tire, replace it with the spare tire. Refer to “Jacking Instructions” in the “EMERGENCY SERVICE” section. Refer to “Replacing Tires and/or Wheels” for instructions on how to restore normal operation of the tire pressure monitoring system after you have had a flat tire. • If one or more of your tires is under-inflated adjust the inflation pressure in all of your tires to the recommended inflation pressure as soon as possible. Be aware that driving on a significantly under-inflated tire can cause the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure, and may affect steering control and brake effectiveness. This could lead to an accident, resulting in severe injury or death. The low tire pressure warning light can come on due to normal causes such as natural air leaks and pressure changes caused by changes in temperature or atmospheric pressure. Adjusting the air pressure in the tires to the pressure shown 3-39 79K21-03E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE on the tire information placard should cause the low tire pressure warning light to turn off. If the light turns on again shortly after adjusting the pressure in your tires, you may have a flat tire. If you have a flat tire, replace it with the spare tire. Refer to “Jacking Instructions” in the “EMERGENCY SERVICE” section. Refer to “Replacing Tires and/or Wheels” for instructions on how to restore normal operation of the tire pressure monitoring system after you have had a flat tire. NOTE: • When the tire inflation pressure is adjusted in high altitude areas, the low tire pressure light may not turn off even after tire inflation pressure adjustment. In this case, adjust the inflation pressure to a slightly higher pressure than is shown on the tire information placard. • The low tire pressure warning light may turn off temporarily after coming on. This could be due to surface temperature increases after long distance driving or traveling to a high temperature area. Even if the tire pressure warning light turns off after coming on, make sure to check the inflation pressure of all tires. • To reduce the chance that the low tire pressure warning light will come on due to normal changes in temperature and atmospheric pressure, it is important to check and adjust the tire pressures when the tires are cold. Tires that appear to be at the specified pressure when checked after driving, when the tires are warm, could have pressure below the specification when the tires cool down. Also, tires that are inflated to the specified pressure in a warm garage may have pressure below the specification when the vehicle is driven outside in very cold temperature. If you adjust the tire pressure in a garage that is warmer than the outside temperature, you should add 1 psi to the recommended cold tire inflation pressure for every 10°F difference between garage temperature and outside temperature. For tire inflation pressure information, refer to “Tire Inflation Pressure” in the “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section. TPMS Malfunction Indicator WARNING Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate when the system is not operating properly. WARNING The TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire pressure telltale. When the system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for approximately one minute and then remain continuously illuminated. This sequence will continue upon subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists. When you turn off the engine, however, the malfunction indicator resets. It takes about ten minutes after restarting the engine for the malfunction to be detected again and for the light to start flashing. WARNING When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may not be able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety of reasons, including the installation of replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS to continue to function properly. 3-40 79K21-03E OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE CAUTION • The tire pressure sensors can be damaged by the installation or removal of tires. When tires must be repaired or replaced, we highly recommend that you have them repaired or replaced by an authorized SUZUKI dealer. • Do not use liquid sealants for a flat tire as air pressure sensors can be damaged. • If the low tire pressure warning light comes on frequently, there may be something wrong with one of the tires or with the monitoring system. Have your vehicle inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer. TPMS Limitations The tire pressure monitoring system may not function properly under certain circumstances. In the following situations, the low tire pressure warning light may come on and remain on or may blink. • When you replace a flat tire with the spare tire. • When you include the spare tire during a tire rotation. • When the TPMS sensor is damaged during a tire replacement or liquid sealants are used to repair a flat tire. • When the TPMS sensor’s electronic signal is disturbed in one of the following ways: – Electric devices or facilities using similar radio wave frequencies are nearby. – A lot of snow or ice covers the vehicle, in particular, around the wheels or wheel housings. – Snow tires or tire chains are used. • When you use non-genuine SUZUKI wheels or tires. Replacing Tires and/or Wheels If you get a flat tire, Suzuki recommends that you have an authorized SUZUKI dealer mount a new tire on the wheel that had the flat tire, and reinstall this tire on the vehicle in place of the spare. The TPMS is already set up to recognize the ID code of the original wheel, and normal TPMS operation will be restored. If you wish to operate your vehicle with the spare tire installed, you must have an authorized SUZUKI dealer set up the TPMS to recognize the ID code of the spare tire TPMS sensor. If you need to replace any wheels on your vehicle, your dealer must make sure that TPMS sensors are installed in the new wheels and must set up the TPMS to recognize the new sensors. WARNING Only use tires and wheels recommended by SUZUKI as standard or optional equipment for your vehicle. Use of tires or wheels not recommended by SUZUKI can result in TPMS failure. Refer to “Tires” in the “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section for additional information. For Vehicles Sold in U.S.A. This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: 1) This device may not cause harmful interference. 2) This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. NOTE: Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment. Traveling to CANADA Please note that service for the tire pressure monitoring system may not be available in CANADA should there be any problems or malfunctions in the system. 3-41 79K21-03E DRIVING TIPS DRIVING TIPS Important Vehicle Design Features To Know ................... 4-1 Break-In ................................................................................ 4-2 Catalytic Converter ............................................................. 4-2 Improving Fuel Economy ................................................... 4-3 On-Pavement Driving .......................................................... 4-4 Off-Road Driving ................................................................. 4-6 4 60G409 79K21-03E Important Vehicle Design Features To Know: NO DRIVING TIPS Important Vehicle Design Features To Know EXAMPLE WARNING 52D078S WARNING • Wear Your Seat Belts at All Times. Even though air bags are equipped at the front seating positions, the driver and all passengers should be properly restrained at all times, using the seat belts provided. Refer to the “Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems” section for instructions on proper use of the seat belts. • Never drive while under the influence of alcohol or other drugs. Alcohol and drugs can seriously impair your ability to drive safely, greatly increasing the risk of injury to yourself and others. You should also avoid driving when you are tired, sick, irritated or under stress. Your multipurpose vehicle has handling characteristics that differ from those of a conventional passenger car. For the safety of you and your passengers, please read the following section very carefully. Multipurpose vehicles such as your new SUZUKI have higher ground clearance and a narrower track than conventional passenger cars, to make them capable of performing in a wide variety of off-road applications. Specific design characteristics give them a higher center of gravity than ordinary cars. An advantage of the higher ground clearance is a better view of the road allowing you to anticipate problems. They are not designed for cornering at the same speed as conventional passenger cars any more than low-slung sports cars are designed to perform satisfactorily under off-road conditions. If at all possible, avoid sharp turns or abrupt maneuvers. As with other vehicles of this type, failure to operate this vehicle correctly may result in loss of control or vehicle rollover. 65D218 In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is significantly more likely to die than a person wearing a seat belt. Important Differences Between Your Multipurpose Vehicle and Ordinary Passenger Cars Higher Ground Clearance The higher ground clearance of your vehicle enables it to clear off-road obstacles, such as rocks and tree stumps, that ordinary passenger cars cannot drive over. An unavoidable result of this higher ground clearance is that the vehicle also has a higher center of gravity. Consequently, your vehicle will handle differently than a vehicle with a lower center of gravity. Multipurpose vehicles have a significantly higher rollover rate than other types of vehicles. 4-1 79K21-03E Important Vehicle Design Features To Know: NO On-Pavement Driving: NO DRIVING TIPS Shorter Wheelbase Along with its higher ground clearance, your vehicle has a shorter wheelbase and shorter front and rear overhangs than many passenger cars. These features combine to allow you to drive your vehicle over hillcrests without hanging up on them or damaging the frame and chassis components. The shorter wheelbase also makes the steering of your vehicle more responsive than that of vehicles with longer wheelbases. Narrower Body Width and Track Your vehicle is narrower than the average passenger car so that it can pass through tight spaces. Without the essential characteristics described above: higher ground clearance, shorter wheelbase and narrower body width and track – your vehicle could not provide you with excellent off road driving performance. However, it is also true that on-pavement driving, handling and steering will be different from what drivers experience with a conventional passenger car. Break-In Catalytic Converter CAUTION The future performance and reliability of the engine depends on the care and restraint exercised during its early life. It is especially important to observe the following precautions during the initial 960 km (600 miles) of vehicle operation. • After starting, do not race the engine. Warm it up gradually. • Avoid prolonged vehicle operation at a constant speed. Moving parts will break in better if you vary your speed. • Start off from a stop slowly. Avoid full throttle starts. • Avoid hard stopping, especially during the first 320 km (200 miles) of driving. • Do not drive slowly with the transmission in a high gear. • Drive the vehicle at moderate engine speeds. • Do not tow a trailer during the first 960 km (600 miles) of vehicle operation. EXAMPLE 54G236 The purpose of the catalytic converter is to minimize the amount of harmful pollutants in your vehicle’s exhaust. Use of leaded fuel in vehicles equipped with catalytic converters is prohibited by federal law, because lead deactivates the pollutantreducing components of the catalyst system. The converter is designed to last the life of the vehicle under normal usage and when unleaded fuel is used. No special maintenance is required on the converter. However, it is very important to keep the engine properly tuned. Engine misfiring, which can result from an improperly tuned engine, may cause overheating of the catalyst. This may result in permanent heat damage to the catalyst and other vehicle components. 4-2 79K21-03E On-Pavement Driving: NO Off-Road Driving: NO DRIVING TIPS Improving Fuel Economy CAUTION To minimize the possibility of catalyst or other vehicle damage: • Maintain the engine in the proper operating condition. • In the event of an engine malfunction, particularly one involving engine misfire or other apparent loss of performance, have the vehicle serviced promptly. • Do not shut off the engine or interrupt the ignition when the transmission is in gear and the vehicle is in motion. • Do not try to start the engine by pushing or towing the vehicle or coasting down a hill. • Do not idle the engine with any spark plug wires disconnected or removed, such as during diagnostic testing. • Do not idle the vehicle for prolonged periods if idling seems rough or there are other malfunctions. • Do not allow the fuel tank to get near the empty level. The following instructions will help you improve fuel economy. Avoid excessive idling If you are to wait for more than a minute while you are parked, stop the engine and start it again later. When warming up a cold engine, allow the engine to idle until the temperature gauge pointer comes up to the “C” position. In this position, the engine is sufficiently warm for starting off. 54G584S WARNING Be careful where you park and drive; the catalytic converter and other exhaust components can get very hot. As with any vehicle, do not park or operate this vehicle in areas where combustible materials such as dry grass or leaves can come in contact with a hot exhaust system. Avoid “jackrabbit” starts Fast starts away from lights or stop signs will consume fuel unnecessarily and shorten engine life. Start off slowly. Avoid unnecessary stops Avoid unnecessary deceleration and stopping. Try to maintain a slow, steady speed whenever possible. Slowing down and then accelerating again uses more fuel. Keep a steady cruising speed Keep as constant a speed as road and traffic conditions will permit. 4-3 79K21-03E Off-Road Driving: NO DRIVING TIPS On-Pavement Driving Keep the air cleaner clean Government data show that most rollover accidents for multi-purpose vehicles are caused when a driver loses control of the vehicle and leaves the paved portion of the roadway striking a ditch, curb or other offroad object that causes the vehicle to overturn. The following driving practices may reduce the risk of rollover. EXAMPLE 60A183S If the air cleaner is clogged with dust, there will be greater intake resistance, resulting in decreased power output and increased fuel consumption. Keep weight to a minimum The heavier the load, the more fuel the vehicle consumes. Take out any luggage or cargo when it is not necessary. Keep tire pressure correct Underinflation of the tires can waste fuel due to increased running resistance of the tires. Keep your tires inflated to the correct pressure shown on the label located below the driver’s side door latch striker. Vehicle Slides Off-Road You can reduce the risk of this kind of rollover accident by always keeping the vehicle under control. Typically, drivers lose control of vehicles, often resulting in rollover accidents, when the driver is impaired because of alcohol or other drugs, falls asleep at the wheel or is otherwise inattentive, or is driving too fast for the road conditions. Rollovers On the Roadway If, for any reason, your vehicle slides sideways or spins out of control at highway speeds, while on the paved portion of the roadway, the risk of rollover is greatly increased. This condition can be created when two or more wheels drop off onto the shoulder and you steer sharply in an attempt to reenter the roadway. To reduce the risk of rollover in these circumstances, if conditions permit, you should hold the steering wheel firmly and slow down before pulling back into the travel lanes with controlled steering movements. All Types of Rollover Accidents As with many kinds of automobile accidents, rollovers can be greatly reduced by doing what all prudent drivers should do, i.e., don’t drink and drive, don’t drive when tired and don’t do anything behind the wheel that could cause a loss of attention to the driving task. Additional guidelines are set out below for your on-road driving. Know Your Vehicle Take time to familiarize yourself with the unique handling characteristics of your vehicle by first driving around in an area away from traffic. Practice turning the vehicle at a variety of speeds and in different directions. Get a feel for the greater steering response that your vehicle has over a conventional car. Wear Your Seat Belts at All Times The driver and all passengers should be properly restrained at all times, using the seat belts provided. Refer to the “Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems” section for instructions on proper use of the seat belts. 4-4 79K21-03E Off-Road Driving: NO DRIVING TIPS Don’t Make Sharp Turns As mentioned before, small multipurpose vehicles have specific design characteristics that allow them to perform in a wide variety of applications. These characteristics also change the cornering behavior relative to conventional passenger cars. Remember, small multipurpose vehicles have more responsive steering and a higher center of gravity than conventional passenger cars. If at all possible, avoid making sharp turns in your vehicle. Slow Down on Curves Learn to approach curves cautiously and at a conservative speed. Do not attempt to take curves at the same speeds that you would in a vehicle with a lower center of gravity. Just as you would not drive a sports car on a trail, you should not attempt to drive your vehicle around curves like a sports car. Slow Down and Use Caution on Slippery Roads Under wet road conditions you should drive at a lower speed than on dry roads due to possible slippage of tires during braking. When driving on icy, snowcovered or muddy roads, reduce your speed and avoid sudden acceleration, abrupt braking or sharp steering movements. Use 4-wheel drive high range (4H) (if equipped) for better traction. CAUTION CAUTION Do not operate your vehicle in “4H LOCK” or “4L LOCK” on dry, hard surfaces. Operating your vehicle in “4H LOCK” or “4L LOCK” on dry, hard surfaces puts severe stress to the drive train, especially during tight cornering, and can damage it. Also, you may have some difficulty steering. Unevenly worn tires can cause problems in the operation of the transfer switch. Be sure to rotate the tires according to the maintenance schedule. Refer to “Tires” and “Maintenance Schedule” in the “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section for proper tire rotation procedures. NOTE: Avoid operating your vehicle in “4H LOCK” or “4L LOCK” on wet pavement as much as possible. Operating your vehicle in “4H LOCK” or “4L LOCK” on wet pavement may cause severe damage to the drive train. NOTE: Operating your vehicle in “4H” on dry and tight corner may cause some vibration on your vehicle. This is not caused by the vehicle malfunction, but caused by working of the limited slip differential gear in the center differential. 4-5 79K21-03E DRIVING TIPS Off-Road Driving Your vehicle has specific design characteristics for off-road driving. When you leave the pavement, you will encounter driving surfaces of all kinds which may change continually as you drive. In most cases, offroad driving requires the use of 4-wheel drive. If your vehicle is a 2-wheel drive vehicle, you should limit your off-road driving only to hard, flat, nonslippery surfaces. 2-wheel drive vehicles have far less traction on off-road surfaces than 4-wheel drive vehicles. It is important when driving off-road to follow the guidelines below. Use Caution on Steep Inclines Always inspect hills before you attempt to drive up them. Know what is on the other side and how you will get back down. If you have any doubt that it is safe, do not attempt to drive over a hill. Never drive your vehicle up an extremely steep incline. Coming down a steep hill can be trickier than getting up one. Keep the vehicle heading straight down the hill and use low gear. Do not lock the brakes. If the vehicle begins to slide, accelerate slightly to regain steering control. Do Not Turn on or Drive Across the Side of Hills Turning on or driving across the side of a hill can be extremely hazardous. Most of the vehicle’s weight will be transferred to the downhill tires, which could result in the vehicle rolling sideways. Whenever possible, avoid this potential hazard. Also, if you have to exit your vehicle on a side-hill, always get out on the uphill side. Wear Your Seat Belts at All Times You and your passengers should use the seat belts at all times when driving offroad. For proper seat belt use, refer to the “Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems” section in this manual. Avoid Sudden Reactions in Mud, Ice or Snow Be careful when off-road conditions are slick. Reduce your speed and avoid sudden movements of the vehicle. If your vehicle is a 2-wheel drive vehicle, do not drive in deep snow or mud. If your vehicle is a 4wheel drive vehicle, be aware that driving in deep snow or mud can cause a loss of traction and an increase in the resistance to the vehicle’s forward motion. Use 4WD low gear (4L) and maintain a steady but moderate speed with a light touch on the steering wheel and brakes. Do not drive in the field covered with grown grass If you drive in the field covered with grass, it may cause unexpected accident or vehicle damage by getting caught in grown grass. If Your Vehicle Gets Stuck If your vehicle gets stuck in snow, mud or sand, follow the directions below: 1) (For vehicles equipped with transfer switch) Turn the transfer switch to “4H LOCK” or “4L LOCK”. 2) Shift the transmission back and forth between a forward range (or first gear for manual transmission) and reverse. This will create a rocking motion which may give you enough momentum to free the vehicle. Press gently on the accelerator to keep wheel spin to a minimum. Remove your foot from the accelerator while shifting. Do not race the engine. Excessive wheel spin will cause the tires to dig deeper, making it more difficult to free the vehicle. 3) If your vehicle remains stuck after a few minutes of rocking, get another vehicle to pull you out. 4-6 79K21-03E DRIVING TIPS Tire Chains WARNING • Do not allow anyone to stand near the vehicle when you are rocking it, and do not spin the wheels faster than an indicated 40 km/h (25 mph) on the speedometer. Personal injury and/or vehicle damage may result from spinning the wheels too fast. • Be sure to turn the transfer switch from “4H” to “4H LOCK” or “4L LOCK” when the tires slip in “4H”. The continuing tires slip in “4H” can cause the limited slip differential gear damage in the center differential. CAUTION Release the accelerator pedal when operating the gearshift lever. Operating the lever with the engine racing can damage the gears. CAUTION Do not continue rocking the vehicle for more than a few minutes. Prolonged rocking can cause engine overheating, transmission or transfer case damage or tire damage. Tire chains should only be used if they are needed to increase traction or are required by law. Make sure that the chains you use are small-link chains or cable-type chains and are the correct size for your vehicle’s tires. Also make sure that there is enough clearance between the fenders and the chains as installed on the tires. Install the chains on the rear tires tightly, according to the chain manufacturer’s instructions. Retighten the chains after driving about 1.0 km (1/2 mile) if necessary. With the chains installed, drive slowly. CAUTION If you hear the chains hitting against the vehicle body while driving, stop and tighten them. Do not drive through deep or rushing water Driving in deep or rushing water can be hazardous. You could lose control of the vehicle and the occupants could drown. Also, your vehicle could be seriously damaged. To avoid these risks, observe the following instructions and precautions. • Do not drive through deep or rushing water. Deep or rushing water, such as fast-moving streams or floodwaters, could carry your vehicle away from your intended path. The water is too deep if it covers your wheel hubs, axles or exhaust tailpipe. Know the depth of the water before you attempt to drive through it. • If water blocks the tailpipe, the engine may not start or run. If the water is deep enough to get drawn into the engine intake system, the engine will be badly damaged. • Submerged brakes will have poor braking performance. Drive slowly and carefully. Driving slowly will also help avoid water splashing onto the ignition system, which could cause the engine to stall. • Even when driving through shallow or still waters, drive carefully since the water may be hiding ground hazards such as holes, ditches or bumps. 4-7 79K21-03E DRIVING TIPS WARNING In addition to following the driving tips in this section, it is important to observe the following precautions for on-road and off-road driving. • Driver and passengers should wear seat belts at all times. • Do not let anyone else drive your vehicle unless they are also aware of the vehicle characteristics and handling differences described in this section. • Avoid loaning your vehicle to anyone unless you accompany them. • Make sure your tires are in good condition and always maintain the specified tire pressure. Refer to “Tires” in the “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section for details. • Do not use tires other than those specified by SUZUKI. Never use different sizes or types of tires on the front and rear wheels. For information regarding the specified tires, refer to the Tire Inflation Pressure Label located on the driver’s side door pillar or the “SPECIFICATIONS” section. (Continued) WARNING (Continued) • Never use oversized tires or special shocks and springs to raise (jack up) your vehicle. This will raise the center of gravity of the vehicle and change its handling characteristics. Oversized tires may also rub against the fender over bumps, causing vehicle damage or tire failure. • After driving through water, mud or sandy ground, test the brakes while driving at a slow speed to see if they have maintained their normal effectiveness. If the brakes are less effective than normal, dry them by repeatedly applying the brakes while driving slowly until the brakes have regained their normal effectiveness. • Do not use “4H LOCK” or “4L LOCK” drive for normal driving. • After extended operation in mud, sand or water, have the brakes inspected by your authorized SUZUKI dealer as soon as possible. 4-8 79K21-03E DRIVING TIPS MEMO 4-9 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT 60G407 Automatic Heating and Air Conditioning System (Climate Control) ................................................................. 5-1 Radio Antenna ..................................................................... 5-8 Audio Systems (Type A) ..................................................... 5-8 Audio Systems (Type B) ..................................................... 5-36 Fuel Filler Cap ..................................................................... 5-62 Engine Hood ........................................................................ 5-63 Sun Visor ............................................................................. 5-64 5 Interior Light Switch ........................................................... 5-64 Luggage Compartment Light ............................................. 5-65 Spot Light ............................................................................ 5-66 Accessory Socket (if equipped) ......................................... 5-66 Cigarette Lighter and Ashtray (if equipped) ..................... 5-67 Sunroof (if equipped) .......................................................... 5-68 Assist Grips (if equipped) .................................................. 5-70 Coat Hooks (if equipped) .................................................... 5-70 Glove Box ............................................................................ 5-71 Overhead Console Box (if equipped) ................................ 5-71 Cup Holder and Storage Bin (if equipped) ........................ 5-72 Front Seat Back Pocket (if equipped) ............................... 5-73 Shopping Hook (if equipped) ............................................. 5-73 Armrest ................................................................................ 5-73 Floor Mats (if equipped) ..................................................... 5-74 Luggage Compartment Cover ............................................ 5-74 Underfloor Bins (if equipped) ............................................ 5-77 Luggage Restraint Loops (if equipped) ............................ 5-78 Roof Rails or Roof Rack Anchors (if equipped) ............... 5-78 HomeLink® (if equipped) .................................................... 5-80 Frame Hooks ....................................................................... 5-83 79K21-03E Parking Brake Lever: 6 Pedals: 6 OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Automatic Heating and Air Conditioning System (Climate Control) 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Air Outlet EXAMPLE Windshield defroster outlet Side defroster outlet Side outlet Center outlet Floor outlet Center outlet 1 Open 1 2 EXAMPLE 3 4 2 3 Close 5 64J199 5 5 5 66J250 5-1 79K21-03E Pedals: 6 Gearshift Lever: 10 OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Description of Controls Side outlet (8) (1) (2) (7) (5) (4) (6) (9) (3) 79K020 63J045 When “Open”, air comes out from the side outlets regardless of the air flow selector position. (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) Temperature selector Blower speed selector Air intake selector Air flow selector Defrost switch “OFF” switch “AUTO” switch Air conditioning switch LCD display 5-2 79K21-03E Gearshift Lever: 10 Fuel Filler Cap: 5 OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Blower speed selector (2) Air conditioning switch (8) Temperature selector (1) (1) (2) A/C: OFF A/C: ON (8) 78K047 79K021 78K048 Turn the temperature selector (1) to adjust the temperature. The air conditioning switch (8) is used to turn on and off the air conditioning system. To turn on the air conditioning system, push in the switch and “A/C” will appear on the LCD display. To turn off the air conditioning system, push in the switch again and “A/C” will go off. The blower speed selector (2) is used to turn on the blower and to select blower speed. If the “AUTO” switch (7) is pushed, the blower speed will vary automatically as the climate control system maintains the selected temperature. 5-3 79K21-03E Fuel Filler Cap: 5 Folding Seats: 14 OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT RECIRCULATED AIR (a) When this mode is selected, outside air is shut off and inside air is recirculated. This mode is suitable when driving through an area with polluted air such as a tunnel, or when attempting to quickly cool down the vehicle. Air intake selector (3) (a) Air flow selector (4) FRESH AIR (b) When this mode is selected, outside air is introduced. (b) “FRESH AIR” and “RECIRCULATED AIR” are selected alternately each time the air intake selector is pushed. (3) 79K022 Push the air intake selector (3) to change between the following modes. If the “AUTO” switch (7) is pushed, the air intake will vary automatically as the climate control system maintains the selected temperature. NOTE: If you select “RECIRCULATED AIR” for an extended period of time, the air in the vehicle can become contaminated. Therefore, you should occasionally select “FRESH AIR”. (4) (c) (d) (e) (f) 79K023 Push the air flow selector (4) to change among the following functions. The indication of the selected mode appears on the LCD display. If the “AUTO” switch (7) is pushed, the air flow will vary automatically as the climate control system maintains the selected temperature. 5-4 79K21-03E Folding Seats: 14 OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Heat (e) Ventilation (c) Defrost switch (5) 64J069 64J071 Temperature-controlled air comes out of the center and side air outlets. Temperature-controlled air comes out of the floor outlets and the side outlets, a small amount of air comes out of the windshield defroster outlets and the side defroster outlets. Bi-level (d) Heat & defrost (f) (5) 78K050 Push the defrost switch (5) to turn on the defroster. 64J070 Temperature-controlled air comes out of the floor outlets and cooler air comes out of the center and side outlets. When the temperature selector (1) is in the fully COLD position or fully HOT position, however, the air from the floor outlets and the air from the center and side outlets will be the same temperature. 64J072 Temperature-controlled air comes out of the floor outlets, the windshield defroster outlets, the side defroster outlets and the side outlets. 5-5 79K21-03E Folding Seats: 14 OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT System Operating Instructions Defrost inside temperature below outside temperature. Automatic operation To turn the climate control system off, push the “OFF” switch (6). 66J241 NOTE: If the “AUTO” on the LCD display blinks, there is a problem in the heating system and/or air conditioning system. You should have the system inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer. (7) Temperature-controlled air comes out of the windshield defroster outlets, the side defroster outlets and the side outlets. NOTE: When the defrost switch (5) is pushed to turn on the defroster, the air conditioning system will come on and the “FRESH AIR” mode will be selected automatically. In very cold weather, however, the air conditioning system will not turn on. (6) 78K051 You can let the climate control system work automatically. To set the system for fullyautomatic operation, follow the procedure below. 1) Start the engine. 2) Push the “AUTO” switch (7). 3) Set the desired temperature by turning the temperature selector (1). The blower speed, air intake and air flow are controlled automatically to maintain the set temperature. You can use the air conditioning switch (8) to manually turn the air conditioner on or off according to your preference. When you turn the air conditioning switch off, the climate control system cannot lower the NOTE: • To find the temperature at which you are most comfortable, start with the 22°C (72°F) setting. • If you turn the temperature selector (1) until “HI” or “LO” appears on the LCD display, the climate control system will operate at the maximum cooling or heating and the blower will run at full speed. • To avoid blowing cold air in cold weather or hot air in hot weather, the system will delay turning on the blower until warmed or chilled air is available. • If your vehicle has been left in the sun with the windows closed, it will cool faster if you open the windows briefly. • Even under the automatic operation, you can set individual selectors to the manual mode. The manually selected functions are maintained, and the other functions remain under automatic operation. 5-6 79K21-03E Armrest: 14 Sun Visor: 5 Interior Light Switch: 7 OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Maintenance • To return the blower speed selector (2), air intake selector (3), and air flow selector (4) to automatic operation, push the “AUTO” switch. If you do not use the air conditioner for a long period, such as during winter, it may not give the best performance when you start using it again. To help maintain optimum performance and durability of your air conditioner, it needs to be run periodically. Operate the air conditioner at least once a month for one minute with the engine idling. This circulates the refrigerant and oil and helps protect the internal components. (F) (G) 64J074 EXAMPLE 64J080 Be careful not to cover the interior temperature sensor (F) located between the steering wheel and the climate control panel, or the solar sensor (G) located at the top of the driver’s side dashboard. These sensors are used by the automatic system to regulate temperature. Manual operation You can manually control the climate control system. Set the selectors to the desired positions. NOTE: If you need maximum defrosting: • push the defrost switch (5) to turn on the defroster (the air conditioning system will come on and the “FRESH AIR” mode will be selected automatically), • set the blower speed selector to HIGH, • adjust the temperature selector to the “HI” indication on the LCD display, and • adjust the side outlets so the air blows on the side windows. Your air conditioner is equipped with air filters. Clean or replace them as specified in the “Maintenance Schedule” in the “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section. Have this job done by your SUZUKI dealer as the lower glove box must be lowered for this job. NOTE: Your vehicle uses the air conditioning refrigerant HFC-134a, commonly called “R-134a”. R-134a replaced R-12 around 1993 for automotive applications. Other refrigerants are available, including recycled R-12, but only R-134a should be used in your vehicle. CAUTION Using the wrong refrigerant may damage your air conditioning system. Use R-134a only. Do not mix or replace the R-134a with other refrigerants. 5-7 79K21-03E Interior Light Switch: 7 Spot Light: 7 OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Radio Antenna Audio Systems (type A) Type 2 There are two types of audio system as shown below: Type 1 79K104 63J055 The radio antenna on the roof is removable. To remove the antenna, turn it counterclockwise. To reinstall the antenna, turn it clockwise firmly by hand. CAUTION AM/FM/XM 6-CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL 79K103 AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL To avoid damage to the radio antenna: • Remove the antenna before using an automatic car wash. • Remove the antenna when it is possible for the antenna to hit something such as a low ceiling in a parking garage or putting a car cover over your car. • Remove the antenna before putting a car cover over your vehicle. 5-8 79K21-03E Luggage Compartment Light: 7 Front Door Light: OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Precautions • When the inside of the car is very cold and the player is used soon after switching on the heater, moisture may form on the disc or the optical parts of the player and proper playback may not be possible. If moisture forms on the disc, wipe it off with a soft cloth. If moisture forms on the optical parts of the player, do not use the player for about one hour. This will allow the condensation to disappear normally. • Driving on extremely bumpy roads which cause severe vibrations may cause sound to skip. • This unit uses a precision mechanism. Even in the event that trouble arises, never open the case, disassemble the unit, or lubricate the rotating parts. Please bring the unit to an authorized SUZUKI dealer or a Clarion service Department. Cautions on Handling Never touch the surface. (A) 52D274 52D347 This unit has been designed specifically for playback of compact discs bearing the mark (A). No other discs can be played. To remove fingermarks and dust, use a soft cloth, and wipe in a straight line from the center of the compact disc to the circumference. Removing the disc Proper way to hold the compact disc (B) (C) (B) 52D275 52D277 To remove the compact disc from its storage case, press down on the center of the case and lift the disc out, holding it carefully by the edges. New discs may have some roughness around the edges. The unit may not work or the sound may skip if such discs are used. Use a ball-point pen (B), etc. to remove the roughness (C) from edges of the disc before insertion inside the unit. Always handle the compact disc by the edges. 5-9 79K21-03E Front Seat Heater: 8 OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT 52D348 52D350 Never stick labels on the surface of the compact disc or mark the surface with a pencil or pen. Do not use compact discs that have large scratches, are misshaped, or cracked, etc. Use of such discs will cause damage or prevent the system from operating properly. NOTE: • Do not use commercially available CD protection sheets or discs equipped with stabilizers, etc. These may get caught in the internal mechanism and damage the disc. • CD-R discs may not be able to playback in this unit due to the recording conditions. • CD-RW discs cannot playback in this unit. 52D349 Do not use any solvents such as commercially available cleaners, anti-static spray, or thinner to clean compact discs. 52D351 Do not expose compact discs to direct sunlight or any heat source. 5-10 79K21-03E Assist Grips: 3 Coat Hooks: Sunroof: 5, 8 OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Basic Operations Display (A) Type 1 AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL 79K086 (5) (6) (2) (1) (1) Power on/off knob Volume control knob (2) Tone/balance/fader control knob (3) Preset button 5 (4) Preset button 6 (5) Clock button H (6) Clock button M (3) (4) (A) Clock display Type 2 AM/FM/XM 6-CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (5) (6) (1) (2) (3) (4) 79K105 5-11 79K21-03E Sunroof: 5, 8 OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Turning power on/off Press the power on/off knob (1). The unit starts in the function mode it was in when the power was turned off last. Adjusting the volume Turn the volume control knob (1). Turning it clockwise increases the volume; turning it counterclockwise decreases the volume. • When minutes are between 30 and 59, the clock will reset to the next hour. (example: 12:38 ➔ 1:00) Adjusting bass/treble/balance/fader 1) Press the tone/balance/fader control knob (2). Each time it is pressed, sound adjustment is changed as follows: NOTE: While driving, adjust the volume to an extent that sound and/or noise coming from outside the car can be heard. Bass adjustment (BASS 0) Adjusting the clock 1) Press the clock button H (5) to adjust the hours. Press the clock button M (6) to adjust the minutes. 2) Hold the button depressed to automatically increment the number. 3) To reset the clock to an hour signal, press the clock button H (5) while holding the clock button M (6) depressed. Balance adjustment (BALANCE 0) NOTE: When the clock has not been set, the time “12:00” will flash in the display. Clock reset is effected as follows: • When minutes are between 00 and 29, the clock will reset to the current hour. (example: 12:23 ➔ 12:00) Treble adjustment (TREBLE 0) Adjusting the AVC (Auto volume control) The Auto Volume Control (AVC) function automatically adjusts (increases/ decreases) the sound volume in accordance with vehicle speed. The AVC control is provided with three selectable levels (LEVEL OFF, 1, 2, 3). The range of volume adjustment increases together with the LEVEL number, 1) Press the tone/balance/fader control knob (2) until the AVC adjustment mode is selected. 2) Turn the tone/balance/fader control knob (2) to select the desired AVC adjustment level. (Initial setting: LEVEL 2) Adjusting the contrast of the display 1) Press the tone/balance/fader control knob (2) and preset button 5 (3), preset button 6 (4) simultaneously. 2) To adjust the contrast of the display, turn the power on/off knob (1). Fader adjustment (FADER 0) AVC adjustment (AVC LEVEL 2) Original mode 66J224 2) Turn the tone/balance/fader control knob (2) to adjust the sound. Cancel the dimmer condition Each time you press the power on/off knob (1) for two seconds with the lighting switch on, the background brightness of the audio display will switch between normal and dimmed. 5-12 79K21-03E Sunroof: 5, 8 OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Listening to the Radio Display (C) Type 1 AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (A) (1) (D) 66J097 (2) (3) (6) (B) (4) (5) Type 2 AM/FM/XM 6-CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) Band switch button (FM/AM) Seek up button Seek down button Manual tuning knob Preset buttons (1 to 6) Auto store button (AS)/ Scan button (SCAN) (A) (B) (C) (D) Band Preset channel number Stereo indicator Frequency (2) (3) (6) (1) (4) (5) 79K106 5-13 79K21-03E Engine Hood: 5 OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Selecting the reception band Press the band switch button (1). Each time the button is pressed, the reception band is switched as follows: 66J098 Seek tuning Press the seek up button (2) or the seek down button (3). The unit stops searching for a station at a frequency where a broadcast station is available. Manual tuning Turn the manual tuning knob (4). The frequency being received is displayed. Preset memory 1) Select the desired station. 2) Select the preset button (5) to which you want to store the station and press and hold the button for 2 seconds or longer. Auto store Press and hold the auto store button (6) for 2 seconds or longer. Six stations in total are automatically stored to the preset buttons (5) in sequential order, starting from the lower frequencies. Scan tuning 1) Press the scan button (6). Stations are automatically sought for in a sequential order, starting from a station being currently received, and scan stops for 5 seconds at a frequency where there is a station available. 2) Press the scan button (6) again to stop scanning at the frequency being currently received. Receiving a stereo broadcast station If a stereo broadcast station is received, the stereo indicator will light. NOTE: • When the auto store is performed, the station previously stored in the memory at the position is overwritten. • When there are fewer than 6 stations that can be stored even if 2 rounds of auto store operation are performed, the stations previously stored at the remaining preset buttons (5) are not overwritten. 5-14 79K21-03E Cup Holder and Storage Bin: 3, 14 OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Radio Reception Radio reception can be affected by environment, atmospheric conditions, or radio signal’s power and distance from the station. Nearby mountains and buildings may interfere or deflect radio reception, causing poor reception. Poor reception or radio static can also be caused by electric current from overhead wires or high voltage power lines. Listening to a CD CAUTION (A) 52D274 • CDs or CD-ROMs carrying no mark (A) cannot be used. • Some discs previously recorded in CDR\CD-RW format may not be used. • Never insert your finger or hand into the CD insertion slot. Never insert foreign objects. • Never insert a CD with glue coming out from adhesive tape or a rental CD label or with a trace indicating that adhesive tape or a rental CD label has been removed. This may cause the CD not to eject or result in a malfunction. 52D291 • A CD is inserted with its label facing upward. • When there is a CD already loaded in the unit, another CD cannot be loaded at the same time. Do not use force when inserting the CD into the CD insertion slot. • If a blank disc (non-recorded CD-R) is loaded in the unit, the disc will be ejected. 5-15 79K21-03E Overhead Console Box: Accessory Socket: 8 OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Type 1 AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (Built in CD Player) Display (D) (A) (B) (C) 66J100 (1) (6) (3) (2) (4) (5) 79K107 (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) CD insertion slot CD eject button Disc button (CD/AUX) Track up button/Fast forward button Track down button/Rewind button Repeat button (RPT) (A) (B) (C) (D) Mode indicator Track number Play time Repeat indicator NOTE: About Single CDs (8 cm CDs) • No adapter is required to play a single CD. • A single CD is inserted from the center of the CD insertion slot. • Since an ejected single CD is not automatically reloaded, be sure to remove the ejected single CD. 5-16 79K21-03E Accessory Socket: 8 Cigarette Lighter and Ashtray: 3, 8 OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Loading a CD Insert a CD in the CD insertion slot (1). When a CD is loaded, play starts and the CD indicator (A) lights. Ejecting a CD Press the CD eject button (2). If you left a CD ejected for a period of about 15 seconds, it will be automatically drawn inside the unit. (Auto reload function) The backup eject function: This function allows you to eject a CD with the power turned off by pressing the CD eject button (2). Listening to a CD When a CD is inserted, it is automatically played back. When a CD is already inside the unit, press the disc button (3) to play back the CD. When a CD is inside the unit, the CD indicator (A) is lit on the display unit. Selecting a track • Press the track up button (4) to listen to the next track. • Press the track down button (5) twice to listen to the previous track. When the track down button (5) is pressed once, the track being currently played will return to the beginning. Fast forwarding/Rewinding a track • Hold in the fast forward button (4) to advance a track rapidly. • Hold in the rewind button (5) to rewind a track. Repeat play Press the repeat button (6). The repeat indicator (D) lights and the track currently being played is played repeatedly. Press the repeat button (6) again to cancel repeat play. CAUTION If you forcefully try to push an ejected CD inside the unit before auto reloading, the disc surface might be scratched. 5-17 79K21-03E Frame Hooks: 5, 6 Tire Changing Tools: 3, 5 OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Type 2 AM/FM/XM 6-CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (Built-in CD Changer) Display (F) (A) (B) (C) (D) (E) 66J102 (3) (1) (4) (8) (6) (7) (5) (2) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) Load button (LOAD) Disc select buttons (1 to 6) CD insertion slot CD eject button Disc button (CD/AUX) Track up button/Fast forward button Track down button/Rewind button Repeat button (RPT) (A) (B) (C) (D) (E) (F) Mode indicator Disc number Track number Play time CD indicator Repeat indicator 79K108 5-18 79K21-03E Tire Changing Tools: 3, 5 Shopping Hook: Front Seat Back Pocket: 3 OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT NOTE: About Single CDs (8 cm CDs) • Since the unit is not compatible with a single CD, do not load it into the unit. • Keep in mind the fact that a single CD cannot be played even using a single CD adaptor for the unit. • When a single CD is loaded into the unit accidentally, it will be ejected immediately. Please be sure to remove it. If you forcefully try to push it into the unit without removing it, the CD cannot be ejected. This will result in a damage to the mechanism. Please never do this. Loading one CD 1) Press the load button (1), then press one of the disc select buttons (2) that corresponds to the slot into which you want to load a CD. 66J143 Both the indication “In” and the selected disc number in the CD indicator will blink for about 15 seconds. 2) Load the CD into the CD insertion slot (3). When the CD is loaded, play starts. The disk number in the CD indicator will light. CAUTION You can load a CD only while the indication “In” is blinking for about 15 seconds. During that period, the shutter located in the depth of the CD insertion slot (3) is opened. After 15 seconds time has elapsed, the indication “In” disappears from the display and the shutter closes, making it impossible to load a CD. If you try to load the CD with the shutter closed, the CD may damage the shutter. Never do this. Loading multiple CDs 1) Press the load button (1) for 2 seconds or longer. The indication “CD ALL” appears in the display, and then the indication “In” and a disc number in the CD indicator will blink for about 15 seconds. 2) Load a CD into the CD insertion slot (3). 3) The indication “In” and the next disc number will blink in the display. Load the next CD. 4) After loading the required number of CD’s, press any disc select button (2) to select the desired CD to listen to. If no select button is pressed, play will start from the first loaded CD. Only the numbers in the CD indicator that correspond to the loaded slots will light. Ejecting one CD 1) Select the CD you want to remove with the disc select buttons (2). 2) Press the CD eject button (4). If you leave the ejected CD without removing it, it will be drawn into the unit automatically after about 15 seconds. (Auto reload function) The buck up eject mechanism: This function allows you to eject the CD loaded in the unit with the unit turned off only by pressing the CD eject button (4). 5-19 79K21-03E Underseat Tray: 3 Luggage Restraint Loops: 5 OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Ejecting all the CDs Press the CD eject button (4) for 2 seconds or longer. All the CDs will be ejected from the unit in a sequential manner. • Please prepare a location where removed CDs can be stored. • If you leave the ejected CD without removing it, it will be drawn into the unit automatically after about 15 seconds. (Auto reload function) The buck up eject mechanism: This function allows you to eject the CD loaded in the unit with the unit turned off only by pressing the CD eject button (4). CAUTION If you try to push an ejected CD inside the unit forcibly before auto reloading, the disc surface might be scratched. Listening to a CD 1) When a CD is inserted, it is automatically played back. When a CD is already inside the unit, press the disc button (5) to play back the CD. When a CD is inside the unit, the CD indicator (A) is lit on the display unit. 2) If you want to play another CD, select it with the disc select buttons (2). Play starts from the point on the disc that the unit played last (Last position memory). Selecting a track • Press the track up button (6) to listen to the next track. • Press the track down button (7) twice to listen to the previous track. When the track down button (7) is pressed once, the track being currently played will return to the beginning. Fast forwarding/Rewinding a track • Hold in the fast forward button (6) to advance a track rapidly. • Hold in the rewind button (7) to rewind a track. Repeat play Press the repeat button (8). Each time the button is pressed, repeat play mode changes as follows: TRACK REPEAT OFF DISC REPEAT 66J144 NOTE: This operation should be performed within 2 seconds. To cancel repeat play, press the repeat button (8) several times to change the repeat play mode to OFF. • TRACK REPEAT The indication “TRACK RPT” appears in the display for 2 seconds and then the repeat indicator (F) lights. The track currently being played is played repeatedly. • DISC REPEAT The indication “DISC RPT” appears in the display for 2 seconds and then the repeat indicator (F) lights. When all the tracks on the disc currently being played finish playing, play starts again at the beginning of the disc. 5-20 79K21-03E Luggage Compartment Cover: 5 OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Listening to an MP3/WMA Disc Display (Type 1) (D) Type 1 AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (A) (E) (F) (C) (B) (2) (5) 66J104 (3) (4) Display (Type 2) (D) (1) (A) (B) (E) (F) (C) (G) 66J105 Type 2 AM/FM/XM 6-CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (2) (5) (3) (4) (1) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) Sound control knob Repeat button (RPT) Track up button/Fast forward button Track down button/Rewind button Display button (DISP) (A) (B) (C) (D) (E) (F) (G) Folder number Track number Play time Repeat indicator WMA indicator MP3 indicator CD indicator 79K109 5-21 79K21-03E Underfloor Bins: Roof Rails or Roof Rack Anchors: 5, 13 OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT What is MP3/WMA? MP3 (MPEG1/2 Audio Layer-III) and WMA (Windows MediaTM Audio) are the compression formats of digital audio. The former is developed by MPEG (Motion Picture Experts Group), and the latter is developed by Microsoft Corporation. Using these compression formats, you can record the contents of about 10 music CDs on a single CD media (This figures refer to data recorded on a 650 MB CD-R or CDRW at a fixed bit rate of 128 kbps and a sampling frequency of 44.1 kHz). Points to remember when making MP3/ WMA files Common • High bit rate and high sampling frequency are recommended for high quality sounds. • Selecting VBR (Variable Bit Rate) is not recommended because playing time is not displayed properly and sound may be skipped. • The playback sound quality differs depending on the encoding circumstances. For details, refer to the user manual of your own encoding software and writing software. MP3 • It is recommended to set the bit rate to “128 kbps or more” and “fixed”. WMA • It is recommended to set the bit rate to “64 kbps or more” and “fixed”. • Do not set the copy protect attribute on the WMA file to enable this unit to play back. NOTE: Never assign the “.mp3”, or “.wma” file name extension to a file that is not in the MP3/WMA format. This may not only produce noise from the speaker damage, but also damage your hearing. Recording MP3/WMA files on a CDmedia • You are recommended to minimize the chances of making a disc that contains both CD-DA files and MP3/WMA files. • If CD-DA files are on the same disc as MP3 or WMA files, the songs may not play in the intended order, or some songs may not play at all. • When storing MP3 data and WMA data on the same disc, use different folders for each data. • Do not record files other than MP3/WMA files and unnecessary folder on a disc. • The name of an MP3/WMA file should be added by rules as shown in the following descriptions and also comply with the rules of each file system. • The file extension “.mp3” or “.wma” should be assigned to each file depending on the file format. • You may encounter trouble in playing MP3/WMA files or displaying the information of MP3/WMA files recorded with certain writing software or CD recorders. • This unit does not have a play list function. • Although Multi-session recording is supported, the use of Disc-at-Once is recommended. 5-22 79K21-03E Roof Rails or Roof Rack Anchors: 5, 13 HomeLink: OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Compression formats MP3 • Bit rate MPEG1 Audio Layer III : 32 k - 320 kbps MPEG2 Audio Layer III : 8 k - 160 kbps • Sampling frequency MPEG1 Audio Layer III : 44.1 k/48 k/32 kHz MPEG2 Audio Layer III : 22.05 k/24 k/16 kHz Maximum number of files/folders • Maximum number of files: CD Player: 999(files + folders) 6-CD Player: 512(files + folders) • Maximum number of files in one folder: 255 • Maximum depth of trees: 8 • Maximum number of folders: 255 (Root folder is included.) MP3/WMA MODE Selecting a folder Turn the sound control knob (1) to select a folder. Repeat play Press the repeat button (2). Each time the button is pressed, repeat play mode changes as follows: Type 1 WMA (Ver.7, Ver.8, Ver.9*) • Bit rate 32 k - 192 kbps • Sampling frequency 44.1 k/48 k/32 kHz * WMA 9 Professional/LossLess/Voice are not supported. TRACK REPEAT OFF FOLDER REPEAT 66J128 Supported file systems ISO 9660 Level 1/Level 2, Apple Extension to ISO 9660, Joliet, Romeo Type 2 TRACK REPEAT OFF FOLDER REPEAT DISC REPEAT 66J145 5-23 79K21-03E HomeLink: OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT NOTE: This operation should be performed within 2 seconds. To cancel repeat play, press the repeat button (2) several times to change the repeat play mode to OFF. • TRACK REPEAT The indication “TRACK RPT” appears in the display for 2 seconds and then the repeat indicator (D) lights. The track currently being played is played repeatedly. • FOLDER REPEAT The indication “FOLDER RPT” appears in the display for 2 seconds and then the repeat indicator (D) lights. All the tracks in the folder currently being played are played repeatedly. • DISC REPEAT The indication “DISC RPT” appears in the display for 2 seconds and then the repeat indicator (D) lights. When all the tracks on the disc currently being played finish playing, play starts again at the beginning of the disc. Selecting a track • Press the track up button (3) to listen to the next track. • Press the track down button (4) twice to listen to the previous track. When the track down button (4) is pressed once, the track currently being played will start again at the beginning. Fast forwarding/Rewinding a track • Hold in the fast forward button (3) to advance a track rapidly. • Hold in the rewind button (4) to rewind a track. Displaying CD titles Press the display button (5). Each time the button is pressed, the title changes as follows: OFF FOLDER TITLE ALBUM TITLE FILE TITLE ARTIST TITLE TRACK TITLE 66J146 Forwarding a title If there is a title with 12 letters or more, each press will show next letters in the display. (No scrolling is made.) Press and hold the display button (5) for 2 seconds or longer. A title is changed. 5-24 79K21-03E HomeLink: OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Listening to a XM Satellite Radio (Option) Display (C) Type 1 AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (A) (3) (4) (1) (8) (6) 66J107 (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (5) (2) (7) XM button Category button (CAT) Seek up button Seek down button Manual tuning knob Display button (DISP) Preset button (1 to 6) Scan button (SCAN) (A) Band (B) Channel number (C) Category indicator Type 2 AM/FM/XM 6-CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL If you want to purchase XM Satellite Radio Service, contact your SUZUKI dealer. It is necessary to buy a special tuner to receive XM broadcasting. (3) (4) (1) (8) (6) (B) Your vehicle is capable of receiving XM Satellite Radio anywhere in the United States except Hawaii, Alaska, and Canada. (5) (2) (7) 79K110 5-25 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT XM MODE Selecting a band Press the XM button (1). Each time the button is pressed, the band changes in the following order. XM1 XM2 Selecting a category Press the seek up button (3) or seek down button (4) to select a category. Displaying the category Press the category button (2) to have the currently selected category appear on the display. XM3 Selecting a channel Turn the manual tuning knob (5) to select a channel. 66J129 Selecting a category Press the seek up button (3) or the seek down button (4). The category is changed. Turning the category function on/off Press and hold the category button (2) for 2 seconds or longer, and “CATEGORY ON” appears on the display, the CAT indicator (C) lights up and the CATEGORY function is activated. Press and hold the category button (2) for 2 seconds or longer again, and “CATEGORY OFF” appears on the display and the CAT indicator (C) turns off, indicating that the CATEGORY function has been turned off. NOTE: The first time you use the radio, turn the category function on. NOTE: When the category function is on, only those channels included in the selected category can be selected. Selecting the item to be displayed Press the display button (6). Each time the button is pressed, the item on display changes in the following order. CH NUMBER TITLE CH NAME and hold the button for 2 seconds or longer. Scan tuning 1) Press the scan button (8). Stations are automatically searched for in a sequential order, starting from the station being currently received, and scan tuning stops for 5 seconds at the frequency where there is a station available. 2) Press the scan button (8) again to stop scanning at the frequency currently being received. Satellite Radio Reception Satellite radio receives signals from two satellites in orbit over the equator. Therefore, satellite radio reception can be interrupted when there are objects south of your vehicle. To help compensate for this, ground-based repeaters are placed in major metropolitan areas, but depending on the geographic situation (for example, if mountains or buildings are on the south side of your vehicle), you may experience reception problems. NAME 66J130 Preset memory 1) Select the desired station. 2) Select the preset button (7) to which you want to store the station and press 5-26 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Listening to Audio for AUX (Option) Display Type 1 AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (A) 66J221 (1) Aux button (CD/AUX) (A) Mode indicator Aux function This system has an external input terminal so you can listen to audio from an external device connected to this unit. (1) Press the aux button (1). Each time the button is pressed, the selected mode is switched as follows: Type 2 AM/FM/XM 6-CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL CD AUX 66J123 (1) 79K111 5-27 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Listening to a CD from an External CD Changer (Option) Display (G) (E) (F) Type 1 AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (A) (B) (C) (D) (5) 66J113 (3) (4) (1) (6) (2) Type 2 AM/FM/XM 6-CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) Disc button (CD/AUX) Disc select buttons (1 to 6) Track up button/Fast forward button Track down button/Rewind button Repeat button (RPT) Category button (CAT) (A) (B) (C) (D) (E) (F) (G) Mode indicator Disc number Track number Play time Repeat indicator Random indicator CD changer number (3) (4) (5) (1) (6) (2) 79K112 5-28 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Selecting a CD changer mode Press the disc button (1). Each time the button is pressed, the selected CD plays as follows: Built-in CD player Selecting a track • Press the track up button (3) to listen to the next track. • Press the track down button (4) twice to listen to the previous track. When the track down button (4) is pressed once, the track currently being played will start again at the beginning. Fast forwarding/Rewinding a track • Hold in the fast forward button (3) to advance a track rapidly. • Hold in the rewind button (4) to rewind a track. CD changer 1 To cancel random play, press the category button (6) several times to change the random play mode to OFF. • TRACK RANDOM The tracks in the disc that is loaded are played at random. • DISC RANDOM The tracks in all discs are played at random. NOTE: The random play can be operated with the External CD Changer (Option) only. CD changer 2 52D300 • When only one CD changer is connected to this unit, CD changer 2 is skipped. • When no CD is loaded in the built-in CD player, the built-in CD player is skipped. Selecting a disc Press the disc select button (2) corresponding to the disc number you want to listen to. Play starts from the first track on the disc. If a disc number having no disc is pressed, the selection will be invalid. Random play Press the category button (6). Each time the button is pressed, the mode changes in the following order. Repeat play Press the repeat button (5). Each time the button is pressed, repeat play mode changes as follows: TRACK RANDOM OFF TRACK REPEAT OFF DISC RANDOM DISC REPEAT 66J131 66J144 NOTE: This operation should be performed within 2 seconds. NOTE: This operation should be performed within 2 seconds. To cancel repeat play, press the repeat button (5) several times to change the repeat play mode to OFF. 5-29 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT • TRACK REPEAT The indication “TRACK RPT” appears in the display for 2 seconds and then the repeat indicator (E) lights. The track being currently played is played repeatedly. Remote Audio Controls (if equipped) To control the volume: • To increase the volume, push the upper part of the switch (1). The volume continues to increase until you release the switch. • To decrease the volume, push the lower part of the switch (1). The volume continues to decrease until you release the switch. • To mute, push the switch (2). • DISC REPEAT The indication “DISC RPT” appears in the display for 2 seconds and then the repeat indicator (E) lights. When all the tracks on a disc being currently played finish playing, play starts again at the beginning of the disc. To select the mode (AM1, AM2, FM1, FM2, XM (option), CD, External CD-changer (option), AUX (option)), push the switch (3). You can also turn on the audio system by pushing the switch (3). (2) (3) (1) (4) 79K052 You can control basic functions of the audio system with the switches on the steering wheel. To change the radio station: • To advance to the next preset station, push the upper part of the switch (4) briefly. • To select the previous preset station, push the lower part of the switch (4) briefly. • To scan to a higher frequency radio station, push and hold the upper part of the switch (4). • To scan to a lower frequency radio station, push and hold the lower part of the switch (4). 5-30 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT To change the selection on a CD: • To advance to the next track on a CD, push the upper part of the switch (4) briefly. • To select the previous track on a CD, push the lower part of the switch (4). Anti-Theft Feature Type 1 AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (2) (1) (3) Type 2 AM/FM/XM 6-CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (2) (1) (3) 79K113 5-31 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT (1) Power on/off knob (2) Track up button/Fast forward button (3) Preset buttons (1 to 6) The anti-theft feature is intended to discourage theft or the audio system by preventing the system from operating when it is moved to a different vehicle. This feature works by allowing you to enter a Personal Identification Number (PIN). When the audio system is disconnected from its power source, such as when the audio system is removed or the battery is disconnected, the system will not operate again unless the PIN is reentered. Setting the Anti-Theft Function NOTE: Establish your PIN by combining numbers from 1 to 6 into any 4-digit number. If you forget your PIN, when you remove the battery for repair etc., you will no longer be able to operate the audio system. EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 66J117 5) Input the same 4-digit number you previously entered. 66J117 3) Input the four digit PIN using preset buttons 1 to 6. 1) Turn off the power by pressing the power on/off knob (1). 66J120 6) The power of the audio system will turn off. 66J118 66J118 2) Press the power on/off knob (1) while pressing and holding the track up button (2). The “ENTRY 0000” will blink and the audio system enter PIN-input mode. 4) After you enter your four digit PIN, the display will return to “0000”. NOTE: Write down your PIN for the future use. Canceling Your Established PIN Setting This operation is to be done when you want to cancel the anti-theft function or change your PIN. 1) Turn off the power by pressing the power on/off knob (1). 5-32 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Confirming Your Personal Identification Number (PIN) When the main power source is disconnected such as when you exchange your battery, etc, you will have to confirm your PIN to be able to use the audio system. 66J121 To confirm your PIN: 2) Press the power on/off knob (1) while pressing and holding the track up button (2). The “DELETE 0000” will blink and the audio system will enter the cancel mode. EXAMPLE 66J122 registered PIN, the power of the audio system will turn off, and you will be able to operate the audio system. NOTE: • If you input your PIN incorrectly, “----” will be displayed and the anti-theft function lock mode is entered. If you enter an incorrect PIN fewer than 6 times, the locking time will be for 15 seconds; if you enter an incorrect PIN more than 6 times, the locking time will be for 15 minutes. • If you forget your PIN and enter a wrong PIN, you cannot perform any further operation. 1) Turn the ignition switch to the “ACC” position. EXAMPLE 66J124 3) Input your PIN. The power of the audio system will turn off and your PIN will be deleted. To change your PIN, first delete your current PIN, then set a new one. 66J125 2) Input your PIN. If the PIN that you input matches the 5-33 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Troubleshooting Applicable to every device Phenomenon Power is not turned on. (No sound is produced) Cause Remedy Fuse is blown. Contact your authorized SUZUKI dealer. Connections are not properly made. Contact your authorized SUZUKI dealer. Radio Phenomenon Cause Remedy Too much noise. Not tuned correctly to the frequency of a station. Tune correctly to the station frequency. Stations cannot be selected by seek tuning. There is no station with strong radio waves. Select stations by manual tuning. CD Phenomenon Cause Remedy Compact disc cannot be loaded. Another compact disc is already loaded. Eject the compact disc before loading a new one. Sound skips or is noisy. Compact disc is dirty. Clean the compact disc with a soft cloth. Compact disc is heavily scratched or warped. Replace with a compact disc with no scratches. Water droplets may form on the internal lens when the car is parked in a humid place. Let dry for about 1 hour with the power on. Sound is bad directly after power is turned on. 5-34 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Error display This unit has a number of self-diagnostic functions to protect the system. If a problem should occur, the display shows the type of error. Refer to the table below and take proper measures to correct the problem. If the problem is corrected, the unit will operate normally. Error display Measures to be taken CD/CD changer “Mechanical error”. This error display indicates a mechanical failure in the CD changer (failure to change or eject a disc). The mechanism is probably damaged. Contact your authorized SUZUKI dealer. CD/CD changer “Focus error”. The pick-up-focus is not properly functioning during playback due to damage on the disc or for other reasons. Check disc for damage. CD/CD changer “Disc error”. The CD is inserted upside down or only an eight-centimeter CD adapter is equipped. Check disc for correct loading. If an error display not listed above appears, turn off the unit and contact your SUZUKI dealer. 5-35 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Audio Systems (type B) Precautions AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (Built-in CD Player) 79KA001 • When the inside of the car is very cold and the player is used soon after switching on the heater, moisture may form on the disc or the optical parts of the player and proper playback may not be possible. If moisture forms on the disc, wipe it off with a soft cloth. If moisture forms on the optical parts of the player, do not use the player for about one hour. This will allow the condensation to disappear normally. • Driving on extremely bumpy roads which cause severe vibrations may cause sound to skip. • This unit uses a precision mechanism. Even in the event that trouble arises, never open the case, disassemble the unit, or lubricate the rotating parts. Please bring the unit to an authorized SUZUKI dealer or a Clarion service Department. Cautions on Handling (A) 52D274 This unit has been designed specifically for playback of compact discs bearing the mark (A). No other discs can be played. Removing the disc Proper way to hold the compact disc 52D275 To remove the compact disc from its storage case, press down on the center of the case and lift the disc out, holding it carefully by the edges. Always handle the compact disc by the edges. 5-36 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT prevent the system from operating properly. Never touch the surface. 52D348 52D347 To remove fingermarks and dust, use a soft cloth, and wipe in a straight line from the center of the compact disc to the circumference. Never stick labels on the surface of the compact disc or mark the surface with a pencil or pen. (B) (C) (B) 52D349 Do not use any solvents such as commercially available cleaners, anti-static spray, or thinner to clean compact discs. 52D351 Do not expose compact discs to direct sunlight or any heat source. NOTE: • Do not use commercially available CD protection sheets or discs equipped with stabilizers, etc. These may get caught in the internal mechanism and damage the disc. • CD-R discs may not be able to playback in this unit due to the recording conditions. • CD-RW discs cannot playback in this unit. 52D277 New discs may have some roughness around the edges. The unit may not work or the sound may skip if such discs are used. Use a ball-point pen (B), etc. to remove the roughness (C) from edges of the disc before insertion inside the unit. 52D350 Do not use compact discs that have large scratches, are misshaped, or cracked, etc. Use of such discs will cause damage or 5-37 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Basic Operations Display (A) AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (Built-in CD Player) 79K086 (1) Power on/off knob Volume control knob (2) Tone/balance/fader control knob (3) Preset button 5 (4) Preset button 6 (5) Clock button H (6) Clock button M (5) (6) (1) (2) (A) Clock display (3) (4) 79KA002 5-38 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Turning power on/off Press the power on/off knob (1). The unit starts in the function mode it was in when the power was turned off last. Adjusting the volume Turn the volume control knob (1). Turning it clockwise increases the volume; turning it counterclockwise decreases the volume. • When minutes are between 30 and 59, the clock will reset to the next hour. (example: 12:38 ➔ 1:00) Adjusting bass/treble/balance/fader 1) Press the tone/balance/fader control knob (2). Each time it is pressed, sound adjustment is changed as follows: NOTE: While driving, adjust the volume to an extent that sound and/or noise coming from outside the car can be heard. Bass adjustment (BASS 0) Adjusting the clock 1) Press the clock button H (5) to adjust the hours. Press the clock button M (6) to adjust the minutes. 2) Hold the button depressed to automatically increment the number. 3) To reset the clock to an hour signal, press the clock button H (5) while holding the clock button M (6) depressed. Balance adjustment (BALANCE 0) NOTE: When the clock has not been set, the time “12:00” will flash in the display. Clock reset is effected as follows: • When minutes are between 00 and 29, the clock will reset to the current hour. (example: 12:23 ➔ 12:00) Treble adjustment (TREBLE 0) Adjusting the AVC (Auto volume control) The Auto Volume Control (AVC) function automatically adjusts (increases/ decreases) the sound volume in accordance with vehicle speed. The AVC control is provided with three selectable levels (LEVEL OFF, 1, 2, 3). The range of volume adjustment increases together with the LEVEL number, 1) Press the tone/balance/fader control knob (2) until the AVC adjustment mode is selected. 2) Turn the tone/balance/fader control knob (2) to select the desired AVC adjustment level. (Initial setting: LEVEL 2) Adjusting the contrast of the display 1) Press the tone/balance/fader control knob (2) and preset button 5 (3), preset button 6 (4) simultaneously. 2) To adjust the contrast of the display, turn the power on/off knob (1). Fader adjustment (FADER 0) AVC adjustment (AVC LEVEL 2) Original mode 66J224 2) Turn the tone/balance/fader control knob (2) to adjust the sound. 5-39 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Listening to the Radio Display (C) AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (Built-in CD Player) (A) (B) (D) 66J097 (2) (3) (6) (1) (4) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) Band switch button (FM/AM) Seek up button Seek down button Manual tuning knob Preset buttons (1 to 6) Auto store button (AS)/ Scan button (SCAN) (A) (B) (C) (D) Band Preset channel number Stereo indicator Frequency (5) 79KA003 5-40 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Selecting the reception band Press the band switch button (1). Each time the button is pressed, the reception band is switched as follows: 66J098 Seek tuning Press the seek up button (2) or the seek down button (3). The unit stops searching for a station at a frequency where a broadcast station is available. Manual tuning Turn the manual tuning knob (4). The frequency being received is displayed. Preset memory 1) Select the desired station. 2) Select the preset button (5) to which you want to store the station and press and hold the button for 2 seconds or longer. Auto store Press and hold the auto store button (6) for 2 seconds or longer. Six stations in total are automatically stored to the preset buttons (5) in sequential order, starting from the lower frequencies. Scan tuning 1) Press the scan button (6). Stations are automatically sought for in a sequential order, starting from a station being currently received, and scan stops for 5 seconds at a frequency where there is a station available. 2) Press the scan button (6) again to stop scanning at the frequency being currently received. Receiving a stereo broadcast station If a stereo broadcast station is received, the stereo indicator will light. NOTE: • When the auto store is performed, the station previously stored in the memory at the position is overwritten. • When there are fewer than 6 stations that can be stored even if 2 rounds of auto store operation are performed, the stations previously stored at the remaining preset buttons (5) are not overwritten. 5-41 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Radio Reception Radio reception can be affected by environment, atmospheric conditions, or radio signal’s power and distance from the station. Nearby mountains and buildings may interfere or deflect radio reception, causing poor reception. Poor reception or radio static can also be caused by electric current from overhead wires or high voltage power lines. Listening to a CD CAUTION (A) 52D274 • CDs or CD-ROMs carrying no mark (A) cannot be used. • Some discs previously recorded in CDR\CD-RW format may not be used. • Never insert your finger or hand into the CD insertion slot. Never insert foreign objects. • Never insert a CD with glue coming out from adhesive tape or a rental CD label or with a trace indicating that adhesive tape or a rental CD label has been removed. This may cause the CD not to eject or result in a malfunction. 52D291 • A CD is inserted with its label facing upward. • When there is a CD already loaded in the unit, another CD cannot be loaded at the same time. Do not use force when inserting the CD into the CD insertion slot. • If a blank disc (non-recorded CD-R) is loaded in the unit, the disc will be ejected. 5-42 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (Built-in CD Player) Display (D) (A) (B) (C) 66J100 (1) (6) (3) (2) (4) (5) 79KA004 (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) CD insertion slot CD eject button Disc button (CD/AUX) Track up button/Fast forward button Track down button/Rewind button Repeat button (RPT) (A) (B) (C) (D) Mode indicator Track number Play time Repeat indicator NOTE: About Single CDs (8 cm CDs) • No adapter is required to play a single CD. • A single CD is inserted from the center of the CD insertion slot. • Since an ejected single CD is not automatically reloaded, be sure to remove the ejected single CD. 5-43 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Loading a CD Insert a CD in the CD insertion slot (1). When a CD is loaded, play starts and the CD indicator (A) lights. Ejecting a CD Press the CD eject button (2). If you left a CD ejected for a period of about 15 seconds, it will be automatically drawn inside the unit. (Auto reload function) The backup eject function: This function allows you to eject a CD with the power turned off by pressing the CD eject button (2). CAUTION If you forcefully try to push an ejected CD inside the unit before auto reloading, the disc surface might be scratched. Listening to a CD When a CD is inserted, it is automatically played back. When a CD is already inside the unit, press the disc button (3) to play back the CD. When a CD is inside the unit, the CD indicator (A) is lit on the display unit. Selecting a track • Press the track up button (4) to listen to the next track. • Press the track down button (5) twice to listen to the previous track. When the track down button (5) is pressed once, the track being currently played will return to the beginning. Fast forwarding/Rewinding a track • Hold in the fast forward button (4) to advance a track rapidly. • Hold in the rewind button (5) to rewind a track. Repeat play Press the repeat button (6). Each time the button is pressed, repeat play mode changes as follows: TRACK REPEAT OFF 64J287 NOTE: This operation should be performed within 2 seconds. To cancel repeat play, press the repeat button (6) to change the repeat play mode to OFF. • TRACK REPEAT The indication “TRACK RPT” appears in the display for 2 seconds and then the repeat indicator (D) lights. The track currently being played is played repeatedly. 5-44 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Listening to an MP3/WMA Disc Display (D) AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (Built-in CD Player) (A) (B) (E) (F) (C) 66J104 (2) (5) (3) (4) (1) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) Sound control knob Repeat button (RPT) Track up button/Fast forward button Track down button/Rewind button Display button (DISP) (A) (B) (C) (D) (E) (F) Folder number Track number Play time Repeat indicator WMA indicator MP3 indicator 79KA005 5-45 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT What is MP3/WMA? MP3 (MPEG1/2 Audio Layer-III) and WMA (Windows MediaTM Audio) are the compression formats of digital audio. The former is developed by MPEG (Motion Picture Experts Group), and the latter is developed by Microsoft Corporation. Using these compression formats, you can record the contents of about 10 music CDs on a single CD media (This figures refer to data recorded on a 650 MB CD-R or CDRW at a fixed bit rate of 128 kbps and a sampling frequency of 44.1 kHz). Points to remember when making MP3/ WMA files Common • High bit rate and high sampling frequency are recommended for high quality sounds. • Selecting VBR (Variable Bit Rate) is not recommended because playing time is not displayed properly and sound may be skipped. • The playback sound quality differs depending on the encoding circumstances. For details, refer to the user manual of your own encoding software and writing software. MP3 • It is recommended to set the bit rate to “128 kbps or more” and “fixed”. WMA • It is recommended to set the bit rate to “64 kbps or more” and “fixed”. • Do not set the copy protect attribute on the WMA file to enable this unit to play back. NOTE: Never assign the “.mp3”, or “.wma” file name extension to a file that is not in the MP3/WMA format. This may not only produce noise from the speaker damage, but also damage your hearing. Recording MP3/WMA files on a CDmedia • You are recommended to minimize the chances of making a disc that contains both CD-DA files and MP3/WMA files. • If CD-DA files are on the same disc as MP3 or WMA files, the songs may not play in the intended order, or some songs may not play at all. • When storing MP3 data and WMA data on the same disc, use different folders for each data. • Do not record files other than MP3/WMA files and unnecessary folder on a disc. • The name of an MP3/WMA file should be added by rules as shown in the following descriptions and also comply with the rules of each file system. • The file extension “.mp3” or “.wma” should be assigned to each file depending on the file format. • You may encounter trouble in playing MP3/WMA files or displaying the information of MP3/WMA files recorded with certain writing software or CD recorders. • This unit does not have a play list function. • Although Multi-session recording is supported, the use of Disc-at-Once is recommended. 5-46 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Compression formats MP3 • Bit rate MPEG1 Audio Layer III : 32 k - 320 kbps MPEG2 Audio Layer III : 8 k - 160 kbps • Sampling frequency MPEG1 Audio Layer III : 44.1 k/48 k/32 kHz MPEG2 Audio Layer III : 22.05 k/24 k/16 kHz WMA (Ver.7, Ver.8, Ver.9*) • Bit rate 32 k - 192 kbps • Sampling frequency 44.1 k/48 k/32 kHz * WMA 9 Professional/LossLess/Voice are not supported. Maximum number of files/folders • Maximum number of files: 999(files + folders) • Maximum number of files in one folder: 255 • Maximum depth of trees: 8 • Maximum number of folders: 255 (Root folder is included.) MP3/WMA MODE Selecting a folder Turn the sound control knob (1) to select a folder. Repeat play Press the repeat button (2). Each time the button is pressed, repeat play mode changes as follows: TRACK REPEAT OFF FOLDER REPEAT 66J128 Supported file systems ISO 9660 Level 1/Level 2, Apple Extension to ISO 9660, Joliet, Romeo 5-47 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT NOTE: This operation should be performed within 2 seconds. To cancel repeat play, press the repeat button (2) several times to change the repeat play mode to OFF. • TRACK REPEAT The indication “TRACK RPT” appears in the display for 2 seconds and then the repeat indicator (D) lights. The track currently being played is played repeatedly. • FOLDER REPEAT The indication “FOLDER RPT” appears in the display for 2 seconds and then the repeat indicator (D) lights. All the tracks in the folder currently being played are played repeatedly. Selecting a track • Press the track up button (3) to listen to the next track. • Press the track down button (4) twice to listen to the previous track. When the track down button (4) is pressed once, the track currently being played will start again at the beginning. Fast forwarding/Rewinding a track • Hold in the fast forward button (3) to advance a track rapidly. • Hold in the rewind button (4) to rewind a track. Displaying CD titles Press the display button (5). Each time the button is pressed, the title changes as follows: OFF FOLDER TITLE ALBUM TITLE FILE TITLE ARTIST TITLE TRACK TITLE 66J146 Forwarding a title If there is a title with 12 letters or more, each press will show next letters in the display. (No scrolling is made.) Press and hold the display button (5) for 2 seconds or longer. A title is changed. 5-48 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Listening to Audio for AUX Display AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (Built-in CD Player) (A) 80JA007 (1) Aux button (CD/AUX) (2) Aux input connector (A) Mode indicator (1) (2) 79KA006 5-49 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Aux function This system has an external input terminal so you can listen to audio from an external device connected to this unit. Press the aux button (1). Each time the button is pressed, the selected mode is switched as follows: CD AUX1 NOTE: • AUX1 is displayed when an external component is connected to the frontpanel AUX input connector. • Use a stereo 3.5 mm miniplug cord to connect external components to the AUX input connector. CAUTION • Do not attempt to connect or operate an external component while engaged in driving. • Do not allow the cord to interfere with the driver’s actions. • If an external component is connected when its audio volume has been set to a high level, a loud sound volume may suddenly be produced. 80JA008 5-50 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Listening to a XM Satellite Radio (Option) Display (C) AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (Built-in CD Player) (A) (B) 66J107 (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (3) (4) (1) (8) (6) XM button Category button (CAT) Seek up button Seek down button Manual tuning knob Display button (DISP) Preset button (1 to 6) Scan button (SCAN) (5) (A) Band (B) Channel number (C) Category indicator (2) If you want to purchase XM Satellite Radio Service, contact your SUZUKI dealer. It is necessary to buy a special tuner to receive XM broadcasting. (7) 79KA007 Your vehicle is capable of receiving XM Satellite Radio anywhere in the United States except Hawaii, Alaska, and Canada. 5-51 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT XM MODE Selecting a band Press the XM button (1). Each time the button is pressed, the band changes in the following order. XM1 XM2 Selecting a category Press the seek up button (3) or seek down button (4) to select a category. Displaying the category Press the category button (2) to have the currently selected category appear on the display. XM3 Selecting a channel Turn the manual tuning knob (5) to select a channel. 66J129 Selecting a category Press the seek up button (3) or the seek down button (4). The category is changed. Turning the category function on/off Press and hold the category button (2) for 2 seconds or longer, and “CATEGORY ON” appears on the display, the CAT indicator (C) lights up and the CATEGORY function is activated. Press and hold the category button (2) for 2 seconds or longer again, and “CATEGORY OFF” appears on the display and the CAT indicator (C) turns off, indicating that the CATEGORY function has been turned off. NOTE: The first time you use the radio, turn the category function on. NOTE: When the category function is on, only those channels included in the selected category can be selected. Selecting the item to be displayed Press the display button (6). Each time the button is pressed, the item on display changes in the following order. CH NUMBER TITLE CH NAME and hold the button for 2 seconds or longer. Scan tuning 1) Press the scan button (8). Stations are automatically searched for in a sequential order, starting from the station being currently received, and scan tuning stops for 5 seconds at the frequency where there is a station available. 2) Press the scan button (8) again to stop scanning at the frequency currently being received. Satellite Radio Reception Satellite radio receives signals from two satellites in orbit over the equator. Therefore, satellite radio reception can be interrupted when there are objects south of your vehicle. To help compensate for this, ground-based repeaters are placed in major metropolitan areas, but depending on the geographic situation (for example, if mountains or buildings are on the south side of your vehicle), you may experience reception problems. NAME 66J130 Preset memory 1) Select the desired station. 2) Select the preset button (7) to which you want to store the station and press 5-52 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Listening to Audio for AUX (Option) Display AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (Built-in CD Player) (A) 80JA011 (1) Aux button (CD/AUX) (A) Mode indicator Aux function This system has an external input terminal so you can listen to audio from an external device connected to this unit. (1) Press the aux button (1). Each time the button is pressed, the selected mode is switched as follows: CD AUX2 80JA012 79KA008 NOTE: • AUX2 is displayed when an external component is connected to the AUX (Option) input connector. • Use a stereo 3.5 mm miniplug cord to connect external components to the AUX input connector. 5-53 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Listening to a CD from an External CD Changer (Option) Display (G) (E) (F) AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (Built-in CD Player) (A) (B) (C) (D) 66J113 (5) (3) (4) (1) (6) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) Disc button (CD/AUX) Disc select buttons (1 to 6) Track up button/Fast forward button Track down button/Rewind button Repeat button (RPT) Category button (CAT) (A) (B) (C) (D) (E) (F) (G) Mode indicator Disc number Track number Play time Repeat indicator Random indicator CD changer number (2) 79KA009 5-54 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Selecting a CD changer mode Press the disc button (1). Each time the button is pressed, the selected CD plays as follows: Built-in CD player Selecting a track • Press the track up button (3) to listen to the next track. • Press the track down button (4) twice to listen to the previous track. When the track down button (4) is pressed once, the track currently being played will start again at the beginning. Fast forwarding/Rewinding a track • Hold in the fast forward button (3) to advance a track rapidly. • Hold in the rewind button (4) to rewind a track. CD changer 1 To cancel random play, press the category button (6) several times to change the random play mode to OFF. • TRACK RANDOM The tracks in the disc that is loaded are played at random. • DISC RANDOM The tracks in all discs are played at random. NOTE: The random play can be operated with the External CD Changer (Option) only. CD changer 2 52D300 • When only one CD changer is connected to this unit, CD changer 2 is skipped. • When no CD is loaded in the built-in CD player, the built-in CD player is skipped. Selecting a disc Press the disc select button (2) corresponding to the disc number you want to listen to. Play starts from the first track on the disc. If a disc number having no disc is pressed, the selection will be invalid. Random play Press the category button (6). Each time the button is pressed, the mode changes in the following order. Repeat play Press the repeat button (5). Each time the button is pressed, repeat play mode changes as follows: TRACK RANDOM OFF TRACK REPEAT OFF DISC RANDOM DISC REPEAT 66J131 66J144 NOTE: This operation should be performed within 2 seconds. NOTE: This operation should be performed within 2 seconds. To cancel repeat play, press the repeat button (5) several times to change the repeat play mode to OFF. 5-55 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT • TRACK REPEAT The indication “TRACK RPT” appears in the display for 2 seconds and then the repeat indicator (E) lights. The track being currently played is played repeatedly. Remote Audio Controls (if equipped) To control the volume: • To increase the volume, push the upper part of the switch (1). The volume continues to increase until you release the switch. • To decrease the volume, push the lower part of the switch (1). The volume continues to decrease until you release the switch. • To mute, push the switch (2). • DISC REPEAT The indication “DISC RPT” appears in the display for 2 seconds and then the repeat indicator (E) lights. When all the tracks on a disc being currently played finish playing, play starts again at the beginning of the disc. To select the mode (AM1, AM2, FM1, FM2, XM (option), CD, AUX1, External CDchanger (option), AUX2 (option)), push the switch (3). You can also turn on the audio system by pushing the switch (3). (2) (3) (1) (4) 79K052 You can control basic functions of the audio system with the switches on the steering wheel. To change the radio station: • To advance to the next preset station, push the upper part of the switch (4) briefly. • To select the previous preset station, push the lower part of the switch (4) briefly. • To scan to a higher frequency radio station, push and hold the upper part of the switch (4). • To scan to a lower frequency radio station, push and hold the lower part of the switch (4). 5-56 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT To change the selection on a CD: • To advance to the next track on a CD, push the upper part of the switch (4) briefly. • To select the previous track on a CD, push the lower part of the switch (4). Anti-Theft Feature AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (Built-in CD Player) (2) (1) (3) 79KA010 5-57 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT (1) Power on/off knob (2) Track up button/Fast forward button (3) Preset buttons (1 to 6) The anti-theft feature is intended to discourage theft or the audio system by preventing the system from operating when it is moved to a different vehicle. This feature works by allowing you to enter a Personal Identification Number (PIN). When the audio system is disconnected from its power source, such as when the audio system is removed or the battery is disconnected, the system will not operate again unless the PIN is reentered. Setting the Anti-Theft Function NOTE: Establish your PIN by combining numbers from 1 to 6 into any 4-digit number. If you forget your PIN, when you remove the battery for repair etc., you will no longer be able to operate the audio system. EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 66J117 5) Input the same 4-digit number you previously entered. 66J117 3) Input the four digit PIN using preset buttons 1 to 6. 1) Turn off the power by pressing the power on/off knob (1). 66J120 6) The power of the audio system will turn off. 66J118 66J118 2) Press the power on/off knob (1) while pressing and holding the track up button (2). The “ENTRY 0000” will blink and the audio system enter PIN-input mode. 4) After you enter your four digit PIN, the display will return to “0000”. NOTE: Write down your PIN for the future use. Canceling Your Established PIN Setting This operation is to be done when you want to cancel the anti-theft function or change your PIN. 1) Turn off the power by pressing the power on/off knob (1). 5-58 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Confirming Your Personal Identification Number (PIN) When the main power source is disconnected such as when you exchange your battery, etc, you will have to confirm your PIN to be able to use the audio system. 66J121 To confirm your PIN: 2) Press the power on/off knob (1) while pressing and holding the track up button (2). The “DELETE 0000” will blink and the audio system will enter the cancel mode. EXAMPLE 66J122 registered PIN, the power of the audio system will turn off, and you will be able to operate the audio system. NOTE: • If you input your PIN incorrectly, “----” will be displayed and the anti-theft function lock mode is entered. If you enter an incorrect PIN fewer than 6 times, the locking time will be for 15 seconds; if you enter an incorrect PIN more than 6 times, the locking time will be for 15 minutes. • If you forget your PIN and enter a wrong PIN, you cannot perform any further operation. 1) Turn the ignition switch to the “ACC” position. EXAMPLE 66J124 3) Input your PIN. The power of the audio system will turn off and your PIN will be deleted. To change your PIN, first delete your current PIN, then set a new one. 66J125 2) Input your PIN. If the PIN that you input matches the 5-59 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Troubleshooting Applicable to every device Phenomenon Power is not turned on. (No sound is produced) Cause Remedy Fuse is blown. Contact your authorized SUZUKI dealer. Connections are not properly made. Contact your authorized SUZUKI dealer. Radio Phenomenon Cause Remedy Too much noise. Not tuned correctly to the frequency of a station. Tune correctly to the station frequency. Stations cannot be selected by seek tuning. There is no station with strong radio waves. Select stations by manual tuning. CD Phenomenon Cause Remedy Compact disc cannot be loaded. Another compact disc is already loaded. Eject the compact disc before loading a new one. Sound skips or is noisy. Compact disc is dirty. Clean the compact disc with a soft cloth. Compact disc is heavily scratched or warped. Replace with a compact disc with no scratches. Water droplets may form on the internal lens when the car is parked in a humid place. Let dry for about 1 hour with the power on. Sound is bad directly after power is turned on. 5-60 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Error display This unit has a number of self-diagnostic functions to protect the system. If a problem should occur, the display shows the type of error. Refer to the table below and take proper measures to correct the problem. If the problem is corrected, the unit will operate normally. Error display Measures to be taken CD/CD changer “Mechanical error”. This error display indicates a mechanical failure in the CD changer (failure to change or eject a disc). The mechanism is probably damaged. Contact your authorized SUZUKI dealer. CD/CD changer “Focus error”. The pick-up-focus is not properly functioning during playback due to damage on the disc or for other reasons. Check disc for damage. CD/CD changer “Disc error”. The CD is inserted upside down or only an eight-centimeter CD adapter is equipped. Check disc for correct loading. If an error display not listed above appears, turn off the unit and contact your SUZUKI dealer. 5-61 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Fuel Filler Cap of the driver’s seat and can be locked by simply closing the door. EXAMPLE (1) EXAMPLE Open Close (2) 78K156 78K145 79K053 To remove the fuel filler cap: 1) Open the fuel filler door. 2) Remove the cap by turning it counterclockwise. EXAMPLE WARNING Remove the fuel filler cap slowly. The fuel may be under pressure and may spray out, causing injury. NOTE: The cap holder (1) can hold the fuel filler cap (2) when refueling. To reinstall the fuel filler cap: 1) Turn the cap clockwise until you hear several clicks. 2) Close the fuel filler door. WARNING Fuel is extremely flammable. Do not smoke when refueling, and make sure there are no open flames or sparks in the area. 64J253 The fuel filler cap is located on the right rear side of the vehicle. The fuel filler door can be unlocked by pulling up on the opener lever located on the outboard side 5-62 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT WARNING Engine Hood If you need to replace the fuel cap, use a genuine SUZUKI cap. Use of an improper cap can result in a malfunction of the fuel system or emission control system. It may also result in fuel leakage in the event of an accident. 64J111 64J110 To open the engine hood: 1) Pull the hood release handle located on the outboard side of the driver’s side of the instrument panel. This will disengage the engine hood lock halfway. 2) Push the under-hood release lever sideways with your finger, as shown in the illustration. While pushing the lever, lift up the engine hood. 5-63 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Sun Visor Interior Light Switch Center EXAMPLE (3) (2) (1) (1) 64J112 3) Continue to lift up the hood until it is high enough to support with the prop rod. To close the engine hood: 1) Lift the hood up slightly and remove the prop rod from the hole. Put the prop rod back to the holding clip. 2) Lower the hood close to the bumper, then let it drop down. Make sure the hood is securely latched after closing. WARNING Make sure the hood is fully closed and latched before driving. If it is not, it can fly up unexpectedly during driving, obstructing your view and resulting in an accident. 79K055 The sun visors can be pulled down to block glare coming through the windshield, or they can be unhooked and turned to the side to block glare coming through the side window. The extension (1) can be drawn out to block glare widely. 64J104 Rear (3) (2) (1) CAUTION When unhooking and hooking a sun visor, be sure to handle it by the hard plastic parts or the sun visor can be damaged. 64J211 This light switch has three positions which function as described below: 5-64 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT ON (1) The light comes on and stays on regardless of whether the door is open or closed. DOOR (2) The light comes on when the door is opened. After closing all doors (including the tailgate), the light will remain on for about 15 seconds and then fade out. If you push in the ignition switch or insert the key during this time, the light will start to fade out immediately. After removing the key from the ignition switch, the light will turn on for about 15 seconds and then fade out. OFF (3) The light remains off even when the door is opened. Luggage Compartment Light EXAMPLE (1) (2) 78K146 NOTE: The number of doors involved in the lighting operation of the interior light depends on the vehicle specification. If there is a switch (rubber projection) at the door opening as shown, the door is involved in the lighting operation. 66J047 The luggage compartment light is located at the left side of the rear luggage compartment. When you open any of the doors including the tailgate with the luggage compartment light switch in the “DOOR” position (1), the light comes on and remains on as long as you keep the door open. After closing all doors, the light will remain on for about 15 seconds and then fade out. If you push in the ignition switch or insert the key during this time, the light will start to fade out immediately. After removing the key from the ignition switch, the light will turn on for about 15 seconds and then fade out. When the luggage compartment light switch is in the “OFF” position (2), the light 5-65 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT remains off regardless of whether the door(s) is(are) opened or closed. Spot Light Accessory Socket (if equipped) EXAMPLE EXAMPLE (1) 65J093 Push the switch (1) to turn on the light and push it again to turn off the light. 78K141 EXAMPLE 64J120 5-66 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT The accessory socket will work when the ignition switch is in the “ACC” or “ON” position. Cigarette Lighter and Ashtray (if equipped) 12-volt accessory sockets are located both on the center console and on the left side of the luggage compartment. Cigarette Lighter EXAMPLE Depending on the specification, there are two sockets on the center console. Each socket can be used to provide 12 volt/120 watt power for electrical accessories when used alone. Make sure that the cap remains on the socket when the socket is not in use. CAUTION • To avoid damage to the cigarette lighter socket, do not use it as other accessories’ power source. Some accessories’ power plug can damage the inner mechanism of the cigarette lighter socket. • Holding the cigarette lighter in can overheat and damage the lighter. Release the lighter after you push it in. CAUTION • To prevent the fuse from being blown, when using sockets at the same time, do not exceed the total combined power capacity of 120 watts. • Use of inappropriate electrical accessories can cause damage to your vehicle’s electrical system. Make sure that any electrical accessories you use are designed to plug into this type of socket. 78K139 The cigarette lighter will work when the ignition switch is in the “ACC” or “ON” position. To use the cigarette lighter, push it all the way into the receptacle and release it. It will automatically heat up and will pop out to its normal position when it is ready for use. 5-67 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Sunroof (if equipped) Ashtray EXAMPLE 64J201 You can fit the ashtray into any of the cup holders on the center console. WARNING Make sure tobacco is fully extinguished before closing the ashtrays. Never throw waste in the ashtrays: it could create a fire hazard. You can tilt or slide the sunroof by operating the “TILT” part of the sunroof switch or the “SLIDE” part of the sunroof switch when the ignition switch is in the “ON” position. There is a system to prevent being pinched by the sunroof. When the system senses that something is pinched when the sunroof is sliding forward, the sunroof will automatically reverse direction and slide rearward. This system will operate when the sunroof is closing automatically. This system does not operate when tilting the sunroof down. Make sure there are no hands or other obstructions in the path of the sunroof when you close the sunroof even though there is a system to prevent being pinched by the sunroof. WARNING • The system to prevent being pinched by the sunroof does not work in the area where the sunroof is almost completely closed. • The system to prevent being pinched by the sunroof may not work if the battery is not sufficiently charged. (1) (2) 79K097 To tilt the sunroof up, slide the sun shade rearward by hand and push the “TILT UP” part (1) of the sunroof switch. To tilt the sunroof down, push the “SLIDE OPEN” part (2) of the sunroof switch. If you push the switch for more than a second, the sunroof will automatically tilt up or down fully. To stop the sunroof halfway, push the switch briefly. 5-68 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT movement stops completely, release the switch. The features are reactivated. 3) Make sure you can open or close the sunroof automatically by pushing the sunroof switch for more than about a second. (1) (2) 79K098 64J109 To slide the sunroof rearward, push the “SLIDE OPEN” part (2) of the sunroof switch. To side the sunroof forward, push the “TILT UP” part (1) of the sunroof switch. If you push the switch for more than a second, the sunroof will automatically slide fully rearward or forward. To stop the sunroof halfway, push the switch briefly. The sun shade will open automatically and cannot be closed when the sunroof is slid rearward. How to reactivate the system to prevent being pinched by the sunroof When you disconnect the negative (–) terminal from the battery or change the fuses, the features below will not operate. • The system to prevent being pinched by the sliding sunroof. • The system to automatically open or close the sunroof fully. In this case, you must reactivate the features using the following procedures. 1) Turn the ignition switch to the “ON” position. 2) Push and hold the “TILT UP” part (1) of the sunroof switch, the sunroof will tilt up fully and then down slightly. After the 65D612 WARNING • Never allow any part of your body such as hands or head to get out of the sunroof opening while the vehicle is moving. • Be sure there are no hands or other obstructions in the path of the sunroof when you close the sunroof. (Continued) 5-69 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT WARNING Assist Grips (if equipped) Coat Hooks (if equipped) (Continued) • Always remove the ignition key when leaving the vehicle even if for a short time. Also do not leave children alone in a parked vehicle. Unattended children could use the sunroof switches and get trapped by the sunroof. CAUTION Do not put your body weight on the roof around the sunroof such as by sitting on it. 64J136 Assist grips are provided for convenience. • Be sure to close the sunroof when you leave the vehicle unattended. • Periodically inspect the guide rail for dirt and clean it if any dirt has accumulated. 64J137 You can hang clothing on the coat hooks. These hooks are not designed for large or heavy items. WARNING If your vehicle is equipped with side curtain air bags, do not hang sharp items like a hanger on the coat hook. When hanging the clothes, hang it on the hook without using a hanger. 5-70 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Glove Box Overhead Console Box (if equipped) CAUTION If you park your vehicle outdoors in direct sunlight or in hot weather, the eyeglasses compartment can get very hot since it is close to the roof. So, when parking in such conditions: • Do not leave eyeglasses in the compartment. The heat may distort plastic lenses or frames. • Do not place flammable items, such as a lighter, in the compartment. The heat may cause a fire. EXAMPLE (1) (2) (1) 78K136 (1) LOCK (2) UNLOCK 79K056 To open the glove box, pull the latch lever. To close it, push the lid until it latches securely. If a lock is equipped on the latch lever, lock the glove box by inserting the key and turning it clockwise and unlock the glove box by turning the key counterclockwise. WARNING To use the overhead console box, push on the front edge (1) and open the lid. To close the lid, push the front edge (1) until it latches. Do not put heavy or sharp items in the box. NOTE: An aftermarket garage door opener can be installed in the front side overhead console box. WARNING Never drive with the overhead console box lid open. It could cause injury if an accident occurs. Never drive with the glove box lid open. It could cause injury if an accident occurs. 5-71 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Cup Holder and Storage Bin (if equipped) WARNING Do not use the cup holder or the storage bin to hold cups containing hot liquids or sharp-edged, hard or breakable objects. Objects in these bins may be thrown about during a sudden stop or impact, and could cause personal injury. Cup holders and a storage bin are provided as shown. EXAMPLE Bottle holder 64J115 To use the console bin, pull the lever up and open the lid. 79K140 To access a bin, push the release button. EXAMPLE 64J200 You should hold a bottle with a cap in the bottle holder. 64J116 To use the rear cup holders, open the lid. 5-72 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Front Seat Back Pocket (if equipped) Shopping Hook (if equipped) EXAMPLE Armrest CAUTION To avoid damage to the armrest, do not lean on it or allow a child to sit on it. EXAMPLE Center Console Armrest 66J049 64J127 This pocket is provided for holding light and soft things such as gloves, newspapers or magazines. The shopping hooks are located on both sides of the luggage compartment. You can hang the shopping bag or other suitable objects on the hook. This hook is not designed for large or heavy items. WARNING Do not put hard or breakable objects in the pocket. If an accident occurs, objects such as bottles, cans, etc. can injure the occupants in the rear seat. 64J263 5-73 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Floor Mats (if equipped) WARNING Failure to take the following precautions may result in the driver’s side floor mat interfering with the pedals and causing a loss of vehicle control or an accident. • Make sure that the floor mat grommet(s) is(are) hooked to the fastener(s). • Never place additional floor mats on top of the existing floor mats. EXAMPLE 80J2014 Your vehicle has a fastener to keep the driver’s side floor mat from sliding forward and possibly interfering with the pedals. Whenever you put the driver’s side floor mat back in the vehicle after it has been removed, be sure to hook the floor mat grommet(s) to the fastener(s) and position the floor mat properly in the footwell. When you replace the floor mats in your vehicle with a different type such as allweather floor mats, we highly recommend using genuine SUZUKI floor mats for proper fitting. Luggage Compartment Cover Luggage or other cargo placed in the luggage compartment can be hidden from view by a luggage compartment cover. However, the luggage compartment covers are not designed to support items loaded on top of them, and may get damaged if used as a shelf. WARNING Do not carry items on top of the luggage compartment cover, even if they are small and light. Objects on top of the cover could be thrown about in an accident, causing injury, or could obstruct the driver’s rear view. CAUTION To avoid damaging the luggage compartment cover: • Do not place items on top of it. • Do not push down on it or lean on it. • Handle it carefully when installing or removing. NOTE: The seatback should always be securely latched in a fairly upright position when removing or installing the luggage compartment cover. 5-74 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT To remove the luggage compartment cover: rear front (b) (a) (a) 66J205 3) Lift up both ends of the cover to disengage the attachment points (b). 66J203 1) Release the three hooks (a) from the rear seat backs. (c) 66J204 2) Fold and roll the cover forward. 66J228 4) Place one end of the cover in the quarter window opening (c) so enough 5-75 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT clearance is established on the other end to swing the cover down and out. To stow a luggage compartment cover on the floor of the rear luggage room: To reinstall the luggage compartment cover: (c) 78K147 78K148 5) Tilt the luggage compartment cover, and then remove the compartment cover from the vehicle. 1) Fold/roll the luggage compartment cover, and place one end in the quarter window opening (c) to swing the other end into position. CAUTION When you place the end of the cover in the quarter window opening (c), be careful not to damage the window or other materials while positioning the compartment cover. 66J207 Tilt the cover, and fit it onto floor of the rear luggage room. 5-76 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Underfloor Bins (if equipped) EXAMPLE (d) (e) (A) (b) 66J209 66J210 2) Align the attachment points (d) on the cover with the attachment points (b) on the vehicle and push down both ends. Make sure that the cover securely fits in the attachment points. 3) Unroll/unfold the cover as you secure the other latches (e). 64J132 Pull up the strap (A) to open the bin. CAUTION Do not allow items in the bins to extend above the top of the bin. Otherwise, the bin or luggage floor may be damaged. (a) (a) 66J229 4) Reattach the three hooks (a) to the rear seat backs. 5-77 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Luggage Restraint Loops (if equipped) WARNING The luggage restraint loops and optional rubber net can be used to help keep lightweight cargo from moving around in the luggage compartment during normal driving. They are neither capable of nor intended for preventing cargo from being thrown around in a crash. Place heavier objects on the floor and as far forward in the cargo area as possible. Never pile cargo higher than the top of the seat backs. 64J129 Four luggage restraint loops are provided on the luggage compartment floor. An optional rubber net can be hooked to these loops to help keep cargo from moving around in the luggage compartment during normal driving. Roof Rails or Roof Rack Anchors (if equipped) Roof rails WARNING Do not attach the child restraint top strap to the luggage restraint loops. Incorrectly attached top strap will reduce the intended effectiveness of the child restraint system. 64J133 Roof rack anchors (1) 64J224 5-78 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT You can use the roof rails or the roof rack anchors to attach the optional roof rack which is available at your SUZUKI dealer. If you use a roof rack, observe the instructions and precautions in this section and provided with the roof rack. (For vehicles with roof rack anchors) To remove the cap, slide the cap in the direction of the arrow (1) and then lift the edge of the cap up as shown in the illustration. To install the cap, put in the front part of the cap, slide the cap in the opposite direction of the arrow (1) and then push down the rear part of the cap. • Make sure the roof rack is securely installed. • To mount various types of cargo (such as skis, bicycles, etc.) properly, use suitable attachments which are available from your SUZUKI dealer. Be sure to install the attachments properly and securely according to the instructions provided. Do not mount cargo directly on the roof panel. The cargo can damage the roof panel. • The gross weight of the roof rack plus cargo must not exceed the loading capacity (75 kg (165 lbs)). Also, do not let the gross vehicle weight (fully loaded vehicle including driver, passengers, cargo, roof load and trailer tongue weight) exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) listed on the driver’s door lock pillar. • Mount and secure the cargo onto the roof rack properly according to the instructions provided. Be sure to stow the heaviest items at the bottom and distribute the cargo as evenly as possible. • Do not carry items so large that they hang over the bumpers or the sides of the vehicle, or block your view. • Secure the front and rear ends of long items – such as wood panels, surfboards and so forth – to both the front and rear of the vehicle. You should protect the painted surfaces of the vehicle from scuffing caused by tie-down ropes. • Check periodically to make sure the roof rack is securely installed and free from damage. • For vehicles with roof rack anchors, make sure the anchors are covered with the caps when not in use. WARNING • Abrupt maneuvers or failure to properly secure cargo can allow the cargo to fly off the vehicle and hit others, causing personal injury or property damage. • Mount cargo securely and avoid abrupt maneuvers such as “jackrabbit” starts, sharp turns, fast cornering and sudden braking. Check periodically to make sure that cargo is securely fastened. • Large, bulky, long, or flat items can affect vehicle aerodynamics or be caught by the wind, and can reduce vehicle control resulting in an accident and personal injury. Drive cautiously at reduced speed when carrying this type of cargo. 5-79 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT HomeLink® (if equipped) any garage door opener model manufactured before April 1, 1982). A garage door that cannot detect an object – signaling the door to stop and reverse – does not meet current U.S. federal safety standards. For more information, contact HomeLink® at www.homelink.com or by calling 1-800355-3515. 66J092 HomeLink® and the HomeLink® house are registered trademarks of Johnson Controls, Inc. The HomeLink® Wireless Control System provides a convenient way to replace up to three hand-held radio-frequency (RF) transmitters used to activate devices such as gate operators, garage door openers, entry door locks, security systems, even home lighting. Additional HomeLink® information can be found on the Internet at www.homelink.com or by calling 1-800355-3515. Before programming HomeLink® to a garage door opener or gate operator, make sure that people and objects are out of the way of the device to prevent potential harm or damage. When programming a garage door opener, it is advised to park outside of the garage. Do not use HomeLink® with any garage door opener that lacks safety stop and reverse features as required by U.S. federal safety standards (this includes Retain the original transmitter of the RF device you are programming for use in other vehicles as well as for future HomeLink® programming. It is also suggested that upon the sale of the vehicle, the programmed HomeLink® buttons be erased for security purposes. Refer to “Programming HomeLink®” (step 1) only) or, for assistance, contact HomeLink® at www.homelink.com or by calling 1-800355-3515. Programming HomeLink® NOTE: Some vehicles may require the ignition switch to be turned to the second (or “accessories”) position or the “on” position for programming and/or operation of HomeLink®. It is also recommended that a new battery be placed in the hand-held transmitter of the device being programmed to HomeLink® for quicker training and accurate transmission of the radiofrequency signal. Do not repeat “Programming HomeLink®” – step 1) to train additional devices to a second or third HomeLink® button. Begin with “Programming HomeLink®” – step 2). 66J050 1) Press and hold the two outer HomeLink® buttons (buttons one and three) – releasing only when the indicator light begins to flash (after 20 seconds). Do not hold the buttons for longer than 30 seconds and do not repeat step 1) to program a second and/or third hand-held transmitter to the remaining two HomeLink® buttons. 2) Position the end of your hand-held transmitter 5–14 cm (1–3 inches) away from the HomeLink® button you wish to program while keeping the indicator light in view. 3) Simultaneously press and hold both the chosen HomeLink® and hand-held transmitter buttons. Do not release the buttons until step 4) has been completed. 5-80 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT NOTE: Some gate operators and garage door openers may require you to replace this Programming step 3) with procedures noted in the “Gate Operator / Canadian Programming” section. HomeLink®” steps 6–8 to complete the programming of a rolling code equipped device (most commonly a garage door opener). 4) After the HomeLink® indicator light changes from a slow to a rapidly blinking light, release both the HomeLink® and hand-held transmitter buttons. NOTE: There are 30 seconds in which to initiate step 8). NOTE: If the HomeLink® indicator light does not change to a rapidly blinking light, contact HomeLink® at www.homelink.com or call 1-800-355-3515 for assistance. 5) Press and hold the just-trained HomeLink® button and observe the indicator light. – If the indicator light stays on constantly, programming is complete and your device should activate when the HomeLink® button is pressed and released. 66J051 NOTE: To program the remaining two HomeLink® buttons, begin with “Programming HomeLink®” – step 2). Do not repeat step 1). – If the indicator light blinks rapidly for two seconds and then turns to a constant light continue with “Programming 6) At the garage door opener receiver (motor-head unit) in the garage, locate the “learn” or “smart” button. This can usually be found where the hanging antenna wire is attached to the motorhead unit. 7) Firmly press and release the “learn” or “smart” button. (The name and color of the button may vary by manufacturer.) 8) Return to the vehicle and firmly press, hold for two seconds and release the programmed HomeLink® button. Repeat the “press/hold/release” sequence a second time, and, depending on the brand of the garage door opener (or other rolling code equipped device), repeat this sequence a third time to complete the programming process. HomeLink® should now activate your rolling code equipped device. NOTE: To program the remaining two HomeLink® buttons, begin with “Programming HomeLink®” – step 2). Do not repeat step 1). 66J052 For questions or comments, please contact HomeLink® at www.homelink.com or 1-800-355-3515. 5-81 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Gate Operator / Canadian Programming Canadian radio-frequency laws require transmitter signals to “time-out” (or quit) after several seconds of transmission – which may not be long enough for HomeLink® to pick up the signal during programming. Similar to this Canadian law, some U.S. gate operators are designed to “time-out” in the same manner. If you live in Canada or you are having difficulties programming a gate operator by using the Programming procedures (regardless of where you live), replace “Programming HomeLink®” step 3) with the following: NOTE: If programming a garage door opener or gate operator, it is advised to unplug the device during the “cycling” process to prevent possible overheating. 3) Continue to press and hold the HomeLink® button while you press and release – every two seconds (“cycle”) your hand-held transmitter until the frequency signal has successfully been accepted by HomeLink®. (The indicator light will flash slowly and then rapidly.) Using HomeLink® To operate, simply press and release the programmed HomeLink® button. Activation will now occur for the trained device (i.e. garage door opener, gate operator, security system, entry door lock, home/office lighting, etc.). For convenience, the handheld transmitter of the device may also be used at any time. In the event that there are still programming difficulties or questions, contact HomeLink® at www.homelink.com or 1-800-355-3515. Erasing HomeLink® Buttons To erase programming from the three buttons (individual buttons cannot be erased but can be “reprogrammed” as outlined below), follow the step noted: Reprogramming a Single HomeLink® Button To program a device to HomeLink® using a HomeLink® button previously trained, follow these steps: 1) Press and hold the desired HomeLink® button. DO NOT release the button. 2) The indicator light will begin to flash after 20 seconds. Without releasing the HomeLink® button, proceed with “Programming HomeLink®” – step 2). For questions or comments, contact HomeLink® at www.homelink.com or 1800-355-3515. Press and hold the two outer HomeLink® buttons until the indicator light begins to flash-after 20 seconds. Release both buttons. Do not hold for longer that 30 seconds. HomeLink® is now in the train (or learning) mode and can be programmed at any time beginning with “Programming HomeLink®” – step 2). Proceed with “Programming HomeLink®” step 4) to complete. 5-82 79K21-03E OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT Frame Hooks Frame hooks are provided at the front and rear of the vehicle. Front To access the front hook, unhook the lower part of the cover (1) and then remove the cover (1). (1) WARNING Do not use the frame hooks to tow another vehicle or to have your vehicle towed on the road or highway. The hooks are designed for use in emergency situations only, such as if your vehicle or another vehicle gets stuck in deep mud or snow. (2) (2) 78K052 Rear 78K053 The frame hooks (2) are provided for shipping purposes only. 78K149 5-83 79K21-03E VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING Vehicle Loading ................................................................... 6-1 Trailer Towing ...................................................................... 6-2 Towing Your Vehicle (recreational towing) ...................... 6-7 6 54G215 79K21-03E Vehicle Loading: 11 VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING Vehicle Loading GAWR – (Front and Rear) Maximum permissible weight on an individual axle. Vehicle Capacity Weight – Maximum permissible load weight a vehicle can carry including the weight of all the occupants, accessories, cargo, plus trailer tongue weight (if towing a trailer). 54G307 Your vehicle was designed for specific weight capacities. The weight capacities of your vehicle are indicated by the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR), the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR, front and rear) and the Vehicle Capacity Weight. The GVWR and GAWR (front and rear) are listed on the Safety Certification Label which is located below the driver’s side door latch striker. The Vehicle Capacity Weight is listed on the Tire Information Label which is located below the Safety Certification Label. GVWR – Maximum permissible overall weight of the fully loaded vehicle (including all the occupants, accessories and cargo plus the trailer tongue weight if towing a trailer). The weight of any accessories already installed on your vehicle at the time of purchase, or that you or the dealer install after purchase, must be subtracted from the Vehicle Capacity Weight to determine how much capacity remains available for occupants, cargo, and trailer tongue weight (if towing a trailer). Contact your dealer for further information. Actual weight of the loaded vehicle and actual loads at the front and rear axles can only be determined by weighing the vehicle using a vehicle scale. To measure the weight and load, try taking your vehicle to a highway weighing station, shipping company or inspection station for trucks, etc. Compare these weights to the GVWR and GAWR (front and rear) listed on the Safety Certification Label. If the gross vehicle weight or the load on either axle exceeds these ratings, you must remove enough weight to bring the load down to the rated capacity. WARNING Never overload your vehicle. The gross vehicle weight (sum of the weights of the loaded vehicle, driver and passengers) must never exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) listed on the Safety Certification Label. In addition, never distribute a load so that the weight on either the front or rear axle exceeds the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) listed on the Safety Certification Label. WARNING • Always distribute cargo evenly. • To avoid personal injury or damage to your vehicle, always secure cargo to prevent it from shifting if the vehicle moves suddenly. • Place heavier objects on the floor and as far forward in the cargo area as possible. Never pile cargo higher than the top of the seat backs. 6-1 79K21-03E Trailer Towing: 5, 11, 13 VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING Trailer Towing You can use your SUZUKI to tow a trailer, but you should always observe the requirements and recommendations in this section. If you intend to tow a trailer, it is essential to select a trailer and trailer towing equipment which are compatible. A reputable trailer dealer can help you. cool down. Refer to “If the Engine Overheats” section for details on how to deal with overheating. CAUTION Towing in “D” range up a steep hill can cause coolant overheating which may result in engine/automatic transmission damage. CAUTION Trailer towing puts additional stress on the engine, drive train and brakes of your vehicle. Never tow a trailer during the first 960 km (600 miles) of vehicle operation. CAUTION Because towing a trailer puts additional stress on your vehicle, more frequent maintenance will be required than under normal driving conditions. Follow the schedule for Maintenance Recommended Under Severe Driving Conditions or perform more frequent maintenance as necessary. For Automatic transmission vehicles, shift into “3” (Low 2) or “L” (Low 1) (if necessary) and frequently monitor the coolant temperature gauge when towing up a steep hill. If the gauge indicates overheating, park the vehicle in a safe place and let the engine Hitches Use only a trailer hitch bracket that is designed to bolt to the frame of your vehicle, and a hitch that is designed to bolt to this bracket. We recommend that you use a genuine SUZUKI trailer hitch bracket and trailer hitch (available as options), or equivalent. WARNING Never use a bumper hitch or a hitch which attaches to the axle of your vehicle. Safety Chains Always attach safety chains between your vehicle and trailer. Cross safety chains under the tongue of the trailer so that the tongue will not drop to the road if the trailer becomes separated from the hitch. Follow the manufacturer’s recommendation for attaching safety chains. Always leave just enough slack to permit full turning. Never allow safety chains to drag on the road. WARNING Never attach safety chains to the bumper of your vehicle. Secure connections so that they can’t come loose. Trailer Lights Make sure your trailer is equipped with lights which meet federal, state and local requirements. Always check for the proper operation of all trailer lights before you start to tow. WARNING Never splice trailer lights directly into your vehicle’s electrical system, or electrical system damage may occur. Brakes WARNING If trailer brakes are used, you should follow all instructions provided by the manufacturer. Never tap into the brake system of your vehicle. 6-2 79K21-03E Trailer Towing: 5, 11, 13 VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING Tires Gross Trailer Weight Gross Combined Weight WARNING When towing a trailer, it is very important for your vehicle and trailer to have properly inflated tires. Your vehicle’s tires should be inflated to the recommended pressures listed on your vehicle’s Tire Inflation Pressure label. Inflate trailer tires according to the specifications provided by the trailer manufacturer. Mirrors Check to see if your vehicle’s mirrors meet federal, state and local requirements for mirrors used on towing vehicles. If they do not, you must install required mirrors before you tow. Vehicle/Trailer Weight Limits Before towing, you must make sure that gross trailer weight, gross combined weight, trailer tongue weight, gross vehicle weight and gross axle weight (front and rear) are within specified limits as described below. You can measure vehicle and trailer weights using a vehicle scale and can measure tongue weight using a bathroom scale. 60A378 60A381 Gross Trailer Weight is the weight of the trailer plus all cargo in it (measured with the trailer disconnected from the towing vehicle). Gross trailer weight must never exceed 1360 kg (3000 pounds). Gross Combined Weight is the weight of the fully loaded vehicle (including all the occupants, accessories and cargo) plus the weight of the fully loaded trailer. Gross combined weight must never exceed: • 2.4 L – 3460 kg (7628 pounds) • 3.2 L – 3530 kg (7782 pounds) If you intend to tow a trailer having a gross trailer weight greater than 450 kg (1000 pounds), the trailer must be equipped with trailer brakes. 6-3 79K21-03E Trailer Towing: 5, 11, 13 VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING Gross Vehicle Weight Tongue Weight Gross Axle Weight 60A380 60A379 60A382 Tongue Weight is the downward force exerted on the hitch by the trailer coupler, with the trailer fully loaded and the coupler at its normal towing height. Cargo should be distributed so that tongue weight is approximately 10% of gross trailer weight. Gross Vehicle Weight is the weight of the fully loaded vehicle (including all the occupants, accessories and cargo plus the trailer tongue weight). The gross vehicle weight must never exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) listed on the Safety Certification Label. Gross Axle Weight (Front and Rear) is the weight supported by an individual axle with the vehicle fully loaded and the trailer connected. Gross axle weight for the front and rear axles must never exceed the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) listed on the Safety Certification Label. NOTE: You can usually get tongue weight to be about 10% of gross trailer weight by placing about 60% of the total cargo weight in the front half of the trailer. You should measure gross trailer weight and tongue weight before towing, however, to make sure that your load is properly distributed. WARNING Improper distribution of cargo in your trailer may result in poor vehicle handling and swaying of the trailer. Always make sure that trailer tongue weight is about 10% of gross trailer weight. Failure to observe this requirement may result in an accident. 6-4 79K21-03E Trailer Towing: 5, 11, 13 VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING Additional Trailer Towing Warnings WARNING Never overload your trailer or your vehicle. Gross Trailer Weight must never exceed 1350 kg (3000 pounds). Gross Combined Weight must never exceed 3400 kg (7500 pounds) for 2WD or 3450 kg (7600 pounds) for 4WD. Gross vehicle weight must never exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) listed on the Safety Certification Label. Gross axle weight for the front and rear axles must not exceed the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) listed on the Safety Certification Label. WARNING Do not tow a trailer having a gross trailer weight greater than 450 kg (1000 pounds) unless the trailer is equipped with trailer brakes. WARNING WARNING Connect trailer lights and hook up safety chains every time you tow. WARNING Your vehicle will handle differently when towing a trailer. For your safety and the safety of others, you should observe the following precautions: • Practice turning, stopping and backing up before you begin towing in traffic. Do not tow in traffic until you are confident that you can handle the vehicle and trailer safely. • Never exceed posted towing speed limits or 72 km/h (45 mph), whichever is lower. • Never drive at a speed that causes shaking or swaying of the trailer. If you notice even the slightest sign of shaking or swaying, slow down. • Always have someone guide you when backing. (Continued) (Continued) • Allow adequate stopping distance. Stopping distance is increased when you tow a trailer. For each 16 km/h (10 mph) of speed, allow at least one vehicle and trailer length between you and the vehicle ahead. Follow at a greater distance if roads are wet or slippery. • Slow down when making turns. Remember that a larger than normal turning radius is needed because the trailer wheels will be closer than the vehicle wheels to the inside of the turn. • Avoid sudden acceleration and stopping of the vehicle. Do not make quick maneuvers unless they are necessary. • Slow down in cross winds and be prepared for wind blasts from large passing vehicles. • Be careful when passing other vehicles. Be sure to allow enough room for your trailer before you change lanes, and signal well in advance. • Slow down and shift into a lower gear before you reach long or steep downhill grades. It is hazardous to attempt downshifting while you are descending a hill. (Continued) 6-5 79K21-03E Trailer Towing: 5, 11, 13 VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING WARNING (Continued) • Avoid “riding” the brakes. “Riding” the brakes could cause the brakes to overheat, resulting in reduced braking efficiency. Use engine braking as much as possible. • Because of the added trailer weight, your engine may overheat on hot days when going up long or steep hills. Pay attention to your engine temperature gauge. If it indicates overheating, pull off the road and stop in a safe place. Refer to the “If the Engine Overheats” in “EMERGENCY SERVICE” section for details on how to proceed. WARNING 60A186 WARNING When parking your vehicle and connected trailer, always use the following procedure: 1) Apply the vehicle’s brakes firmly. 2) Have another person place wheel chocks under the wheels of the vehicle and the trailer while you are holding the brakes. 3) Slowly release the brakes until the wheel chocks absorb the load. 4) Fully engage the parking brake. 5) Manual transmission – turn off the engine, then shift into reverse or first gear. Automatic transmission – shift into “P” (Park) and turn off the engine. (Continued) (Continued) 6) If you have a 4-wheel drive vehicle, make sure the transfer switch is not in “N” (Neutral). When starting out after parking: 1) Push in the clutch (if equipped) and start the engine. 2) Depress the brake pedal, shift into gear, release the parking brake and slowly pull away from the chocks. 3) Stop, apply the brakes firmly and hold the brakes while you have another person remove the chocks. 6-6 79K21-03E Towing Your Vehicle (recreational towing): 13 VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING Towing Your Vehicle (recreational towing) 4WD Vehicle With a Transfer Switch TOWING INSTRUCTION TABLE Your vehicle may be towed behind another vehicle (such as a motorhome), provided you use the proper towing method specified for your vehicle. The towing method you must use depends on the specifications of your vehicle: whether it is a 2wheel drive (2WD), 4-wheel drive (4WD) with a transfer switch or 4-wheel drive (4WD) without a transfer switch vehicle. DRIVE TRAIN Use the towing instruction table to select the proper towing method for your vehicle, and carefully follow the corresponding instructions. Be sure to use proper towing equipment designed for recreational towing and make sure that towing speed does not exceed 90 km/h (55 mph). 2WD 4WD with a transfer switch 4WD without a transfer switch TRANSMISSION TOWING METHOD A/T A M/T A A/T none M/T none A/T B M/T B 54G585 CAUTION Never tow your 4WD vehicle without a transfer switch using recreational towing methods. If you do, the transmission will be permanently damaged. 64J234 6-7 79K21-03E Towing Your Vehicle (recreational towing): 13 VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING To tow a vehicle equipped with a transfer switch with all four wheels on the ground: 1) Turn the ignition key to the “ON” position. 2) Place the transmission in “N” (Neutral) and depress the brake pedal and the clutch pedal fully (if equipped). 3) Use the transfer switch to shift into neutral. Before towing WARNING When you tow your vehicle, follow the instructions below to avoid accidents and damage to your vehicle. In addition, be sure to observe government and local requirements regarding vehicle lighting and trailer hitches or tow bars. WARNING A safety chain should always be used when you tow your vehicle. CAUTION Do not tow your vehicle with either front wheels or rear wheels directly on the ground (and the transmission in neutral). If you do, the transmission will be damaged fatally. (1) 64J147 Vehicles equipped with a transfer switch may be towed from the front with all four wheels on the ground. Be sure to use proper towing equipment designed for recreational towing and make sure that towing speed does not exceed 90 km/h (55 mph). 64J218 NOTE: First, push in and turn the switch to the mark (1) at the left of the “N” position, and hold the switch in this position for 5 seconds until the “N” indicator blinks, then turn the switch to the “N” position. When you turn the transfer switch to the “N” position, “N” indicator will come on with the buzzer sound. 4) Make sure the “N” light on the instrument cluster comes on. 5) Shift the manual transmission lever into 2nd gear or the automatic transmission lever into “P” (Park). 6) Turn the ignition key to the “ACC” position to unlock the steering wheel. 6-8 79K21-03E Towing Your Vehicle (recreational towing): 13 VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING 7) Release the parking brake. Stop towing the vehicle every 300 km (200 miles). Start the engine. With the manual transmission lever in 2nd gear (or the automatic transmission lever in “D”) and the transfer switch in neutral, rev the engine for about one minute with the clutch engaged (if equipped), to circulate oil in the transfer case. TOWING METHOD A FOUR WHEELS ON THE GROUND 64J148 6-9 79K21-03E Towing Your Vehicle (recreational towing): 13 VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING 4WD Vehicle Without a Transfer Switch 2WD Vehicle 1) Secure the rear wheels on a towing dolly according to the instructions provided by the dolly manufacturer. 2) Turn the ignition key to the “ACC” position to unlock the steering wheel. 3) Make sure the front wheels are facing straight forward and secure the steering wheel with a steering wheel clamping device designed for towing. CAUTION 64J234 54G586 You cannot tow your vehicle behind another vehicle using recreational towing methods. The steering column is not strong enough to withstand shocks transmitted from the front wheels during towing. Always unlock the steering wheel before towing. CAUTION Never tow your vehicle using recreational towing methods. If you do, the transmission will be permanently damaged. 54G585 6-10 79K21-03E Towing Your Vehicle (recreational towing): 13 VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING TOWING METHOD B FRONT WHEELS ON THE GROUND AND REAR WHEELS ON A DOLLY. 52D082 6-11 79K21-03E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE 60G410 Maintenance Schedule ....................................................... 7-2 Periodic Maintenance Schedule ........................................ 7-3 Maintenance Recommended under Severe Driving Conditions ........................................................................... 7-7 Drive Belt ............................................................................. 7-9 Engine Oil and Filter ........................................................... 7-10 Engine Coolant .................................................................... 7-13 Air Cleaner ........................................................................... 7-16 Spark Plugs ......................................................................... 7-16 Gear Oil ................................................................................ 7-17 Clutch Pedal ........................................................................ 7-20 7 Automatic Transmission Fluid ........................................... 7-20 Brakes .................................................................................. 7-22 Steering Wheel .................................................................... 7-24 Tires ...................................................................................... 7-25 Battery .................................................................................. 7-36 Fuses .................................................................................... 7-36 Headlight Aiming ................................................................. 7-39 Bulb Replacement ............................................................... 7-40 Wiper Blades ....................................................................... 7-46 Windshield Washer Fluid ................................................... 7-49 Air Conditioning System .................................................... 7-49 79K21-03E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE WARNING 60A187S WARNING You should take extreme care when working on your vehicle to prevent accidental injury. Here are a few precautions that you should be especially careful to observe: • To prevent damage or unintended inflation of the air bag system, be sure the battery is disconnected and the ignition switch has been in the “LOCK” position for at least 90 seconds before performing any electrical service work on your SUZUKI. Do not touch air bag system components or wires. The wires are wrapped with yellow tape or yellow tubing, and the couplers are yellow for easy identification. (Continued) (Continued) • Do not leave the engine running in garages or other confined areas. • When the engine is running, keep hands, clothing, tools and other objects away from the moving fan and fan belt. • When it is necessary to do service work with the engine running, make sure that the parking brake is set fully and the transmission is in Neutral (for manual transmission vehicles) or Park (for automatic transmission vehicles). • Do not touch ignition wires or other ignition system parts when starting the engine or when the engine is running, or you could receive an electric shock. • Be careful not to touch a hot engine, exhaust manifold and pipes, muffler, radiator and water hoses. • Do not allow smoking, sparks or flames around fuel or the battery. Flammable fumes are present. • Do not get under your vehicle if it is supported only with the portable jack provided in your vehicle. (Continued) WARNING (Continued) • Be careful not to cause accidental short circuits between the positive and negative battery terminals. • Keep used oil, engine coolant and other fluids away from children and pets. Dispose of used fluids properly; never pour them on the ground, into sewers, etc. 7-1 79K21-03E Maintenance Schedule: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE NOTICE (for U.S.A.) Maintenance, replacement or repair of the emission control devices and systems may be performed by any automobile repair establishment or individual using any part which has been certified under the provisions in the Clean Air Act sec. 207. (a) (2). Maintenance Schedule The following table shows the times when you should perform regular maintenance on your vehicle. This table shows in miles, kilometers and months when you should perform inspections, adjustments, lubrication and other services. These intervals should be shortened if driving is usually done under severe conditions (refer to “Maintenance Recommended Under Severe Driving Conditions”). WARNING The shock absorbers are filled with high pressure gas. Never attempt to disassemble them or throw them into a fire. Avoid storing them near a heater or heating device. When scrapping the absorber, the gas must be released from the absorber safely. Ask your dealer for assistance. WARNING SUZUKI recommends that maintenance on items marked with an asterisk (*) be performed by your authorized SUZUKI dealer or a qualified service technician. If you are qualified, you may perform maintenance on the unmarked items by referring to the instructions in this section. If you are not sure whether you can successfully complete any of the unmarked maintenance jobs, ask your authorized SUZUKI dealer to do the maintenance for you. CAUTION Whenever it becomes necessary to replace parts on your vehicle, it is recommended that you use genuine SUZUKI replacement parts or their equivalent. 7-2 79K21-03E Periodic Maintenance Schedule: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Periodic Maintenance Schedule R: Replace or change I : Inspect, clean, adjust, lubricate or replace as necessary Interval: This interval should be judged by miles (x 1000) 7.5 15 22.5 30 37.5 45 52.5 60 67.5 odometer reading or months, whichever comes km (x 1000) 12.5 25 37.5 50 62.5 75 87.5 100 112.5 first. months 7.5 15 22.5 30 37.5 45 52.5 60 67.5 ENGINE & EMISSION CONTROL 1. Drive belt Inspect for damage – – – I – – – I – *2. Valve lash (clearance) (for 2.4 L engine) – – – – – – – I – 3. Engine oil and oil filter R R R R R R R R R *4. Cooling system hoses and connections – – – I – – – I – 5. Engine coolant SUZUKI LLC: Standard (Green) – – – R – – – R – SUZUKI LLC: Super (Blue) (#2) First time only: Replace at 150000 km (90000 miles) or 90 months Second time and after: Replace every 75000 km (45000 miles) or 45 months *6. Exhaust pipes and mountings – – – I – – – I&(R) – *7. EVAP canister Replace every 250000 km (150000 miles) or 180 months *8. Emission-related hoses & tubes – – – – – – – I – 9. Spark plugs – – – – – – – R – *10. Ignition coil (Plug cap) – – – I – – – I – *11. Fuel tank & cap – – – I – – – I – 12. Air cleaner filter element – – – R – – – R – *13. Fuel filter – – – – – – – – – *14. Fuel lines and connections – – – I – – – I – *15. Canister air suction filter Replace every 250000 km (150000 miles) or 180 months 75 125 75 – – R – – – – – – – – – – #2: Be sure to perform the engine coolant level check under the daily inspection in “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section. If you replace the engine coolant other than the SUZUKI LLC: Super (Blue), follow the schedule of SUZUKI LLC: Standard (Green). 7-3 79K21-03E Periodic Maintenance Schedule: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE R: Replace or change I : Inspect, clean, adjust, lubricate or replace as necessary Interval: This interval should be judged by miles (x 1000) 82.5 90 97.5 105 112.5 120 127.5 135 142.5 odometer reading or months, whichever comes km (x 1000) 137.5 150 162.5 175 187.5 200 212.5 225 237.5 first. months 82.5 90 97.5 105 112.5 120 127.5 135 142.5 ENGINE & EMISSION CONTROL 1. Drive belt Inspect for damage – I – – – I – – – *2. Valve lash (clearance) (for 2.4 L engine) – – – – – I – – – 3. Engine oil and oil filter R R R R R R R R R *4. Cooling system hoses and connections – I – – – I – – – 5. Engine coolant SUZUKI LLC: Standard (Green) – R – – – R – – – SUZUKI LLC: Super (Blue) (#2) First time only: Replace at 150000 km (90000 miles) or 90 months Second time and after: Replace every 75000 km (45000 miles) or 45 months *6. Exhaust pipes and mountings – I – – – I&(R) – – – *7. EVAP canister Replace every 250000 km (150000 miles) or 180 months *8. Emission-related hoses & tubes – – – – – I – – – 9. Spark plugs – – – – – R – – – *10. Ignition coil (Plug cap) – I – – – I – – – *11. Fuel tank & cap – I – – – I – – – 12. Air cleaner filter element – R – – – R – – – *13. Fuel filter – – – – – – – – – *14. Fuel lines and connections – I – – – I – – – *15. Canister air suction filter Replace every 250000 km (150000 miles) or 180 months 150 250 150 I – R I R I I – I I (#1) R R I (#1) #1: Inspect at 250000 km (150000 miles) or 180 months. #2: Be sure to perform the engine coolant level check under the daily inspection in “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section. If you replace the engine coolant other than the SUZUKI LLC: Super (Blue), follow the schedule of SUZUKI LLC: Standard (Green). NOTE: The maintenance services enclosed with rectangle are recommended maintenance items. Item 6 (R) is applicable to the exhaust mounting rubber only. The U.S. Environmental Protection Agency or the California Air Resources Board has determined that the failure to perform recommended maintenance items enclosed with a rectangle will not nullify the emission warranty or limit recall liability prior to the completion of the vehicle’s useful life. SUZUKI, however, urges that all recommended maintenance services be performed at the indicated intervals and the maintenance recorded. 7-4 79K21-03E Periodic Maintenance Schedule: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE R: Replace or change I : Inspect, clean, adjust, lubricate or replace as necessary Interval: This interval should be judged by miles (x 1000) odometer reading or months, whichever comes km (x 1000) first. months CHASSIS AND BODY 1. Clutch (for manual transmission) Pedal and fluid level *2. Brake discs and pads (front, rear) Brake drums and shoes (if equipped) *3. Brake hoses and pipes 4. Brake fluid level check, *replacement 5. Brake pedal stroke check, *adjustment 6. Parking brake lever and *cable Lever movement check, *adjustment 7. Tires (including tire rotation) *8. Wheel discs *9. Wheel bearings *10. Suspension system *11. Propeller shafts/Drive shafts *12. Manual transmission oil 13. Automatic transmission (A/T) Fluid level *Fluid change *Fluid hose *14. Transfer oil *15. Differential & Extension (for 2WD) oil 16. Steering system Steering wheel movement, *linkage *17. Power steering (if equipped) 18. All Latches, Hinges and Locks 19. Air conditioner filter (if equipped) 7.5 12.5 7.5 15 25 15 22.5 37.5 22.5 30 50 30 37.5 62.5 37.5 45 75 45 52.5 87.5 52.5 60 100 60 67.5 112.5 67.5 75 125 75 – – – – – – I I I I I I – – – – – – I I I I I I – – – – – – I I I I I I – – – – – – I I I I R I – – – – – – I I I I I I – I I – – – – – I I I I I I I I – – – – I I I I I – I I I I – I – I – I – I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I – I – *I – I – *I – I – I – I – I – I – I – I – I I – – R – I – R – I – I – I – I Replace every 175000 km (105000 miles)-----4-speed A/T or 5-speed A/T – – – – – I – – I – – I – I – R R – – I – I – I I I I – I I I I I I I – I I I R I I I – I I I I I I I – I I I R 7-5 79K21-03E Periodic Maintenance Schedule: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE R: Replace or change I : Inspect, clean, adjust, lubricate or replace as necessary Interval: This interval should be judged by miles (x 1000) odometer reading or months, whichever comes km (x 1000) first. months CHASSIS AND BODY 1. Clutch (for manual transmission) Pedal and fluid level *2. Brake discs and pads (front, rear) Brake drums and shoes (if equipped) *3. Brake hoses and pipes 4. Brake fluid level check, *replacement 5. Brake pedal stroke check, *adjustment 6. Parking brake lever and *cable Lever movement check, *adjustment 7. Tires (including tire rotation) *8. Wheel discs *9. Wheel bearings *10. Suspension system *11. Propeller shafts/Drive shafts *12. Manual transmission oil 13. Automatic transmission (A/T) Fluid level *Fluid change *Fluid hose *14. Transfer oil *15. Differential & Extension (for 2WD) oil 16. Steering system Steering wheel movement, *linkage *17. Power steering (if equipped) 18. All Latches, Hinges and Locks 19. Air conditioner filter (if equipped) 82.5 137.5 82.5 90 150 90 97.5 162.5 97.5 105 175 105 112.5 187.5 112.5 120 200 120 127.5 212.5 127.5 135 225 135 142.5 237.5 142.5 150 250 150 – – – – – – I I I I I I – – – – – – I I I I I I – – – – – – I I I I R I – – – – – – I I I I I I – – – – – – I I I I I I – I I – – – – – I I I I I I R I – – – – I I I I I – I I I R – I – I – I – I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I – *I – I – *I – I – I – I – I – I – I – I – I – I – R – I – R – I – I – I – I – I Replace every 175000 km (105000 miles)-----4-speed A/T or 5-speed A/T – I – – – – – I – I – I – R – I – I – I – I – I I I I – I I I R I I I – I I I I I I I – I I I R I I I – I I I I NOTE: This table shows the service schedule up to 250000 km (150000 miles). Beyond 250000 km (150000 miles), perform the same services at the same intervals shown in the chart. Beyond 250000 km (150000 miles), the maintenance services enclosed with a rectangle are required. Item 9 *I - inspect for wear. 7-6 79K21-03E Maintenance Recommended under Severe Driving Conditions: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Maintenance Recommended under Severe Driving Conditions If the vehicle is usually used under the conditions corresponding to any severe condition code given below, it is recommended that applicable maintenance operation be performed at the particular interval shown in the chart below. Severe condition code A – Repeated short trips B – Driving on rough and/or muddy roads C – Driving on dusty roads D – Driving in extremely cold weather and/or on salted roads E – Repeated short trips in extremely cold weather H – Towing a trailer Severe Condition Code A – Maintenance C D E H Engine oil and oil filter A B – D – H Exhaust pipes and mountings Maintenance Operation R I I – – C – – – Air cleaner filter element *1 R – – C – – – Canister air suction filter R A B C – – H Brake discs and pads (front) Brake drums and shoes (rear) I – B – D E H Propeller shafts/Drive shafts I – B – – R E H Manual transmission oil Maintenance Interval Every 5000 km (3000 miles) or 3 months Every 10000 km (6000 miles) or 6 months Every 5000 km (3000 miles) or 3 months Every 25000 km (15000 miles) or 15 months Every 100000 km (60000 miles) or 60 months Every 10000 km (6000 miles) or 6 months Every 10000 km (6000 miles) or 6 months Every 25000 km (15000 miles) or 15 months 7-7 79K21-03E Maintenance Recommended under Severe Driving Conditions: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Severe Condition Code Maintenance Maintenance Operation – B – – E H Automatic transmission (A/T) fluid R – B – – E H Transfer, Differential and Extension oil R – B – – – – Bolts and nuts on suspension T – B C D – – Drive belt (Engine accessory) I – – – Air conditioner filter element *2 I C D – R Maintenance Interval Every 25000 km (15000 miles) or 15 months Every 25000 km (15000 miles) or 15 months Every 10000 km (6000 miles) or 6 months Every 25000 km (15000 miles) or 15 months Every 10000 km (6000 miles) or 6 months Every 50000 km (30000 miles) or 30 months NOTE: I – Inspect, clean, adjust, lubricate or replace as necessary T – Tighten to the specified torque R – Replace or change L – Lubricate *1 Inspect more frequently if the vehicle is used under dusty conditions. *2 Clean more frequently if the air flow from the air conditioner decreases. 7-8 79K21-03E Drive Belt: 1, 2 Engine Oil and Filter: 1, 2 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Drive Belt WARNING L4 2.4 L When the engine is running, keep hands, hair, clothing, tools, etc. away from the moving fan and drive belts. V6 3.2 L PS ADB Check the accessory drive belt only for damage. You do not need check it for tension as it has an automatic tensioner. If you need to replace or adjust the belt have it done by your SUZUKI dealer. PS ADB GE GE AC AC →: 100 N (22 lbs, 10 kg) press ADB: Accessory drive belt GE: Generator PS: Power steering pump AC: Air conditioner compressor 79K041 7-9 79K21-03E Engine Oil and Filter: 1, 2 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Engine Oil and Filter Oil Level Check Specified Oil Engine oil dipstick EXAMPLE FULL ADD “Starburst” 52D084 52D030 79K096 Use engine oil with the American Petroleum Institute Certified For Gasoline Engines “Starburst” symbol. We highly recommend you use SAE 5W30 oil. CAUTION It is important to keep the engine oil at the correct level for proper lubrication of your vehicle’s engine. Check the oil level with the vehicle on a level surface. The oil level indication may be inaccurate if the vehicle is on a slope. The oil level should be checked either before starting the engine or at least 5 minutes after stopping the engine. The handle of the engine oil dipstick is colored yellow for easy identification. Pull out the oil dipstick, wipe oil off with a clean cloth, insert the dipstick all the way into the engine, then remove it again. The oil on the stick should be between the upper and lower limits shown on the stick. If the oil level indication is near the lower limit, add enough oil to raise the level to the upper limit. Failure to use the recommended oil can result in engine damage. 7-10 79K21-03E Engine Oil and Filter: 1, 2 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Refilling Changing Engine Oil and Filter WARNING EXAMPLE Open EXAMPLE Close 81A147 60G306 Remove the oil filler cap and pour oil slowly through the filler hole to bring the oil level to the upper limit on the dipstick. Be careful not to overfill. Too much oil is almost as bad as too little oil. After refilling, start the engine and allow it to idle for about a minute. Stop the engine, wait about 5 minutes and check the oil level again. Drain the engine oil while the engine is still warm. 1) Remove the oil filler cap. 2) Remove the engine under cover. 3) Place a drain pan under the drain plug. 4) Using a wrench, remove the drain plug and drain out the engine oil. New and used oil and solvent can be hazardous. Children and pets may be harmed by swallowing new or used oil or solvent. Repeated, prolonged contact with used engine oil may cause skin cancer. Brief contact with used oil or solvent may irritate skin. • Keep new and used oil and solvent away from children and pets. • Wear a long-sleeve shirt and waterproof gloves. • Wash with soap if oil or solvent contacts your skin. 5) Reinstall the drain plug and gasket. Tighten the plug with a wrench to the specified torque. 6) Reinstall the engine under cover. Tightening torque specification 35 Nm (25.3 lb-ft, 3.5 kg-m) WARNING The engine oil temperature may be high enough to burn your fingers when the drain plug is loosened. Wait until the drain plug is cool enough to touch with your bare hands. 7-11 79K21-03E Engine Oil and Filter: 1, 2 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Replace the Oil Filter NOTE: • When it is difficult to remove the oil filter, we recommend you take your vehicle to your SUZUKI dealer for oil filter replacement. • For 3.2 L engine, since special procedures are required, we recommend you take your vehicle to your SUZUKI dealer for oil filter replacement. 2.4 L engine EXAMPLE Refill with Oil and Check for Leaks 54G093 78K055 1) Using an oil filter wrench, turn the oil filter counterclockwise and remove it. 2) Using a clean rag, wipe off the mounting surface on the engine where the new filter will be seated. 3) Smear a little engine oil around the rubber gasket of the new oil filter. 4) Screw on the new filter by hand until the filter gasket contacts the mounting surface. (1) Oil filter (2) 3/4 turn 5) Tighten the filter 3/4 turn from the point of contact with the mounting surface (or to the specified torque) using an oil filter wrench. 6) Reinstall the engine under cover. Tightening torque specification 14 Nm (10.1 lb-ft, 1.4 kg-m) CAUTION CAUTION To tighten the oil filter properly, it is important to accurately identify the position at which the filter gasket first contacts the mounting surface. To prevent oil leakage, make sure that the oil filter is tight, but do not overtighten it. 1) Pour oil through the filler hole and install the filler cap. For the approximate capacity of the oil, refer to the “Capacities” item in the “SPECIFICATIONS” section. 2) Start the engine and look carefully for leaks at the oil filter and drain plug. Run the engine at various speeds for at least 5 minutes. 3) Stop the engine and wait about 5 minutes. Check the oil level again and add oil if necessary. Check for leaks again. CAUTION When replacing the oil filter, it is recommended that you use a genuine SUZUKI replacement filter. If you use an after-market filter, make sure it is of equivalent quality and carefully follow the manufacturer’s instructions and precautions. 7-12 79K21-03E Gear Oil: 6, 10 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Engine Coolant EXAMPLE Selection of Coolant CAUTION SUZUKI LLC: Super (Blue) coolant; SUZUKI LLC: Super (Blue) coolant is already diluted to the proper percentage. Do not dilute with distilled water additionally. Doing so may result in the possibility of freezing coolant and/or overheating. To maintain optimum performance and durability of your engine, use SUZUKI Genuine Coolant or equivalent. 83E010 64J151 CAUTION Oil leaks from around the oil filter or drain plug indicate incorrect installation or gasket damage. If you find any leaks or are not sure that the filter has been properly tightened, have the vehicle inspected by your SUZUKI dealer. EXAMPLE FULL LOW 60A208 NOTE: If you replace the engine coolant other than the SUZUKI LLC: Super (Blue), follow the schedule of SUZUKI LLC: Standard (Green). To see the detail of the maintenance schedule, refer to “Periodic Maintenance Schedule” in this section. This type of coolant is best for your cooling system as it: • Helps maintain proper engine temperature. • Gives proper protection against freezing and boiling. • Gives proper protection against corrosion and rust. Failure to use the proper coolant can damage your cooling system. Your authorized SUZUKI dealer can help you select the proper coolant. 7-13 79K21-03E Gear Oil: 6, 10 Automatic Transmission Fluid: 10 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Engine Coolant Level Check CAUTION To avoid damaging your cooling system: • Always use a high quality ethylene glycol base phosphate type coolant diluted with distilled water at the correct mixture concentration. • Make sure that the proper mix is 50/ 50 coolant to distilled water and in no case higher than 70/30. Concentrations greater than 70/30 coolant to distilled water will cause overheating conditions. • Do not use straight coolant nor plain water (except SUZUKI LLC: Super (Blue)). • Do not add extra inhibitors or additives. They may not be compatible with your cooling system. • Do not mix different types of base coolants. Doing so may result in accelerated seal wear and/or the possibility of severe overheating and extensive engine/automatic transmission damage. Check the engine coolant level at the reserve tank, not at the radiator. With the engine cool, the engine coolant level should be between the “FULL” and “LOW” marks. Adding Engine Coolant If the engine coolant level is below the “LOW” mark, more engine coolant should be added. Remove the reserve tank cap and add engine coolant until the reserve tank level reaches the “FULL” mark. Never fill the reserve tank above the “FULL” mark. CAUTION WARNING Engine coolant is harmful or fatal if swallowed or inhaled. Do not drink antifreeze or coolant solution. If swallowed, do not induce vomiting. Immediately contact a poison control center or a physician. Avoid inhaling mist or hot vapors; if inhaled, remove to fresh air. If coolant gets in eyes, flush eyes with water and seek medical attention. Wash thoroughly after handling. Solution can be poisonous to animals. Keep out of the reach of children and animals. • The mixture you use should contain 50% concentration of antifreeze. • If the lowest ambient temperature in your area is expected to be –35 °C (–31°F) or below, use higher concentrations up to 60% following the instructions on the antifreeze container. • When putting the cap on the reserve tank, line up the arrow on the cap and the arrow on the tank. Failure to follow this can result in coolant leakage. 7-14 79K21-03E Automatic Transmission Fluid: 10 Engine Coolant: 1, 2 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Engine Coolant Replacement EXAMPLE Open Close 66J191 66J151 1) When the engine is cool, remove the radiator cap by turning it slowly to the left until a “stop” is felt. Do not press down while turning the cap. Wait until any pressure is released, then press down on the cap and continue turning it to the left. WARNING It is hazardous to remove the radiator cap when the engine coolant temperature is high, because scalding fluid and steam may be blown out under pressure. Wait until the engine coolant temperature has lowered before removing the cap. 2) Remove the reservoir by lifting it up, and drain the reservoir completely. 64J191 3) Loosen the drain plug attached to the lower part of the radiator and drain the engine coolant into a suitable container. 4) Reinstall the reservoir and fill it with engine coolant to the “FULL” line. 5) Tighten the drain plug on the radiator, fill the radiator with engine coolant and install the radiator cap. 6) After filling, let the engine idle for about 2 – 3 minutes to get rid of air in the cooling system. Then, stop the engine. 7) Check the engine coolant level in the radiator again. If the level has gone down, add more engine coolant. CAUTION The engine coolant must be replaced with the vehicle on level ground. 7-15 79K21-03E Engine Coolant: 1, 2 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Air Cleaner CAUTION Spark Plugs The air cleaner element should be replaced every 50000 km (30000 miles). More frequent replacement is necessary when you drive under dusty conditions. EXAMPLE 66J167 78K056 If the air cleaner is clogged with dust, there will be greater intake resistance, resulting in decreased power output and increased fuel consumption. NOTE: For 3.2 L engine, to approach the spark plugs, you need to remove the bolts shown in the illustration. Check and clean periodically according to the following procedure: 1) Take off the air cleaner case cover. Remove the element from the air cleaner case cover. 2) This air cleaner element is of dry type. Remember that it needs cleaning according to the following method. 3) Blow off dust on cleaner element by compressed air from inside the element, or replace the element as necessary. 7-16 79K21-03E Engine Coolant: 1, 2 Windshield Washer Fluid: 3 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Gear Oil Specified Gear Oil When replacing gear oil, use gear oil with the appropriate viscosity and grade as shown in the charts below. We highly recommend you use SAE 75W-90 gear oil (SAE 80W-90 for front differential oil, rear differential oil and transfer gear oil). 1.0 – 1.1 mm (0.039 – 0.043 in.) Transmission/Extension case 65D434 You should inspect spark plugs periodically for carbon deposits. When carbon accumulates on a spark plug, a strong spark may not be produced. Remove carbon deposits with a wire or pin and adjust the spark plug gap. To access the spark plugs: 1) Remove the engine cover. 2) Disconnect the coupler (1) while pushing the release lever. 3) Remove the bolt. 4) Pull the ignition coil out. 80G093 CAUTION When replacing spark plugs, you should use the brand and type specified for your vehicle. For the specified plugs, refer to the “SPECIFICATIONS” section at the end of this book. If you wish to use a brand of spark plug other than the specified plugs, consult your SUZUKI dealer. 54G095 Differential/Transfer case 65D594 7-17 79K21-03E Windshield Washer Fluid: 3 Air Cleaner: 1, 2 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Extension case (2WD) Manual transmission API GRADE Transmission/ Extension case (1) GL-4 Transfer case Differential Front GL-5 (Hypoid gear oil) Rear (2) 52D087 Transfer case 66J165 (1) Oil filler and level plug (2) Oil drain plug (1) (2) 66J005 (1) Oil filler and level plug (2) Oil drain plug 7-18 79K21-03E Spark Plugs: 1, 2 Brakes: 6 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Front differential (1) (2) 79K133 Rear differential (1) Gear Oil Level Check Gear Oil Replacement The manual transmission, transfer gears, extension case and differentials (front and rear) are lubricated with gear oil. To check the gear oil level in any of the above locations, use the following procedure: To change the gear oil in the manual transmission, transfer case, extension case or differential(s), use the following procedure: 1) Park the vehicle on a level surface. Set parking brake and stop the engine. 2) Remove the oil filler plug (1). 3) Check the inside of the hole with your finger. If the oil level comes up to the bottom of the plug hole, the oil level is correct. If so, reinstall the plug. 4) If the oil level is low, add gear oil through the filler plug hole (1) until the oil level reaches the bottom of the filler hole, then reinstall the plug. 1) Remove the oil filler plug (1). 2) Remove the drain plug (2), drain the oil and reinstall the drain plug. 3) Pour new gear oil of the specified type through the filler hole until the oil level reaches the bottom of the filler hole. 4) Reinstall the filler plug. WARNING After driving the vehicle, gear oil temperature may be high enough to burn you. Wait until the oil filler plug is cool enough to touch with your bare hands before inspecting or replacing gear oil. CAUTION (2) When tightening these plugs, apply sealing compound “SUZUKI Bond No. 1217G” or equivalent to the plug threads to prevent oil leakage and tighten them to the specified torque shown below. 79K134 (1) Oil filler and level plug (2) Oil drain plug 7-19 79K21-03E Brakes: 6 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Clutch Pedal Tightening torque Manual transmission Transfer Extension case Front differential Rear differential Oil Filler Plug 23 Nm (17.0 lb-ft) (2.3 kg-m) 23 Nm (17.0 lb-ft) (2.3 kg-m) 23 Nm (17.0 lb-ft) (2.3 kg-m) 23 Nm (17.0 lb-ft) (2.3 kg-m) 23 Nm (17.0 lb-ft) (2.3 kg-m) Oil Drain Plug 23 Nm (17.0 lb-ft) (2.3 kg-m) 23 Nm (17.0 lb-ft) (2.3 kg-m) 23 Nm (17.0 lb-ft) (2.3 kg-m) 23 Nm (17.0 lb-ft) (2.3 kg-m) 23 Nm (17.0 lb-ft) (2.3 kg-m) Automatic Transmission Fluid Specified Fluid Use an automatic transmission fluid SUZUKI ATF 3317 or Mobil ATF 3309. Fluid Level Check CAUTION Driving with too much or too little fluid can damage the transmission. 64J154 Check the clutch pedal for smooth operation and clutch fluid level from time to time. If clutch dragging is felt with the pedal fully depressed, have the clutch inspected by your SUZUKI dealer. If the clutch fluid level is near the “MIN” line, fill it up to the “MAX” line with DOT3 brake fluid. You must check the fluid level with the automatic transmission fluid at normal operating temperature. To check the fluid level: 1) To warm up the transmission fluid, drive the vehicle or idle the engine until the temperature gauge indicates normal operating temperature. 2) Then drive for ten more minutes. CAUTION Be sure to use the specified automatic transmission fluid. Using automatic transmission fluid other than SUZUKI ATF 3317 or Mobil ATF 3309 may damage the automatic transmission of your vehicle. 7-20 79K21-03E Brakes: 6 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE NOTE: Do not check the fluid level if you have just driven the vehicle for a long time at high speed, if you have driven in city traffic in hot weather, or if the vehicle has been pulling a trailer. Wait until the fluid cools down (about 30 minutes), or the fluid level indication will not be correct. 3) Park your vehicle on level ground. 4) Apply the parking brake and then start the engine in “P” (Park). Let it idle for two minutes and keep it running during the fluid level check. 5) With your foot on the brake pedal, move the gearshift lever through each gear, pausing for about three seconds in each range. Then move it back to the “P” (Park) position. EXAMPLE The fluid level should be between the two marks in the “HOT” range on the dipstick. 7) Add just enough specified fluid through the dipstick hole to fill the transmission to the proper level. or CAUTION After checking or adding oil, be sure to insert the dipstick securely. Changing Oil 60A205 The handle of the A/T fluid dipstick is colored red for easy identification. Since special procedures, materials and tools are required to change the automatic transmission oil, it is recommended that you trust this job to your authorized SUZUKI dealer. WARNING Be sure to depress the brake pedal when moving the gearshift lever, or the vehicle can move suddenly. FULL HOT LOW HOT 65D109 6) Remove the dipstick, clean it and push it back in until the cap seats. Pull out the dipstick and read the fluid level. 7-21 79K21-03E Steering Wheel: 6 Clutch Pedal: 6 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Brakes WARNING Brake Fluid 65D477 WARNING 64J154 Check the brake fluid level by looking at the reservoir in the engine compartment. Check that the fluid level is between the “MAX” and “MIN” lines. If the brake fluid level is near the “MIN” line, fill it up to the “MAX” line with DOT3 brake fluid. Failure to follow the guidelines below can result in personal injury or serious damage to the brake system. • If the brake fluid in the reservoir drops below a certain level, the brake warning light on the instrument panel will come on (the engine must be running with the parking brake fully disengaged.) Should the light come on, immediately ask your SUZUKI dealer to inspect the brake system. • A rapid fluid loss indicates a leak in the brake system which should be inspected by your SUZUKI dealer immediately. • Brake fluid can harm your eyes and damage painted surfaces. Use caution when refilling the reservoir. (Continued) (Continued) • Do not use any fluid other than DOT3 brake fluid. Do not use reclaimed fluid or fluid that has been stored in old or open containers. It is essential that foreign particles and other liquids are kept out of the brake fluid reservoir. WARNING Brake fluid is harmful or fatal if swallowed, and harmful if it comes in contact with skin or eyes. If swallowed, do not induce vomiting. Immediately contact a poison control center or a physician. If brake fluid gets in eyes, flush eyes with water and seek medical attention. Wash thoroughly after handling. Solution can be poisonous to animals. Keep out of the reach of children and animals. CAUTION The brake fluid should be replaced according to the maintenance schedule. Have the brake fluid replaced by your SUZUKI dealer. 7-22 79K21-03E Tires: 6 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE NOTE: With disc brakes, the fluid level can be expected to gradually fall as the brake pads wear. measured above is less than the minimum distance required, have your vehicle inspected by your SUZUKI dealer. NOTE: When measuring the distance between the brake pedal and floor wall, push in the floor carpet as far as it goes and measure the distance between the carpet surface and the brake pedal. Brake Pedal 60G104 “a” WARNING Floor carpet 79K138 Pedal to floor carpet minimum distance “a” 80 mm (3.1 in.) With the engine running and the parking brake set, measure the distance between the brake pedal and floor carpet when the pedal is depressed with approximately 300 N (66 lbs, 30 kg) of force. The minimum distance required is as specified. Since your vehicle’s brake system is self-adjusting, there is no need for pedal adjustment. If the pedal to floor carpet distance as If you experience any of the following problems with your vehicle’s brake system, have the vehicle inspected immediately by your SUZUKI dealer. • Poor braking performance • Uneven braking (brakes not working uniformly on all wheels.) • Excessive pedal travel • Brake dragging • Excessive noise • (Except ABS equipped vehicle) Pedal pulsation (pedal pulsates when pressed for braking.) 7-23 79K21-03E Tires: 6 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Steering Wheel Parking Brake Lever EXAMPLE Power Steering (if equipped) EXAMPLE 200 N (44 lbs, 20 kg) (1) “c” “b” (2) 60A226 Ratchet tooth specification “b” 64J155 78K080 Steering wheel play “c” 5th – 7th 0 – 30 mm (0.0 – 1.2 in.) Check the parking brake for proper adjustment by counting the number of clicks made by the ratchet teeth as you slowly pull up on the parking brake lever to the point of full engagement. The parking brake lever should stop between the specified ratchet teeth and the rear wheels should be securely locked. If the parking brake is not properly adjusted or the brakes drag after the lever has been fully released, have the parking brake inspected and/or adjusted by your SUZUKI dealer. Check the play of the steering wheel by gently turning it from left to right and measuring the distance that it moves before you feel slight resistance. The play should be between the specified values. Check that the steering wheel turns easily and smoothly without rattling by turning it all the way to the right and to the left while driving very slowly in an open area. If the amount of free play is outside the specification or you find anything else to be wrong, an inspection must be performed by your SUZUKI dealer. (1) UPPER (2) LOWER Check the steering box case, vane pump and hose connections for leaks or damage. Power Steering Fluid Check the fluid level by looking at the reservoir in the engine compartment when the fluid is cold (about room temperature). Check that the fluid level is between the (1) and (2) lines. If the fluid level is near the (2) line, fill it up to the (1) line with an automatic transmission fluid equivalent to ATF DEXRON®-II (Esso JWS 2326) or DEXRON®-III. Do not overfill. 7-24 79K21-03E Tires: 6 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Tires For safe operation of your vehicle, it is important that the tires be the correct type and size, in good condition, and properly inflated. Be sure to follow the requirements and recommendations in this section. Tire Sidewall Labeling Useful information about a tire is molded into its sidewall. The example below shows a typical passenger car tire. Typical Passenger Car Tire Sidewall I C D J B H G A E F EXAMPLE 67D027 A. Tire Manufacturer The name of the tire manufacturer is shown here. B. Tire Name/Model The tire name or model is shown here. C. Tire Size The tire size code is a combination of letters and numbers used to define a particular tire’s width, height, aspect ratio, construction type, and service description. See the “Tire Size” explanation later in this section for more details. D. U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number The Department of Transportation (DOT) marking indicates that the tire is in compliance with the U.S. Department of Transportation Motor Vehicle Safety Standards. The letters and numbers following the DOT marking is the Tire Identification Number (TIN). The TIN identifies the tire manufacturer and plant, tire size, and date the tire was manufactured. E. Uniform Tire Quality Grading (UTQG) Tire manufacturers are required to grade tires based on three performance factors: treadwear, traction and temperature resistance. Refer to the “Uniform Tire Quality Grading” section for more details. F. Load Rating Load rating is the maximum weight a tire is designed to support in normal service. G. Max Inflation Pressure Max inflation pressure is the maximum inflation pressure a tire is designed for. H. Tire Ply Material These tire markings describe the type of cord and number of plies in the sidewall and under the tread. I. Load Index and Speed Rating The two- or three-digit number is the tire’s load index, the maximum load a tire can carry at the speed indicated by its speed symbol at the maximum inflation pressure. The higher the number is, the greater the load carrying capacity. The letter symbol denotes the speed at which a tire is designed to be driven for extended periods of time. (Ratings are listed below.) 7-25 79K21-03E Tires: 6 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Letter Rating Speed Rating Q 99 mph R 106 mph S 112 mph T 118 mph U 124 mph H 130 mph V 149 mph W 168 mph* Y 186 mph* *The letters ZR may be used on tires with a maximum speed capability over 149 mph and will always be used on tires with a maximum speed capability over 186 mph. J. M+S Marking This marking indicates the tire has some mud and snow capabilities and is designed for all-season use. Tire Size The following illustration shows an example of a typical passenger car tire size. EXAMPLE A B C D D. Construction Code This letter code is used to indicate the type of ply construction in the tire. The letter “R” means radial ply tire construction, the letter “D” means diagonal or bias ply construction, and the letter “B” means belted-bias ply construction. E. Rim Diameter This two-digit number is the wheel or rim diameter in inches. WARNING E 67D028 A. Tire Type This letter code indicates the primary intended use of the tire. The letter “P” identifies a tire primarily intended for use on a passenger vehicle. B. Tire Width This three-digit number indicates the tire section width in millimeters from sidewall to sidewall. C. Aspect Ratio This two-digit number represents the tire section height divided by the tire section width. Your SUZUKI is equipped with tires which are all the same type and size. This is important to ensure proper steering and handling of the vehicle. Never mix tires of different size or type on the four wheels of your vehicle. Mixing tires could cause you to lose control while driving which may lead to an accident. The size and type of tires used should be only those approved by SUZUKI Motor Corporation as standard or optional equipment for your vehicle. 7-26 79K21-03E Tires: 6 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Tire Inflation Pressure Tire inflation pressure should be checked when the tire is cold. “Cold tire inflation pressure” is the pressure in a tire that has been driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km) or has been standing for three hours or more. 54G307 The front, rear and spare tire pressure specifications for your vehicle are shown below and are listed on the Tire and Loading Information Label, which is located on the driver’s door lock pillar. The Tire and Loading Information Label contains the following information: • Seating Capacity • Maximum Allowed Combined Weight of Occupants and Cargo • Original Tire Size • Recommended Cold Tire Inflation Pressure of Original Tires Recommended Cold Tire Inflation Pressures Front Tires 230 kPa 33 psi Rear Tires 230 kPa 33 psi Spare 230 kPa 33 psi NOTE: The tire inflation pressure will change due to changes in atmospheric pressure, temperature or tire temperature when driving. To reduce the chance that the low tire pressure warning light will come on due to normal changes in temperature and atmospheric pressure, it is important to check and adjust the tire pressures when the tires are cold. Tires that appear to be at the specified pressure when checked after driving, when the tires are warm, could have pressure below the specification when the tires cool down. Also, tires that are inflated to the specified pressure in a warm garage may have pressure below the specification when the vehicle is driven outside in very cold temperature. If you adjust the tire pressure in a garage that is warmer than the outside temperature, you should add 1 psi to the recommended cold tire inflation pressure for every 10°F difference between garage temperature and outside temperature. Measuring air pressure Use the following steps to achieve proper tire inflation: 1) Identify the recommended tire pressure on the vehicle’s Tire and Loading Information Label or in the owner’s manual. 2) Remove the valve cap from the tire valve stem. 3) Using a reliable pressure gauge, measure the tire inflation pressure by pressing the tire gauge firmly onto the valve to get a pressure measurement. Remember that inflation pressures should be checked when the tires are “cold”, meaning before they have been driven one mile or after sitting for three hours or more allowing the tire to cool to ambient air temperature. 4) If the air pressure is too high, slowly release the air by pressing on the tire valve stem with the edge of the 7-27 79K21-03E Tires: 6 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE tire gauge until you reach the correct pressure. 5) If the air pressure is too low, fill the tire with air at a service station until it reaches the recommended pressure. 6) Make sure all tires have the same air pressure (unless the owner’s manual indicates otherwise). WARNING • Air pressures should be checked when the tires are cold or you may get inaccurate readings. • Check the inflation pressure from time to time while inflating the tire gradually, until the specified pressure is obtained. (Continued) WARNING (Continued) • Never underinflate or overinflate the tires. Underinflation can cause unusual handling characteristics or can cause the rim to slip on the tire bead, resulting in an accident or damage to the tire or rim. Underinflation can also cause tires to overheat, leading to tire failure. Overinflation can cause the tire to burst, resulting in personal injury. Overinflation can also cause unusual handling characteristics which may result in an accident. Tire Inspection Inspect your vehicle’s tires at least once a month by performing the following checks: 1) Measure the air pressure with a tire gauge. Adjust the pressure if necessary. Remember to check the spare tire, too. Refer to the “Measuring Air Pressure” section. 54G136 (1) Tread wear indicator (2) Indicator location mark 2) Check that the depth of the tread groove is more than 1.6 mm (0.06 in.). To help you check this, the tires have molded-in tread wear indicators in the grooves. When the indicators appear on the tread surface, the remaining depth of the tread is 7-28 79K21-03E Tires: 6 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE 1.6 mm (0.06 in.) or less and the tire should be replaced. 3) Check for abnormal wear, cracks and damage. Any tires with cracks or other damage should be replaced. If any tires show abnormal wear, have them inspected by your SUZUKI dealer. WARNING Hitting curbs and running over rocks can damage tires and affect wheel alignment. Be sure to have tires and wheel alignment checked periodically by your SUZUKI dealer. 4) Check for loose wheel nuts. 5) Check that there are no nails, stones or other objects sticking into the tires. WARNING Your SUZUKI is equipped with tires which are all the same type and size. This is important to ensure proper steering and handling of the vehicle. Never mix tires of different size or type on the four wheels of your vehicle. The size and type of tires used should be only those approved by SUZUKI Motor Corporation as standard or optional equipment for your vehicle. WARNING Replacing the wheels and tires equipped on your vehicle with certain combinations of aftermarket wheels and tires can significantly change the steering and handling characteristics of your vehicle. Oversized tires may also rub against the fender over bumps, causing vehicle damage or tire failure. Therefore, use only those wheel and tire combinations approved by SUZUKI Motor Corporation as standard or optional equipment for your vehicle. For information regarding the specified tires, refer to the Tire Information Label located on the driver’s side door pillar or the “SPECIFICATIONS” section. CAUTION Replacing the original tires with tires of a different size may result in false speedometer or odometer readings. Check with your SUZUKI dealer before purchasing replacement tires that differ in size from the original tires. 7-29 79K21-03E Tires: 6 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Uniform Tire Quality Grading The U.S. National Highway Traffic Safety Administration has developed a grading system for evaluating the performance of passenger car tires. The following information will help you understand the grading system, which applies to vehicles sold in the U.S. Consult your SUZUKI dealer or tire retailer for help in choosing the correct replacement tires for your vehicle. Quality grades can be found where applicable on the tire sidewall between tread shoulder and maximum section width. For example: Treadwear 200 Traction AA Temperature A DOT Quality Grades Treadwear Traction AA A B C Temperature A B C All Passenger Car Tires Must Conform To Federal Safety Requirements in Addition To These Grades Treadwear The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified government test course. For example, a tire graded 150 would wear one and one-half (1 1/2) times as well on the government course as a tire graded 100. The relative performance of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use, however and may depart significantly from the norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices and differences in road characteristics and climate. Traction – AA, A, B, C The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B and C. Those grades represent the tire’s ability to stop on wet pavement as measured under controlled conditions on specified government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction performance. WARNING The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on straightahead braking traction tests, and does not include acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning or peak traction characteristics. Temperature – A, B, C The temperature grades are A (the highest), B and C, representing the tire’s resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of performance which all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by law. WARNING The temperature grade for this tire is established for a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded. Excessive speed, underinflation or excessive loading, either separately or in combination, can cause heat buildup and possible tire failure. 7-30 79K21-03E Tires: 6 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Tire Rotation WARNING 4-tire rotation 65D459 To avoid uneven wear of your tires and to prolong their life, rotate the tires as illustrated. Tires should be rotated as recommended in the periodic maintenance schedule. After rotation, adjust front and rear tire pressures to the specification listed on your vehicle’s Tire and Loading Information Label. Rust or dirt on a wheel, or on the parts to which it is fastened, can make wheel nuts become loose after a time. The wheel could come off and cause an accident. When you change a wheel, remove any rust or dirt from places where the wheel attaches to the vehicle. In an emergency, you can use a cloth or a paper towel to do this; but be sure to use a scraper or wire brush later, if you need to, to get all the rust or dirt off. WARNING Vehicle equipped with P225/ 65R17 tires have a spare wheel and tire that are a different size than the wheels and tires on the vehicle. The spare wheel and tire on these vehicles are intended for temporary emergency use only. The wheel is painted yellow to remind you that the wheel and tire are for temporary use only. Continuous use of this spare can result in tire failure and loss of control. Always observe these precautions when using this spare: • Be aware that your vehicle will handle differently with this temporary spare. • Do not exceed 80 km/h (50 mph) speed. • Replace the temporary spare with a standard tire and wheel as soon as possible. • Do not operate your vehicle in “4H LOCK” or “4L LOCK” with this temporary spare. (Continued) 7-31 79K21-03E Battery: 9 Fuses: 7 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE WARNING (Continued) • Do not use tire chains on the spare tire. If you must use tire chains, rearrange the wheels so standard tires and wheels are fitted to the rear axle. • Replace the spare tire with a new one as soon as the tread wear indicator appears. • When replacing the spare tire, use a replacement tire with the exact same size and construction. Snow Tires Your vehicle is equipped with all-season tires which are designed for use in summer and most winter conditions. For improved traction in severe winter conditions, SUZUKI recommends mounting radial snow tires on all four wheels. Snow tires must be the same size as the standard tires. Also be sure to use the tires of the same type and brand on all four wheels of your vehicle. GLOSSARY OF TIRE TERMINOLOGY always face outward when mounted on a vehicle. Accessory Weight – the combined weight (in excess of those standard items which may be replaced) of automatic transmission, power steering, power brakes, power windows, power seats, radio, and heater, to the extent that these items are available as factory-installed equipment (whether installed or not). Maximum Inflation Pressure – the maximum cold inflation pressure a tire is designed to support in normal service. Cold Tire Inflation Pressure – the pressure in a tire that has been driven less than 1 mile or has been standing for three hours or more. Curb Weight – the weight of a motor vehicle with standard equipment including the maximum capacity of fuel, oil, and coolant, and, if so equipped, air conditioning and additional weight optional engine. Intended Outboard Sidewall – (1) the sidewall that contains a whitewall, bears white lettering or bears manufacturer, brand, and/or model name molding that is higher or deeper than the same molding on the other sidewall of the tire, or (2) the outward facing sidewall of an asymmetrical tire that has a particular side that must Maximum Loaded Vehicle Weight – the sum of curb weight, accessory weight, vehicle capacity weight (total load capacity), and production options weight. Normal Occupant Weight – 68 kilograms times the number of occupants specified in the second column of Table 1 (shown below). Occupant distribution – distribution of occupants in a vehicle as specified in the third column of Table 1 (shown below). Production Options Weight – the combined weight of those installed regular production options weighing over 2.3 kilograms in excess of those standard items which they replace, not previously considered in curb weight or accessory weight, including heavy duty brakes, ride levelers, roof rack, heavy duty battery, and special trim. 7-32 79K21-03E Fuses: 7 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Recommended Inflation Pressure – the cold tire inflation pressure recommended by a manufacturer. Rim – metal support for a tire or tire and tube assembly upon which the tire beads are seated. Vehicle Capacity Weight – the rated cargo and luggage load plus 68 kilograms (150 lbs) times the vehicle’s designated seating capacity. Vehicle Maximum Load on the Tire – the load on an individual tire that is determined by distributing to each axle its share of the maximum loaded vehicle weight and dividing by two. Vehicle Normal Load on the Tire – the load on an individual tire that is determined by distributing to each axle its share of the curb weight, accessory weight, and normal occupant weight (distributed in accordance with Table 1 shown below) and dividing by 2. TABLE 1 – Occupant Loading and Distribution For Vehicle Normal Load For Various Designated Seating Capacities Vehicle normal load, number of occupants Occupant distribution in a normally loaded vehicle 2 through 4 2 2 in front 5 through 10 3 2 in front, 1 in second seat Designated seating capacity, number of occupants Vehicle Loading Your vehicle was designed for specific load capacities. The load capacities of your vehicle are indicated by the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR), the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR, front and rear), and the total load capacity, the seating capacity, and the cargo load capacity. The GVWR and GAWR (front and rear) are listed on the Safety Certification Label which is located below the driver’s side door latch striker. The total load capacity and seating capacity are listed on the Tire and Loading Information Label which is located below the Safety Certification Label. The cargo load capacity can be determined as described below. Cargo Load Capacity – Maximum weight of cargo and luggage that the vehicle can safely carry. Cargo load capacity is the difference between the total load capacity of the vehicle and the total combined weight of all vehicle occupants. Refer to “Steps for Determining Correct Load Limit” for details on how to determine cargo load capacity. GVWR – Maximum permissible overall weight of the fully loaded vehicle (including all the occupants, accessories and cargo plus the trailer tongue weight if towing a trailer). GAWR – (Front and Rear) Maximum permissible weight on an individual axle. Seating Capacity – Maximum number of occupants the vehicle is designed to carry. NOTE: Even though the number of occupants is within the seating capacity, you still must make sure that you do not 7-33 79K21-03E Fuses: 7 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE exceed the total load capacity of the vehicle. Total Load Capacity – Maximum permissible weight a vehicle can carry including the weight of all the occupants, accessories, cargo, plus trailer tongue weight (if towing a trailer). The weight of any accessories already installed on your vehicle at the time of purchase, or that you or the dealer install after purchase, must be subtracted from the total load capacity to determine how much capacity remains available for occupants, cargo, and trailer tongue weight (if towing a trailer). Contact your dealer for further information. Actual weight of the loaded vehicle and actual loads at the front and rear axles can only be determined by weighing the vehicle using a vehicle scale. To measure the weight and load, try making your vehicle to a highway weighing station, shipping company or inspection station for trucks, etc. Compare these weights to the GVWR and GAWR (front and rear) listed on the Safety Certification Label. If the gross vehicle weight or the load on either axle exceeds these ratings, you must remove enough weight to bring the load down to the rated capacity. WARNING Never overload your vehicle. Overloading your vehicle can cause damage to your tires and lead to poor steering and braking which can result in an accident. The gross vehicle weight (sum of the weights of the loaded vehicle, driver and passengers) must never exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) listed on the Safety Certification Label. In addition, never distribute a load so that the weight on either the front or rear axle exceeds the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) listed on the Safety Certification Label. WARNING • Always distribute cargo evenly. • To avoid personal injury or damage to your vehicle, always secure cargo to prevent it from shifting if the vehicle moves suddenly. • Place heavier objects on the floor and as far forward in the cargo area as possible. Never pile cargo higher than the top of the seatbacks. Steps for Determining Correct Load Limit 1) Locate the statement “The combined weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs” on your vehicle’s placard. 2) Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will be riding in your vehicle. 3) Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX kg or XXX lbs. 4) The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage load capacity. For example, if the “XXX” amount equals 1400 lbs and there will be five 150 lb passen- 7-34 79K21-03E Fuses: 7 Headlight Aiming: Bulb Replacement: 7 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE gers in your vehicle, the amount of available cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lbs (1400 – 750 (5 x 150) = 650 lbs). 5) Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in Step 4. 6) If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your trailer will be transferred to your vehicle. Consult this manual to determine how this reduces the available cargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle. Vehicle Loading Example As an example, suppose that the Tire and Loading Information label on your vehicle indicates that your vehicle’s total load capacity is 950 lbs. If you were to drive your vehicle with one passenger, and the total combined weight of you and your passenger was 350 lbs, then the cargo and luggage capacity of your vehicle would be 600 lbs (950 – 350 = 600 lbs). If you later added 2 more passengers, having a combined weight of 325 lbs, the cargo and luggage capacity of your vehicle would be reduced from 600 lbs to 275 lbs (600 – 325 = 275 lbs). As you can see, as the number and combined weight of vehicle occupants increase, the vehicle’s cargo and luggage capacity decreases. Suppose again, that you were to take a trip in your vehicle with the same three passengers described above, and you decided to tow a trailer having a trailer tongue weight of 75 lbs. The cargo and luggage capacity would be reduced again, to 200 lbs (275 – 75 = 200 lbs). NOTE: Use of replacement tires with a higher load-carrying capacity than the original tires, or using a tire inflation pressure higher than the recommended tire inflation pressure, will not increase the GVWR or GAWR limit of your vehicle. Determining Compatibility of Tire and Vehicle Load Limits The tires on your vehicle, when they are inflated to the recommended tire inflation pressure, have a load-carrying capacity that is greater than the load that will be on the tires when the vehicle is at its GVWR or GAWR limit. Never use replacement tires that have a load-carrying capacity less than the original tires on your vehicle. Tire loadcarrying capacity information is molded into the tire sidewall typically shown as “Max. Load”. Use of replacement tires with a lower load-carrying capacity than the original tires, or failure to keep the tires inflated to recommended tire pressure, may reduce the GVWR or GAWR limit of your vehicle. 7-35 79K21-03E Bulb Replacement: 7 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Battery WARNING To avoid harm to yourself or damage to your vehicle or battery, follow the jump starting instructions in the “EMERGENCY SERVICE” section of this manual if it is necessary to jump start your vehicle. EXAMPLE WARNING 60A269 WARNING Batteries produce flammable hydrogen gas. Keep flames and sparks away from the battery or an explosion may occur. Never smoke when working near the battery. WARNING When checking or servicing the battery, disconnect the negative cable. Be careful not to cause a short circuit by allowing metal objects to contact the battery posts and the vehicle at the same time. Battery posts, terminals and related accessories contain lead and lead compounds. Wash hands after handling. Fuses Your vehicle has three types of fuses, as described below: Main Fuse – The main fuse takes current directly from the battery. Primary Fuses – These fuses are between the main fuse and individual fuses, and are for electrical load groups. Individual Fuses – These fuses are for individual electrical circuits. For details on protected circuits, refer to the “FUSES AND PROTECTED CIRCUITS” section in this manual. Your vehicle is equipped with a battery that requires infrequent maintenance. You will never have to add water. You should, however, periodically check the battery, battery terminals and battery hold-down bracket for corrosion. Remove corrosion using a stiff brush and ammonia mixed with water, or baking soda mixed with water. After removing corrosion, rinse with clean water. The test indicator on the top of the battery provides information on the condition of the battery. If your vehicle is not going to be driven for a month or longer, disconnect the cable from the negative terminal of the battery to help prevent discharge. 7-36 79K21-03E Bulb Replacement: 7 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Main Fuse Box 64J157 Main Fuse / Primary Fuse (1) 15A CPRSR A/C compressor fuse (2) 20A O2 HTR O2 sensor heater fuse (3) 15A THR MOT Throttle motor fuse (4) 20A AT Automatic transmission fuse (5) 25A RR DEF Rear defogger fuse (6) 15A HORN Horn fuse (7) 20A FR FOG Front fog light fuse (8) 20A MRR HTR Mirror heater fuse (9) 40A FR BLW (10) 30A ABS 2 (11) 50A ABS 1 ABS actuator fuse (12) 20A FI Main fuse PRIMARY FUSE (13) Blank 60A LAMP Head light, Accessory, Dome light, Sunroof, Hazard light, Door lock, Rear fog light, Stop lamp, Tail light 50A IGN 2 Wiper/Washer, Power window, Seat heater 40A 4WD 4WD actuator 30A RDTR 1 Radiator fan 30A RDTR 2 Radiator fan – – (14) 10A H/L L Head light high beam fuse, left (15) 10A H/L R Head light high beam fuse, right (16) 10A H/L Head light fuse (17) 40A ST Starter motor fuse (18) 40A IGN Ignition fuse (19) 15A H/L LO L Head light low beam fuse, left (20) 15A H/L LO R Head light low beam fuse, right The main fuse, primary fuses and some of the individual fuses are located in the engine compartment. If the main fuse blows, no electrical component will function. If a primary fuse blows, no electrical component in the corresponding load group will function. When replacing the main fuse or a primary fuse, use a genuine SUZUKI replacement. INDIVIDUAL FUSE WARNING If a fuse in the main fuse box blows, be sure to have your vehicle inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer. Always use a genuine SUZUKI replacement. Never use a substitute such as a wire even for a temporary fix, or extensive electrical damage and a fire can result. Front blower motor fuse ABS actuator fuse 7-37 79K21-03E Bulb Replacement: 7 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Fuse under the Dash Board Fuse box 64J192 (J) (I) (V) (U) (T) (H) (G) (F) (E) (D) (C) (B) (A) SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE USE THE DESIGNATED FUSES AND RELAYS ONLY (K) (S) (R) (Q) (P) (O) (N) (M) (L) (X) (W) 79K057 ACC Radio, Remote door mirror fuse 10A METER Meter fuse 15A IG COIL Ignition coil fuse – Blank P/W Power window fuse (A) 10A DOME Dome lamp fuse (T) (B) 10A STOP Stop lamp fuse (U) (C) – – Blank (V) (W) – (X) 30A (D) 15A ACC 3 Accessory socket fuse (E) 10A CRUISE Cruise control fuse (F) 15A ACC 2 Cigar or Accessory socket fuse (G) 20A WIP Wiper fuse (H) 15A IG2 SIG Ignition signal & Seat heater fuse (I) 10A BACK Back lamp fuse (J) 10A ABS/ESP ABS or ESP controller fuse (K) 10A A/B Air bag fuse (L) 15A RADIO Radio fuse (M) 15A HAZ Hazard light fuse (N) 7.5A ST SIG Starter signal fuse (O) 10A Engine control module fuse ECM (P) 25A S/R Sun roof motor fuse (Q) 25A B/U Buck up fuse (R) 10A TAIL Tail light fuse (S) 20A D/L Door lock actuator fuse 15A 65D045 The fuse box is located under the driver’s side of the dashboard. To remove a fuse, use the fuse puller provided in the fuse box. 7-38 79K21-03E Bulb Replacement: 7 Wiper Blades: 3 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Headlight Aiming WARNING Since special procedures are required, we recommend you take your vehicle to your SUZUKI dealer for headlight alignment. Always be sure to replace a blown fuse with a fuse of the correct amperage. Never use a substitute such as aluminum foil or wire to replace a blown fuse. If you replace a fuse and the new one blows in a short period of time, you may have a major electrical problem. Have your vehicle inspected immediately by your SUZUKI dealer. OK BLOWN NOTE: Make sure that the fuse box cover always carries spare fuses. 60A243 OK BLOWN 81A283 7-39 79K21-03E Wiper Blades: 3 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Bulb Replacement Center Interior Light (if equipped) Rear Interior Light (if equipped) WARNING • Light bulbs can be hot enough to burn your finger right after being turned off. This is true especially for halogen headlight bulbs. Replace the bulbs after they become cool enough. • The headlight bulbs are filled with pressurized halogen gas. They can burst and injure you if they are hit or dropped. Handle them carefully. CAUTION The oils from your skin may cause a halogen bulb to overheat and burst when the lights are on. Grasp a new bulb with a clean cloth. CAUTION 64J159 64J160 Pull down the lens by using a flat blade screwdriver covered with a soft cloth as shown. To install it, simply push it back in. Pull down the lens by using a flat blade screwdriver covered with a soft cloth as shown. To install it, simply push it back in. The bulb can be removed by simply pulling it out. When replacing the bulb, make sure that the contact springs are holding the bulb securely. The bulb can be removed by simply pulling it out. Frequent replacement of a bulb indicates the need for an inspection of the electrical system. This should be carried out by your SUZUKI dealer. NOTE: If it is difficult to replace headlight bulbs or clearance light bulbs due to under-hood components trust this job to your dealer. 7-40 79K21-03E Wiper Blades: 3 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Spot Light (if equipped) Headlights Pull down the lens by using a flat blade screwdriver covered with a soft cloth as shown. Low beam (Halogen headlamp) Open the engine hood. Disconnect the coupler. Remove the sealing rubber. Push the retaining spring forward and unhook it. Then remove the bulb. Install a new bulb in the reverse order of removal. Ceiling-mount type (if equipped) High beam 79K089 79K061 Remove the bulb holder by turning it counterclockwise. Pull out the bulb. 78F072 Open the engine hood. Disconnect the coupler while pushing the lock release. Turn the bulb holder counterclockwise to remove it. 66J108 7-41 79K21-03E Wiper Blades: 3 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Front Fog Light (1) (4) (3) (2) 79K090 1) Insert a flat blade screwdriver into the hole (2) and remove the clips (1) by twist the driver as shown in the illustration. 2) Remove the bolt (3) by a Phillips-head screwdriver. 65J357 78F072 3) Remove the clip (4) with the same way as No.1). 4) Open the fender cover. Disconnect the coupler with pushing the lock release. Turn the bulb holder counterclockwise and remove it. 7-42 79K21-03E Air Conditioning System: 4 INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Other General Lights Position/Turn signal light Bulb Bulb holder EXAMPLE EXAMPLE (2) (1) (1) (3) (2) (4) (1) (2) 54G124 54G123 (1) Removal (2) Installation To remove a bulb holder from a light housing, turn the holder counterclockwise and pull it out. To install the holder, push the holder in and turn it clockwise. (3) Removal (4) Installation There are two types of bulb, “Full glass type” (1) and “Glass/metal type” (2). To remove and install a full glass type bulb (1), simply pull out or push in the bulb. 64J163 To replace the bulb of position/turn signal light, follow the procedure for the bulb replacement of the “Front Fog Light”. Rear combination light EXAMPLE To remove a glass metal type bulb (2) from a bulb holder, push in the bulb and turn it counterclockwise. To install a new bulb, push it in and turn it clockwise. You can access the individual bulb or bulb holders as follows. 78K124 7-43 79K21-03E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Door illumination light License plate light High-mount stop light (if equipped) The followings are the general procedure for replace the bulbs of high-mount stop light. Since special procedures are required, we recommend you take your vehicle to your SUZUKI dealer for the bulbs of high-mount stop light replacement. (1) (1) (2) 65J345 Turn the cover (1) counterclockwise to remove it. 64J165 Luggage compartment light NOTE: When reinstalling, put the packing (2) between the cover and bulb holder. 64J181 To remove a high-mounted stop light housing the following procedure: 1) Open the tailgate, and remove the trim (1) as shown in the illustration. 64J166 7-44 79K21-03E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE (2) 64J182 64J183 64J184 2) Release the claws of the light housing by the flat head etc. through the service holes as shown in the illustration. 3) Close the tailgate. Remove a highmounted stop light housing (2) from the tailgate. 4) Remove the each bulb. 5) Replace the bulbs. To install a high-mounted stop light housing in the reverse order of removal. 7-45 79K21-03E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Wiper Blades For windshield wipers: 52D102 54G129 If the wiper blades become brittle or damaged, or make streaks when wiping, replace the wiper blades. 70G119 1) Hold the wiper arm away from the window. 2) Squeeze lock lever (1) towards wiper arm (2) and remove the wiper frame from the arm as shown. To install new wiper blades, follow the procedures below. CAUTION To avoid scratching or breaking the window, do not let the wiper arm strike the window while replacing the wiper blade. NOTE: Some wiper blades may be different from the ones described here depending on vehicle specifications. If so, consult your SUZUKI dealer for proper replacement method. 7-46 79K21-03E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Installation 60A260 3) Pull the locked end of the wiper blade firmly to unlock the blade and slide the blade out as shown. 52D124 (3) Retainer 4) If the new blade is provided without the two metal retainers, move them from the old blade to the new one. 52D125 (4) Locked end 5) Install the new blade in the reverse order of removal, with the locked end positioned toward the wiper arm. Make sure the blade is properly retained by all the hooks. Grasp the blade near the locked end and pull in the direction of the arrows to lock the end into place. 6) Reinstall wiper frame to arm, making sure that the lock lever is snapped securely into the arm. 7-47 79K21-03E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE For rear wipers: 65D151 NOTE: Do not flex the wiper blade frame end more than necessary. If you do, it can break off. 54G135 (1) Retainer 4) If the new blade is provided without the two metal retainers, move them from the old blade to the new one. 5) Install the new blade in the reverse order of removal. Make sure the blade is properly retained by all the hooks. 6) Reinstall wiper frame to arm in the reverse order of removal. 80G146 1) Hold the wiper arm away from the window. 2) Remove the wiper frame from the arm as shown. 3) Slide the blade out as shown. 7-48 79K21-03E INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE Windshield Washer Fluid fluid tank. If the fluid level is near empty, refill it. Front and rear (if equipped) Use a good quality windshield washer fluid, diluted with water as necessary. EXAMPLE WARNING Do not use “anti-freeze” solution in the windshield washer reservoir. This can severely impair visibility when sprayed on the windshield, and also damage your vehicle’s paint. Air Conditioning System If you do not use the air conditioner for a long period, such as during winter, it may not give the best performance when you start using it again. To help maintain optimum performance and durability of your air conditioner, it needs to be run periodically. Operate the air conditioner at least once a month for one minute with the engine idling. This circulates the refrigerant and oil and helps protect the internal components. CAUTION (or opposite side) 66J008 Damage may result if the washer motor is operated with no fluid in the washer tank. 66J116 Check that there is washer fluid in the tank by looking at the washer fluid level gauge which is attached to the cap of the washer 7-49 79K21-03E EMERGENCY SERVICE EMERGENCY SERVICE Tire Changing Tool ............................................................. 8-1 Spare Tire Nut Lock (if equipped) ...................................... 8-1 Jacking Instructions ........................................................... 8-2 Changing Wheels ................................................................ 8-3 Jump Starting Instructions ................................................ 8-7 Towing a Disabled Vehicle ................................................. 8-8 If the Starter Does Not Operate .......................................... 8-8 If the Engine is Flooded ...................................................... 8-9 If the Engine Overheats ...................................................... 8-9 8 60G411 79K21-03E Jacking Instructions: 5 EMERGENCY SERVICE Tire Changing Tool WARNING After using the tire changing tools, be sure to stow them securely, or they could be thrown about in an accident, causing injury. Spare Tire Nut Lock (if equipped) To UNLOCK To LOCK 64J124 The jack, wheel brace and jack handle are stowed in the rear left corner of the luggage compartment. Remove the cover to access the tools. To remove the jack, turn its shaft counterclockwise and pull the jack out of the storage bracket. To stow the jack, place it in the storage bracket and turn the shaft clockwise until the jack is securely held in place. 64J172 A nut lock is used for the spare tire. To unlock the spare tire nut, insert the ignition key into the lock as far as the key will go and remove the lock with the key in. To lock the spare tire nut, put the lock on the nut and push the lock in. WARNING The tire changing tools should be used only to change wheels. It is important to read the jacking instructions in this section before attempting to use the jack. 8-1 79K21-03E Jacking Instructions: 5 EMERGENCY SERVICE Jacking Instructions jack-head groove fits around the jacking point beneath the vehicle body. (3) (1) (2) 64J194 75F062 1) Place the vehicle on level, hard ground. 2) Set the parking brake firmly and shift into “P” (Park) if your vehicle has an automatic transmission, or shift into “R” (Reverse) if your vehicle has a manual transmission. 3) Turn on the hazard warning flasher if your vehicle is near traffic. 4) Block the front and rear of the wheel diagonally opposite of the wheel being lifted. 5) Place the spare wheel near the wheel being lifted as shown in the illustration in case that the jack slips. 79K059 (2) Jack handle (3) Wheel brace 7) Continue to raise the jack slowly and smoothly until the tire clears the ground. Do not raise the vehicle more than necessary. (1) 79K058 (1) Jacking point 6) Position the jack as shown in the illustration and raise the jack by turning the 8-2 79K21-03E Jump Starting Instructions: 7 EMERGENCY SERVICE WARNING • Use the jack only to change wheels on level, hard ground. • Never jack up the vehicle on an inclined surface. • Never raise the vehicle with the jack in a location other than the designated jacking point near the wheel to be changed. • Make sure that the jack is raised at least 51 mm (2 inches) before it contacts the flange. Use of the jack when it is within 51 mm (2 inches) of being fully collapsed may result in failure of the jack. • Never get under the vehicle when it is supported by the jack. • Never run the engine when the vehicle is supported by the jack and never allow passengers to remain in the vehicle. Changing Wheels To change a wheel, use the following procedure: To remove the spare wheel: 1) Remove the jack and tools from the vehicle. (2) (A) (1) 78K151 3) Unhook the under claws (1) and the middle claws (2) one by one. (3) 78K150 2) Release the lock at the underneath of the spare wheel full cover (A) as shown in the illustration. 78K152 4) Unhook the upper claws (3), and remove the wheel full cover. 8-3 79K21-03E Jump Starting Instructions: 7 Towing a Disabled Vehicle: 6 If the Starter Does Not Operate: 2, 9 EMERGENCY SERVICE NOTE: Remove the full wheel cover from the bottom part to the upper part. Otherwise, the claws may be broken. facing the wheel. Tighten each nut snugly by hand until the wheel is securely seated on the hub. (B) (Half cover type) 78K153 (4) (5) 78K060 NOTE: If your vehicle is equipped with the half cover, remove the center bolt (4), then remove the outer cover (5) of the spare wheel half cover. 5) Pull out the lock cover (B) fitted on the lock nut of the spare wheel while inserting the key full into the key hole of the lock cover (B). 6) Remove the lock nut and wheel nuts of the spare wheel, then remove the spare wheel with both hands. To change the wheel: 1) Loosen, but do not remove the wheel nuts. 2) Jack up the vehicle (follow the jacking instructions in this section) 3) Remove the wheel nuts and wheel. 4) Before installing the new wheel, clean any mud or dirt off from the surface of the wheel and hub with a clean cloth. Clean the hub carefully; it may be hot from driving. 5) Install the new wheel and replace the wheel nuts with their cone shaped end EXAMPLE 81A057 Tightening torque for wheel nut 100 Nm (10.0 kg-m, 72.3 lb-ft) 6) Lower the jack and fully tighten the nuts in a crisscross fashion with a wrench as shown in the illustration. 8-4 79K21-03E If the Engine is Flooded: 2, 9 If the Engine Overheats: 2, 9 EMERGENCY SERVICE WARNING Use genuine wheel nuts and tighten them to the specified torque as soon as possible after changing wheels. Incorrect wheel nuts or improperly tightened wheel nuts may come loose or fall off, which can result in an accident. If you do not have a torque wrench, have the wheel nut torque checked by an authorized SUZUKI dealer. To install the wheel: (1) (2) (4) (5) 78K155 78K063 2) Put the spare tire nut lock (4) on the spare tire nut and push the lock in. 3) Install the wheel cover in the reverse order to removal. NOTE: When you install the spare tire full cover, make sure the position of the upper claws marked on outside (5) and holes, then hook them first. (3) 78K154 1) Install the wheel with both hands to the spare tire carrier (1) as shown in the illustration. Then tighten the wheel nuts (2) and spare tire nut (3). 8-5 79K21-03E If the Engine Overheats: 2, 9 If You Cannot Shift Automatic Transmission Gearshift Lever Out of “P” (PARK): 2, 9 EMERGENCY SERVICE WARNING (3) (4) 64J196 CAUTION To avoid the removal of the spare wheel full cover while driving, be sure to fit the claws (3) of the outer cover of the spare wheel full cover to each hole (4) of the inner cover of the spare wheel full cover. Vehicle equipped with P225/65R17 tires have a spare wheel and tire that are a different size than the wheels and tires on the vehicle. The spare wheel and tire on these vehicles are intended for temporary emergency use only. The wheel is painted yellow to remind you that the wheel and tire are for temporary use only. Continuous use of this spare can result in tire failure and loss of control. Always observe these precautions when using this spare: • Be aware that your vehicle will handle differently with this temporary spare. • Do not exceed 80 km/h (50 mph) speed. • Replace the temporary spare with a standard tire and wheel as soon as possible. • Do not operate your vehicle in “4H LOCK” or “4L LOCK” with this temporary spare. • Do not use tire chains on the spare tire. If you must use tire chains, rearrange the wheels so standard tires and wheels are fitted to the rear axle. (Continued) WARNING (Continued) • Replace the spare tire with a new one as soon as the tread wear indicator appears. • When replacing the spare tire, use a replacement tire with the exact same size and construction. Snow Tires Your vehicle is equipped with all-season tires which are designed for use in summer and most winter conditions. For improved traction in severe winter conditions, SUZUKI recommends mounting radial snow tires on all four wheels. Snow tires must be the same size as the standard tires. Also be sure to use the tires of the same type and brand on all four wheels of your vehicle. 8-6 79K21-03E EMERGENCY SERVICE Jump Starting Instructions WARNING • Never attempt to jump start your vehicle if the battery appears to be frozen. Batteries in this condition may explode or rupture if jump starting is attempted. • When making jumper cable connections, be certain that your hands and the jumper cables remain clear from pulleys, belts or fans. • Batteries produce flammable hydrogen gas. Keep flames and sparks away from the battery or an explosion may occur. Never smoke when working near the battery. • If the booster battery you use for jump starting is installed in another vehicle, make sure the two vehicles are not touching each other. • If your battery discharges repeatedly, for no apparent reason, have your vehicle inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer. • To avoid harm to yourself or damage to your vehicle or battery, follow the jump starting instructions below precisely and in order. If you are in doubt, call for qualified road service. CAUTION Your vehicle should not be started by pushing or towing. This starting method could result in permanent damage to the catalytic converter. Use jumper cables to start a vehicle with a weak or run-down battery. When jump starting your vehicle, use the following procedure: 2) Turn off all vehicle accessories, except those necessary for safety reasons (for example, headlights or hazard lights). EXAMPLE Engine Hook Discharged Battery 12V BATTERY Charged Battery 60A270 60A269 1) Use only a 12-volt battery to jump start your vehicle. Position the good 12-volt battery close to your vehicle so that the jumper cables will reach both batteries. When using a battery installed on another vehicle, DO NOT LET THE VEHICLES TOUCH. Set the parking brakes fully on both vehicles. EXAMPLE 52D129 8-7 79K21-03E EMERGENCY SERVICE 3) Make jumper cable connections as follows: 1. Connect one end of the first jumper cable to the positive (+) terminal of the discharged battery (1). 2. Connect the other end to the positive (+) terminal of the booster battery (2). 3. Connect one end of the second jumper cable to the negative (–) terminal of the booster battery (2). 4. Make the final connection to an unpainted, heavy metal part (i.e. engine hook (3)) of the engine of the vehicle with the discharged battery (1). WARNING Never connect the jumper cable directly to the negative (–) terminal of the discharged battery, or an explosion may occur. 4) If the booster battery you are using is installed on another vehicle, start the engine of the vehicle with the booster battery. Run the engine at moderate speed. 5) Start the engine of the vehicle with the discharged battery. 6) Remove the jumper cables in the exact reverse order in which you connected them. Towing a Disabled Vehicle Emergency Towing If your vehicle is disabled, it may be towed by a tow truck using one of the following methods: 1) Tow the vehicle with two wheels lifted by the tow truck and the other two wheels on a towing dolly. 2) Use the appropriate towing method specified for your vehicle in the “Towing Your Vehicle (recreational towing)” section, but with the wheels lifted by the tow truck instead of on a towing dolly. Be sure to carefully follow the specific instructions provided in the “Towing Your Vehicle (recreational towing)” section. If the Starter Does Not Operate 1) Try turning the ignition switch to the “START” position with the headlights turned on to determine the battery condition. If the headlights go excessively dim or go off, it usually means that either the battery has run down or battery terminal contact is poor. Recharge the battery or correct battery terminal contact if necessary. 2) If the headlights remain bright, check the fuses. If the reason for failure of the starter is not obvious, there may be a major electrical problem. Have the vehicle inspected by your authorized SUZUKI dealer. CAUTION If vehicle damage (such as steering or drivetrain damage, inability to operate free axle mechanism, etc.) prevent normal use of the towing procedures for your vehicle described in the “Towing Your Vehicle (recreational towing)” section, have your vehicle towed with two wheels lifted by the tow truck and the other two wheels on a towing dolly. 8-8 79K21-03E EMERGENCY SERVICE If the Engine is Flooded If the Engine Overheats If the engine is flooded with gasoline, it may be hard to start. If this happens, press the accelerator pedal all the way to the floor and hold it there while cranking the engine. (Do not operate the starter motor for more than 15 seconds). The engine could overheat temporarily under severe driving conditions. If the engine coolant temperature gauge indicates overheating during driving: 1) Turn off the air conditioner, if equipped. 2) Take the vehicle to a safe place and park. 3) Let the engine run at normal idle speed for a few minutes until the indicator is within the normal, acceptable temperature range shown by the white band between “H” and “C”. WARNING If you see or hear escaping steam, stop the vehicle in a safe place and immediately turn off the engine to let it cool. Do not open the hood when steam is present. When the steam can no longer be seen or heard, open the hood to see if the coolant is still boiling. If it is, you must wait until it stops boiling before you proceed. Also, be careful not to touch hot engine parts (radiator, water hoses, engine etc.). If the temperature indication does not come down to within the normal, acceptable range: 1) Turn off the engine and check that the water pump belt and pulleys are not damaged or slipping. If any abnormality is found, correct it. 2) Check the coolant level in the reservoir. If it is found to be lower than the “LOW” line, look for leaks at the radiator, water pump and radiator and heater hoses. If you locate any leaks that may have caused the overheating, do not run the engine until these problems have been corrected. 3) If you do not find a leak, carefully add coolant to the reservoir and then the radiator, if necessary. (Refer to “Engine Coolant” in the “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section.) 8-9 79K21-03E EMERGENCY SERVICE 66J191 WARNING • It is hazardous to remove the radiator cap when the water temperature is high, because scalding fluid and steam may be blown out under pressure. The cap should only be taken off when the coolant temperature has lowered. • To prevent personal injury, keep hands, tools and clothing away from the engine cooling fan and airconditioner fan (if equipped). These electric fans can automatically turn on without warning. 8-10 79K21-03E EMERGENCY SERVICE MEMO 8-11 79K21-03E APPEARANCE CARE APPEARANCE CARE Corrosion Prevention ......................................................... 9-1 Vehicle Cleaning ................................................................. 9-3 60G412 9 79K21-03E Corrosion Prevention: 5 APPEARANCE CARE Corrosion Prevention It is important to take good care of your vehicle to protect it from corrosion. vehicle which are not well ventilated to permit quick drying. Listed below are instructions for how to maintain your vehicle to prevent corrosion. Please read and follow these instructions carefully. Wash your vehicle immediately after using it off-road. For washing instructions, refer to the “Vehicle Cleaning” section. Important Information About Corrosion Common causes of corrosion 1) Accumulation of road salt, dirt, moisture or chemicals in hard-to-reach areas of the vehicle underbody or frame. 2) Chipping, scratches and any damage to treated or painted metal surfaces resulting from minor accidents or impact from stones and gravel. Environmental conditions which accelerate corrosion 1) Road salt, dust control chemicals, sea air or industrial pollution will all accelerate the corrosion of metal. 2) High humidity will increase the rate of corrosion particularly when the temperature range is just above the freezing point. 3) Moisture in certain areas of a vehicle for an extended period of time may promote corrosion even though other body sections may be completely dry. 4) High temperatures will cause an accelerated rate of corrosion to parts of the If you frequently drive on salted roads, your vehicle should be washed at least once a month during the winter. If you live near the ocean, your vehicle should be washed at least once a month throughout the year. 52D151 This information illustrates the necessity of keeping your vehicle (particularly the underbody) as clean and dry as possible. It is equally important to repair any damage to the paint or protective coatings as soon as possible. How to Help Prevent Corrosion Wash your vehicle frequently The best way to preserve the finish on your vehicle and to help avoid corrosion is to keep it clean with frequent washing. Wash your vehicle at least once during the winter and once immediately after the winter. Keep your vehicle, particularly the underside, as clean and dry as possible. Remove foreign material deposits Foreign material such as salts, chemicals, road oil or tar, tree sap, bird droppings and industrial fall-out may damage the finish of your vehicle if it is left on painted surfaces. Remove these types of deposits as quickly as possible. If these deposits are difficult to wash off, an additional cleaner may be required. Be sure that any cleaner you use is not harmful to painted surfaces and is specifically intended for your purposes. Follow the manufacturer’s directions when using these special cleaners. WARNING Foreign material can lodge between the fuel tank of your vehicle and the skid plate which covers it. You should periodically clean out any foreign material which has accumulated in this area, since it could create a fire hazard. 9-1 79K21-03E Corrosion Prevention: 5 APPEARANCE CARE Repair finish damage Carefully examine your vehicle for damage to the painted surfaces, especially if it is used off-road. Should you find any chips or scratches in the paint, touch them up immediately to prevent corrosion from starting. If the chips or scratches have gone through to the bare metal, have a qualified body shop make the repair. Keep passenger and cargo compartments clean Moisture, dirt or mud can accumulate under the floor mats and may cause corrosion. Occasionally, check under these mats to ensure that this area is clean and dry. More frequent checks are necessary if the vehicle is used off road or in wet weather. Certain cargo such as chemicals, fertilizers, cleaners, salts, etc. are extremely corrosive by nature. These products should be transported in sealed containers. If a spill or leak does occur, clean and dry the area immediately. Use mud and gravel shields The use of mud and gravel shields will help protect your vehicle, especially if you frequently drive on gravel or salted roads. Full-size shields, which extend as close to the road as is practical, are the best. The fittings for such shields should also be corrosion resistant. Please check with your authorized SUZUKI dealer for information on these shields. Cover your vehicle Store your vehicle in a dry, well-ventilated area Do not park your vehicle in a damp, poorly ventilated area. If you often wash your vehicle in the garage or if you frequently drive it in when wet, your garage may be damp. The high humidity in the garage may cause or accelerate corrosion. A wet vehicle may corrode even in a heated garage if the ventilation is poor. WARNING Do not apply additional undercoating or rust preventive coating on or around exhaust system components such as the catalytic converter, exhaust pipes, etc. A fire could be started if the undercoating substance becomes overheated. 50G203 If you cannot regularly park your vehicle in a garage, we recommend you use a vehicle cover. Years of exposure to midday sun can cause the colors in paint, plastic parts and fabrics to fade. Covering your vehicle with a high-quality, “breathable” vehicle cover can help protect the finish from the harmful UV rays in sunlight, and can reduce the amount of dust and air pollution reaching the surface. Your SUZUKI dealer can help you select the right cover for your vehicle. 9-2 79K21-03E Vehicle Cleaning: 5 APPEARANCE CARE Vehicle Cleaning damp cloth to remove dirt and the soap solution. If some dirt still remains on the surface, repeat this procedure. Fabric upholstery Remove loose dirt with a vacuum cleaner. Using a mild soap solution, rub stained areas with a clean damp cloth. To remove soap, rub the areas again with a cloth dampened with water. Repeat this until the stain is removed, or use a commercial fabric cleaner for tougher stains. If you use a fabric cleaner, carefully follow the manufacturer’s instructions and precautions. 76G044S WARNING When cleaning the interior or exterior of the vehicle, NEVER USE flammable solvents such lacquer thinners, gasoline, benzene or cleaning materials such as bleaches and strong household detergents. The materials could cause personal injury or damage to the vehicle. Cleaning Interior Vinyl upholstery Prepare a solution of soap or mild detergent mixed with warm water. Apply the solution to the vinyl with a sponge or soft cloth and let it soak for a few minutes to loosen dirt. Rub the surface with a clean, Leather upholstery Remove loose dirt with a vacuum cleaner. Using a mild soap or saddle soap solution, wipe dirt off with a clean damp soft cloth. To remove soap, wipe the areas again with a soft cloth dampened with water. Wipe the areas dry with a soft dry cloth. Repeat this until the dirt or stain is removed, or use a commercial leather cleaner for tougher dirt or stains. If you use a leather cleaner, carefully follow the manufacture’s instructions and precautions. Do not use solvent type cleaners or abrasive cleaners. Vinyl floor mats Ordinary dirt can be removed from vinyl with water or mild soap. Use a brush to help loosen dirt. After dirt is loosened, rinse the mat thoroughly with water and dry it in the shade. Carpets Remove dirt and soil as much as possible with a vacuum cleaner. Using a mild soap solution, rub stained areas with a clean damp cloth. To remove soap, rub the areas again with a cloth dampened with water. Repeat this until the stain is removed, or use a commercial carpet cleaner for tougher stains. If you use a carpet cleaner, carefully follow the manufacturer’s instructions and precautions. Instrument panel and console NOTE: Wipe up spills containing chemicals, alcohol, etc., immediately with a soft, damp cloth. Use a mild soap solution if necessary. Do not use cleaners or polishes containing strong solvents or acidic solutions. These chemicals may stain and discolor the instrument panel and console. Seat belts Clean seat belts with a mild soap and water. Do not use bleach or dye on the belts. They may weaken the fabric in the belts. 9-3 79K21-03E Vehicle Cleaning: 5 APPEARANCE CARE Cleaning the Exterior CAUTION CAUTION It is important that your vehicle be kept clean and free from dirt. Failure to keep your vehicle clean may result in fading of the paint or corrosion to various parts of the vehicle body. Washing WARNING When washing the vehicle: • Avoid directing steam or hot water of more than 80°C (176°F) on plastic parts. • To avoid damaging engine components, do not use pressurized water in the engine compartment. • Do not pour the water on the battery. And wipe off the water which remains on the battery. The water entering inside the battery possibly causes fluid leakage. • Never attempt to wash and wax your vehicle with the engine running. • When cleaning the underside of the body and fender, where there may be sharp-edged parts, you should wear gloves and a long-sleeved shirt to protect your hands and arms from being cut. • After washing your vehicle, carefully test the brakes before driving to make sure they have maintained their normal effectiveness. 2) Rinse the body to loosen the dirt. Remove dirt and mud from the body exterior with running water. You may use a soft sponge or brush. Do not use hard materials which can scratch the paint or plastic. Remember that the headlight covers or lenses are made of plastic in many cases. When washing the vehicle, follow the instructions below: To avoid damage to the paint or plastic surface, do not wipe the dirt off without ample water. Be sure to follow above procedure. 1) Flush the underside of body and wheel housings with pressurized water to remove mud and debris. Use plenty of water. CAUTION cloth should be frequently soaked in the soap solution. CAUTION When using a commercial car wash product, observe the cautions specified by the manufacturer. Never use strong household detergents or soaps. 4) Once the dirt has been completely removed, rinse off the detergent with running water. 5) After rinsing, wipe off the vehicle body with a wet chamois or cloth and allow it to dry in the shade. 6) Check carefully for damage to painted surfaces. If there is any damage, “touch-up” the damage following the procedure below: 1. Clean all damaged spots and allow them to dry. 2. Stir the paint and “touch-up” the damaged spots lightly using a small brush. 3. Allow the paint to dry completely. 3) Wash the entire exterior with a mild detergent or car wash soap using a sponge or soft cloth. The sponge or 9-4 79K21-03E APPEARANCE CARE Waxing 60B211S After washing the vehicle, waxing and polishing are recommended to further protect and beautify the paint. • Only use waxes and polishes of good quality. • When using waxes and polishes, observe the precautions specified by the manufacturers. 9-5 79K21-03E GENERAL INFORMATION GENERAL INFORMATION Identification Numbers ....................................................... 10-1 Safety Certification Label ................................................... 10-2 Emission Compliance Label (for U.S.A.) ........................... 10-2 Warranties ............................................................................ 10-2 On-Board Vehicle Computers and Event Data Recorders ............................................................................ 10-3 Reporting Safety Defects ................................................... 10-4 54G072 10 79K21-03E Identification Numbers: 2, 5 GENERAL INFORMATION Identification Numbers The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) may be found in the two locations shown in the above illustrations. This number is used to register the vehicle. It is also used to assist your dealer when ordering parts or referring to special service information. Vehicle Identification Number EXAMPLE (for some vehicles) 3.2 L engine model Engine Serial Number 2.4 L engine model 79K060 The engine serial number is stamped on the cylinder block as shown in the above illustration. 60G152 60G128 64J197 10-1 79K21-03E Safety Certification Label: 6 Emission Compliance Label (For U.S.A.): 1, 2 Warranties: NO GENERAL INFORMATION Safety Certification Label Emission Compliance Label (for U.S.A.) Warranties The warranties covering your vehicle are explained in a separate New Vehicle Warranty Information booklet given to you at the time of sale. Please read this booklet carefully so you can understand your rights and responsibilities. For U.S.A. The following warranties are provided with your vehicle: • New Vehicle Limited Warranty • Limited Warranty For SUZUKI Parts or Accessories • Emission Components Defect Warranty • Emission Performance Warranty 52D059 This label contains important safetyrelated information about your vehicle. The label is located on the driver’s door lock pillar. 60A412 The EPA emission compliance label is located under the hood. 10-2 79K21-03E Reporting Safety Defects: NO GENERAL INFORMATION On-Board Vehicle Computers and Event Data Recorders Your vehicle is equipped with on-board computer systems which monitor and control several aspects of vehicle performance, including the following: • Emission-related components and engine parameters such as engine speed and throttle position are monitored to provide emissions control and to provide optimum fuel economy. Your vehicle also has an onboard diagnostic system which monitors and records information about emission-related malfunctions. • Signals from various sensors are monitored to provide air bag deployment. • If your vehicle is equipped with antilock brakes, conditions such as vehicle speed and brake performance are monitored, so that the ABS system can provide effective antilock braking. If your vehicle has an Electronic Stability Program (ESP®) system, conditions such as yaw rate, lateral acceleration, and brake fluid pressure are monitored, so that the ESP® system can help the driver control the vehicle in difficult driving situations. Some information may be stored by the on-board computers during normal operation of the vehicle. This stored information can assist technicians in repairing the vehicle when malfunctions occur. Other information is stored only in the event of crash, by computer systems that are commonly called Event Data Recorders (EDRs). In a crash event, EDRs such as the Airbag Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM) in your vehicle may record information about the condition of the vehicle and how it was operated, such as data related to airbag readiness, airbag performance, safety belt usage, and the severity of the collision. These data can help provide a better understanding of the circumstances in which crashes and injuries occur and lead to the designing of safer vehicles. The SDM in your vehicle does not collect or store personal information. In addition, once SUZUKI collects or receives data, SUZUKI may use the data for research conducted by SUZUKI, make the data available for outside research if need is shown and confidentiality is assured, or make summary data which does not identify specific vehicles available for outside research. Others, such as law enforcement personnel, may have access to the special equipment that can read the information if they have access to the vehicle or storage device. To read the stored information, special equipment is needed and access to the vehicle or storage device is required. SUZUKI will not access information about a crash event or share it with others other than with the consent of the vehicle owner or lessee, in response to an official request from the police or similar government office, as part of SUZUKI’s defense of litigation through the discovery process, or as required by law. 10-3 79K21-03E GENERAL INFORMATION Reporting Safety Defects If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying American Suzuki Motor Corp. To contact American Suzuki, owners in the continental United States can call toll-free 1-800-934-0934, or write to: American Suzuki Motor Corporation Automotive Customer Relations 3251 East Imperial Highway Brea, CA 92821-6795 If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved in individual problems between you, your dealer, or American Suzuki Motor Corp. For owners outside the continental United States, please refer to the distributor’s address listed in your Warranty Information booklet. To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to: Administrator, NHTSA, 1200 New Jersey Ave., SE., Washington, D.C. 20590. You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://www.safercar.gov. Suzuki Canada Inc. Customer Relations 100 East Beaver Creek Road Richmond Hill, On L4B 1J6 For vehicles registered for use and principally operated in Canada please contact Suzuki Canada Inc. at 1-905889-2677 extension 2254 or write to: 10-4 79K21-03E GENERAL INFORMATION MEMO 10-5 79K21-03E Fuses and Protected Circuits: 7 FUSES AND PROTECTED CIRCUITS FUSES AND PROTECTED CIRCUITS 64J157 MAIN FUSE BOX No. (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) (10) COLOR (AMPS) BLUE (15) YELLOW (20) BLUE (15) YELLOW (20) CLEAR (25) BLUE (15) YELLOW (20) YELLOW (20) GREEN (40) PINK (30) CPRSR O2 HTR THR MOT AT RR DEF HORN FR FOG MRR HTR FR BLW ABS 2 FUSES PROTECTED CIRCUIT A/C compressor fuse O2 sensor heater fuse Throttle motor fuse Automatic transmission fuse Rear defogger fuse Horn fuse Front fog light fuse Mirror heater fuse Front blower motor fuse ABS actuator fuse 11 In engine compartment 11-1 79K21-03E Fuses and Protected Circuits: 7 FUSES AND PROTECTED CIRCUITS 64J157 MAIN FUSE BOX No. (11) (12) (13) (14) (15) (16) (17) (18) (19) (20) COLOR (AMPS) RED (50) YELLOW (20) – RED (10) RED (10) RED (10) GREEN (40) GREEN (40) BLUE (15) BLUE (15) ABS 1 FI – H/L L H/L R H/L ST MTR IGN H/L LO L H/L LO R FUSES PROTECTED CIRCUIT ABS actuator fuse Main fuse Blank Head light high beam fuse, left Head light high beam fuse, right Head light fuse Starter motor fuse Ignition fuse Head light low beam fuse, left Head light low beam fuse, right In engine compartment 11-2 79K21-03E FUSES AND PROTECTED CIRCUITS (J) (I) (V) (U) (T) (H) (G) (F) (E) (D) (C) (B) (A) SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE USE THE DESIGNATED FUSES AND RELAYS ONLY (K) (S) (R) (Q) (P) (O) (N) (M) (L) (X) (W) 79K057 (A) (B) (C) (D) (E) (F) (G) (H) (I) (J) (K) (L) FUSES IN FUSE BOX DOME Dome lamp fuse STOP Stop lamp fuse – Blank ACC 3 Accessory socket fuse CRUISE Cruise control fuse Cigar or Accessory socket BLUE (15) ACC 2 fuse YELLOW (20) WIP Wiper fuse Ignition signal & Seat BLUE (15) IG2 SIG heater fuse RED (10) BACK Back lamp fuse RED (10) ABS/ESP ABS or ESP controller fuse RED (10) A/B Air bag fuse BLUE (15) RADIO Radio fuse RED (10) RED (10) – BLUE (15) RED (10) FUSES IN FUSE BOX HAZ Hazard light fuse ST SIG Starter signal fuse ECM Engine control module fuse S/R Sun roof motor fuse B/U Buck up fuse (M) (N) (O) (P) (Q) BLUE (15) BROWN (7.5) RED (10) CLEAR (25) CLEAR (25) (R) RED (10) TAIL Tail light fuse (S) YELLOW (20) D/L (T) BLUE (15) ACC (U) (V) (W) (X) RED (10) BLUE (15) – PINK (30) METER IG COIL – P/W Door lock actuator fuse Radio, Remote door mirror fuse Meter fuse Ignition coil fuse Blank Power window fuse 11-3 79K21-03E FUSES AND PROTECTED CIRCUITS MEMO 11-4 79K21-03E Specifications: 1, 2, 5, 6, 7, 10, 11 SPECIFICATIONS SPECIFICATIONS NOTE: Specifications are subject to change without notice. ITEM: Dimensions Overall length Overall width Overall height Wheelbase Tread Minimum running ground clearance ITEM: Weight Gross axle weight rating Gross vehicle weight rating Vehicle capacity weight 4WD: 4-wheel drive 2WD: 2-wheel drive M/T: Manual transmission A/T: Automatic transmission UNIT: mm (in.) 4WD 2WD Front Rear 4WD 2WD 4500 (177.1) 1810 (71.3) 1695 (66.7) 1683 (66.3) 2640 (103.9) 1540 (60.6) 1560 (61.4) 200 (7.9) 188 (7.4) See the safety certification label and the tire information label which are located on the driver’s door lock pillar. 12 12-1 79K21-03E Specifications: 1, 2, 5, 6, 7, 10, 11 SPECIFICATIONS ITEM: Engine Type Number of cylinders Bore Stroke Piston displacement Compression ratio ITEM: Electrical Ignition timing Standard spark plug Battery Fuses J24B (16V DOHC) 4 92.0 mm (3.62 in.) 90.0 mm (3.54 in.) 2393 cm3 (146.0 cu.in, 2393 cc) 10.0 : 1 2.4 L 3.2 L N32A (24V DOHC) 6 89.0 mm (3.50 in.) 85.6 mm (3.37 in.) 3195 cm3 (194.9 cu.in, 3195 cc) 10.0 : 1 5° B.T.D.C. NGK SILFR6A11 AC DELCO 41-990 12V GP24 See “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” and “FUSES AND PROTECTED CIRCUITS” sections 12-2 79K21-03E Specifications: 1, 2, 5, 6, 7, 10, 11 SPECIFICATIONS ITEM: Lights Headlight Front fog light Turn signal light Position light Brake/tail light License plate light Reversing light High mount stop light Door illumination light Dome light Luggage compartment light ITEM: Wheel Tire size, front and rear Tire pressure Low beam High beam Front Rear Spot light Center light Rear light Halogen WATTAGE 12V 55W 12V 60W 12V 55W 12V 21W 12V 21W 12V 5W 12V 21/5W 12V 5W 12V 21W 12V 5W 12V 5W 12V 8W 12V 10W 12V 10W 12V 5W BULB No. H7 HB3 H11 WY21W WY21W WY5W 7443 W5W 7440 W5W – – – – W5W P225/70R16, P225/65R17, P225/60R18 For the specified tire pressure, see the Tire Information Label located on the driver’s door lock pillar. 12-3 79K21-03E SPECIFICATIONS ITEM: Steering Toe-in Camber angle Caster angle ITEM: Capacities (approx.) Coolant Fuel tank Engine oil (replaced with filter) Transmission oil Differential gear oil 2.4 L 3.2 L 7.3 L (15.4 US pt) 9.5 L (20.1 US pt) 66 L (17.4 US gal) 4.8 L (10.1 US pt) 6.0 L (12.7 US pt) 1.9 L (4.0 US pt) 2.5 L (5.3 US pt) 3.0 L (6.3 US pt) 0.95 L (2.0 US pt) 1.1 L (2.3 US pt) 0.8 L (1.7 US pt) 0.8 L (1.7 US pt) 1.5 L (3.2 US pt) 1.6 L (3.4 US pt) 0.47 L (1.0 US pt) 2.4 L 3.2 L Front 2WD Extension case oil 0 ± 2 mm (0 ± 0.08 in.) 6 ± 2 mm (0.24 ± 0.08 in.) 0° 00’ –1° 15’ ± 40’ 2° 30’ 2.4 L 3.2 L M/T A/T Rear Transfer gear box oil Front Rear Front Rear Front 5M/T, 5A/T 4A/T 4WD with a transfer switch without a transfer switch 12-4 79K21-03E INDEX INDEX Symbols “AIR BAG” Light ..................................................................2-61 “CRUISE” Indicator Light ...................................................2-62 “ESP OFF” Indicator Light ........................................ 2-59, 3-33 “ESP” (Electronic Stability Program) Warning Light .......2-59 “ESP” Warning Light ...........................................................3-33 “SET” Indicator Light ..........................................................2-62 Numerics 4-Speed Automatic Transmission ......................................3-13 5-Speed Automatic Transmission ......................................3-11 A A/T Selector Position ..........................................................2-68 Accelerator Pedal ................................................................3-8 Accessory Socket ................................................................5-66 Adding Engine Coolant .......................................................7-14 Adjusting Seat Position ......................................................2-19 Adjusting Seatbacks ................................................. 2-19, 2-22 Air Cleaner ...........................................................................7-16 Air Conditioning System .....................................................7-49 Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) ..........................................3-29 Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Warning Light .................2-58 Anti-Lock Braking System (ABS) .......................................3-32 Armrest .................................................................................5-73 Assist Grips .........................................................................5-70 Audio Systems (type A) ......................................................5-8 Audio Systems (type B) ......................................................5-36 Automatic Heating and Air Conditioning System (Climate Control) .................................................................5-1 Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) .................................. 2-28 Automatic Transmission Fluid .......................................... 7-20 Auto-On Headlight System ................................................ 2-77 Average Speed .................................................................... 2-68 B Basic Operations .......................................................5-11, 5-38 Battery .................................................................................. 7-36 Brake Assist System .......................................................... 3-29 Brake Fluid .......................................................................... 7-22 Brake Pedal ..................................................................3-8, 7-23 Brake System Warning Light ............................................. 2-57 Brakes .................................................................................. 7-22 Braking ................................................................................. 3-28 Break-In ................................................................................ 4-2 Brightness Control ............................................................. 2-66 Bulb Replacement ............................................................... 7-40 C Catalytic Converter ............................................................. 4-2 Changing Engine Oil and Filter ......................................... 7-11 Changing Wheels ................................................................ 8-3 Charging Light .................................................................... 2-60 Child Lock System (rear doors) ......................................... 2-3 Child Restraint Systems ..................................................... 2-33 Cigarette Lighter and Ashtray ........................................... 5-67 13 Clutch Pedal .................................................................3-8, 7-20 Coat Hooks .......................................................................... 5-70 Corrosion Prevention ......................................................... 9-1 Cruise Control ..................................................................... 3-26 13-1 79K21-03E INDEX Daily Inspection Checklist ..................................................3-2 Daytime Running Light (D.R.L.) Indicator Light ...............2-63 Daytime Running Light (D.R.L.) System ............................2-78 Door Locks ...........................................................................2-1 Drive Belt ..............................................................................7-9 Driver’s Seat Belt Reminder Light .....................................2-61 Driving Range ......................................................................2-68 Front Seats .......................................................................... 2-18 Fuel Consumption .............................................................. 2-68 Fuel Filler Cap ..................................................................... 5-62 Fuel Gauge .......................................................................... 2-65 Fuel Pump Labeling ............................................................ 1-1 Fuel Recommendation ....................................................... 1-1 Fuse under the Dash Board ............................................... 7-38 Fuses .................................................................................... 7-36 FUSES AND PROTECTED CIRCUITS ................................ 11-1 E G Electronic Stability Program (ESP®) .................................3-31 Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR) .................................2-28 Emission Compliance Label (for U.S.A.) ...........................10-2 Engine Block Heater ............................................................3-10 Engine Coolant ....................................................................7-13 Engine Coolant Level Check ..............................................7-14 Engine Coolant Replacement .............................................7-15 Engine Hood ........................................................................5-63 Engine Oil and Filter ............................................................7-10 Engine Serial Number .........................................................10-1 Exhaust Gas Warning .........................................................3-1 Gasoline Containing MTBE ................................................ 1-1 Gasoline/Ethanol blends .................................................... 1-1 Gasoline/Methanol blends ................................................. 1-1 Gear Oil ................................................................................ 7-17 Gear Oil Level Check .......................................................... 7-19 Gear Oil Replacement ......................................................... 7-19 GLOSSARY OF TIRE TERMINOLOGY ............................... 7-32 Glove Box ............................................................................ 5-71 Cup Holder and Storage Bin ...............................................5-72 D F Floor Mats ............................................................................5-74 Fluid Level Check ................................................................7-20 Folding Rear Seats ..............................................................2-24 Frame Hooks ........................................................................5-83 Front Air Bags ......................................................................2-45 Front Fog Light Switch .......................................................2-78 Front Passenger’s Seat Belt Reminder Light ...................2-55 Front Seat Back Pocket ......................................................5-73 Front Seat Heater .................................................................2-21 H Hazard Warning Switch ...................................................... 2-79 Head Restraints ..........................................................2-20, 2-23 Headlight Aiming ................................................................ 7-39 High Beam Indicator Light ................................................. 2-63 Hill descent control Indicator Light ................................... 2-60 Hill descent control System ............................................... 3-35 Hill hold control System ..................................................... 3-37 HomeLink® .......................................................................... 5-80 Horn ...................................................................................... 2-82 I Identification Numbers ....................................................... 10-1 If the Engine is Flooded ..................................................... 8-9 13-2 79K21-03E INDEX If the Engine Overheats ......................................................8-9 If the Starter Does Not Operate ..........................................8-8 If You Cannot Shift Automatic Transmission Gearshift Lever Out of “P” (PARK) .....................................................3-15 If Your Vehicle Gets Stuck ..................................................4-6 Ignition Key Reminder ........................................................2-1 Ignition Switch .....................................................................3-3 Illumination Indicator Light ................................................2-64 Important Vehicle Design Features To Know ...................4-1 Improving Fuel Economy ....................................................4-3 Information Display .............................................................2-67 Inside Rearview Mirror ........................................................2-17 Installation with Lap-Shoulder Seat Belts (Child Restraint with No Top Strap) ...................................2-35 Installation with the LATCH System ..................................2-38 Installation-Child Restraint with Top Strap .......................2-40 Instrument Cluster ...............................................................2-54 Interior Light Switch ............................................................5-64 Lighting Operation .............................................................. 2-76 Lights “On” reminder ......................................................... 2-78 Listening to a CD .......................................................5-15, 5-42 Listening to a CD from an External CD Changer (Option) .......................................................................5-28, 5-54 Listening to a XM Satellite Radio (Option) ..............5-25, 5-51 Listening to Audio for AUX (Option) .............. 5-27, 5-49, 5-53 Listening to the Radio ...............................................5-13, 5-40 Low Fuel Warning Light ..................................................... 2-62 Low Tire Pressure Warning Light .............................2-55, 3-38 Luggage Compartment Cover ........................................... 5-74 Luggage Compartment Light ............................................. 5-65 Luggage Restraint Loops ................................................... 5-78 M Jacking Instructions ............................................................8-2 Jump Starting Instructions .................................................8-7 Maintenance Recommended under Severe Driving Conditions ........................................................................... 7-7 Maintenance Schedule ....................................................... 7-2 Malfunction Indicator Light ................................................ 2-61 Manual Transmission ......................................................... 3-11 Master Warning Indicator Light ......................................... 2-64 Mirrors .................................................................................. 2-17 K N Keyless Entry System Transmitter (Type B) .....................2-11 Keyless Start System Indicator Light ................................2-63 Keyless Start System Remote Controller (Type A) ..........2-5 Keyless Start System Remote Controller/ Keyless Entry System Transmitter ....................................2-4 Keys ......................................................................................2-1 National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) ............................................................................... 10-4 J L Lap-Shoulder Belt ................................................................2-28 Lighting Control Lever ........................................................2-75 O Odometer ............................................................................. 2-70 Off-Road Driving ................................................................. 4-6 Oil Level Check ................................................................... 7-10 Oil Pressure Light ............................................................... 2-60 On-Board Vehicle Computers and Event Data Recorders ............................................................................ 10-3 13-3 79K21-03E INDEX On-Pavement Driving ..........................................................4-4 Open Door Warning Light ...................................................2-62 Outside Rearview Mirrors ...................................................2-17 Overhead Console Box .......................................................5-71 P Parking Brake Lever .................................................... 3-7, 7-24 Pedals ...................................................................................3-8 Periodic Maintenance Schedule .........................................7-3 Power Assisted Brakes .......................................................3-29 Power Door Locking System ..............................................2-2 Power Mirror Control ...........................................................2-18 Power Steering ....................................................................7-24 Power Steering Fluid ...........................................................7-24 Power Window Controls .....................................................2-15 R Radio Antenna .....................................................................5-8 Rear Seats ............................................................................2-22 Rear Window Defroster and Outside Rearview Mirrors Defroster Switch ..................................................................2-82 Rear Window Wiper/Washer Switch ..................................2-81 Refill with Oil and Check for Leaks ....................................7-12 Remote Audio Controls ............................................ 5-30, 5-56 Replace the Oil Filter ...........................................................7-12 Replacing Tires and/or Wheels ..........................................3-41 Reporting Safety Defects ....................................................10-4 Roof Rails or Roof Rack Anchors ......................................5-78 S Safety Certification Label ...................................................10-2 Seat Adjustment ........................................................ 2-18, 2-22 Seat Belt Extender ...............................................................2-41 Seat Belt Inspection ............................................................2-33 Seat Belt Pretensioner System .......................................... 2-42 Seat Belt Reminder ............................................................. 2-30 Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems ........................... 2-26 Selection of Coolant ........................................................... 7-13 Shopping Hook ................................................................... 5-73 Shoulder anchor height adjuster ....................................... 2-32 Side Air Bags and Side Curtain Air Bags ......................... 2-46 Side Door Locks .................................................................. 2-1 SLIP Indicator Light ...................................................2-58, 3-32 Snow Tires ..................................................................7-32, 8-6 Spare Tire Nut Lock ............................................................ 8-1 Spark Plugs ......................................................................... 7-16 SPECIFICATIONS ................................................................ 12-1 Specified Fluid .................................................................... 7-20 Specified Gear Oil ............................................................... 7-17 Specified Oil ........................................................................ 7-10 Speedometer ....................................................................... 2-65 Spot Light ............................................................................ 5-66 Stability Control System .................................................... 3-31 Starting the Engine ............................................................. 3-9 Steering Wheel .................................................................... 7-24 Sun Visor ............................................................................. 5-64 Sunroof ................................................................................ 5-68 Supplemental Restraint System (air bags) ....................... 2-43 T Tachometer .......................................................................... 2-65 Tailgate ................................................................................ 2-3 Temperature Gauge ............................................................ 2-66 Theft Deterrent Light .......................................................... 2-15 Thermometer ....................................................................... 2-70 Tilt Steering Lock Lever ..................................................... 2-82 13-4 79K21-03E INDEX Tire Chains ...........................................................................4-7 Tire Changing Tool ..............................................................8-1 Tire Inflation Pressure .........................................................7-27 Tire Inspection .....................................................................7-28 Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) .........................3-38 Tire Rotation ........................................................................7-31 Tire Sidewall Labeling .........................................................7-25 Tire Size ................................................................................7-26 Tires ......................................................................................7-25 Towing a Disabled Vehicle .................................................8-8 Towing Your Vehicle (recreational towing) .......................6-7 Traction Control System .....................................................3-31 Trailer Towing ......................................................................6-2 Transfer Position Indicator Light .......................................2-64 Trip meter .............................................................................2-70 Troubleshooting ..................................................................5-34, ................................................................................................5-60 Turn Signal Control Lever ..................................................2-78 Turn Signal Indicators .........................................................2-63 Turn Signal Operation .........................................................2-79 W Warning and Indicator Lights ............................................ 2-55 Warning and Indicator Messages ...................................... 2-72 Warranties ........................................................................... 10-2 Washing ............................................................................... 9-4 Waxing ................................................................................. 9-5 Windows .............................................................................. 2-15 Windshield Washer ............................................................. 2-80 Windshield Washer Fluid ................................................... 7-49 Windshield Wiper and Washer Lever ................................ 2-79 Windshield Wipers .............................................................. 2-80 Wiper Blades ....................................................................... 7-46 U Underfloor Bins ...................................................................5-77 Uniform Tire Quality Grading .............................................7-30 Using the Transfer Switch ..................................................3-15 Using the Transmission ......................................................3-11 V Vehicle Cleaning ..................................................................9-3 Vehicle Identification Number ............................................10-1 Vehicle Loading ........................................................... 6-1, 7-33 Vehicle With Keyless Start System ....................................3-4 Vehicle Without Keyless Start System ..............................3-3 13-5 79K21-03E INDEX MEMO 13-6 79K21-03E Prepared by June, 2009 Part No. 99011-79K21-03E Printed in Japan TP334 79K21-03E